MC-12 Digital Controller
User Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. “Dolby, Pro Logic’” and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby
Laboratories. Surround EX is a jointly developed technology of THX and Dolby, Laboratories, Inc., and is a registered trademark of
Dolby. Used under authorization.
THX, Ultra and Ultra2 are trademarks of THX Ltd., which may be registered in some jurisdictions. All rights reserved.
Lexicon Inc.
3 Oak Park
Bedford, MA 01730-1413 USA
Manufactured under license from Lucasfilm Ltd. U.S. Patent Nos. 5,043,970; 5,189,703; and/or 5,222,056. European Patent No.
0323830. Other U.S. and foreign patents pending. Lucasfilm is a trademark of Lucasfilm Ltd.
Tel
Fax
781-280-0300
781-280-0490
DTS, DTS-ES, Neo:6, and DTS 96/24 are trademarks of Digital Theater Systems, Inc.
SACD is a trademark of Sony Electronics, Inc.
www.harmanspecialtygroup.com
Customer Service
SHARC is a Trademark of Analog Devices, Inc.
Telephone:
Sales Fax:
Service Fax:
781-280-0300
781-280-0495
781-280-0499
Lexicon, Logic 7 and the L7 logo are registered trademarks of Harman International Industries, Inc. U.S. Patent Nos. D454,553;
D454,860; 5,796,844; 5,870,480 and other worldwide patents issued and pending.
© 2005 Harman International Industries, Incorporated. All rights reserved.
This document should not be construed as a commitment on the part of Harman Specialty Group. The information it contains is
subject to change without notice. Harman Specialty Group assumes no responsibility for errors that may appear within this
document.
Part No. 070-14773 | Rev 4 | 05/05
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Introduction
Lexicon
DOCUMENTATION CONVENTIONS
This document contains general safety, installation and operation instructions for the MC-12 and MC-12 Balanced Digital Controllers. It is
important to read this user guide before attempting to use the product. Pay particular attention to safety instructions.
The following symbols are used in the document:
Appears on the component to indicate the pres-
DVD1
NAME
EDIT INPUT NAME
SETUP
INPUTS
ence of uninsulated, dangerous voltage inside
the enclosure – voltage that may be sufficient to
constitute a risk of shock.
Represents a menu path. The menu items in gray boxes must be
selected with the remote control Menu ꢀ arrow to access the
menu or menu item in the black box. For example, the SETUP,
INPUTS, and DVD1 menu items must be selected to open the
DVD1 INPUT SETUP menu.
Appears on the component to indicate impor-
tant operating and maintenance instructions in
the accompanying literature.
The DVD1 INPUT SETUP menu is used here as an example and will
continue to be used as an example throughout this document.
Whenever it appears, any other INPUT SETUP menu may be substi-
tuted. Likewise, whenever the DVD1 input appears as a step in a
menu path, any other input may be substituted.
Calls attention to a procedure, practice, condi-
tion or the like that, if not correctly performed
or adhered to, could result in injury or death.
WARNING
Calls attention to a procedure, practice, condi-
tion or the like that, if not correctly performed
or adhered to, could result in damage or
destruction to part or all of the product.
CAUTION!
Note:
Calls attention to information that is essential to
highlight.
This document uses the term MC-12 to refer to both the MC-12 and MC-12 Balanced Digital Controllers unless otherwise specified.
This document uses the term DTS-(ES) to indicate that DTS-ES encoding may or may not be present in the input source.
ii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Introduction
iii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Introduction
Lexicon
iv
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Introduction
ENGLISH
DEUTSCH
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
WICHTIGE SICHERHEITSHINWEISE
1
2
3
4
Save these instructions for later use.
1
2
3
Bewahren Sie diese Anleitungen zur späteren Benutzung auf.
Follow all instructions and warnings marked on the unit.
Follow all instructions and warnings marked on the unit.
Befolgen Sie alle Anleitungen und alle Warnhinweise auf dem Gerät
Betreiben Sie das Gerät immer mit der korrekten Netzspannung. Angaben über den
Strombedarf entnehmen Sie bitte den Betriebsanweisungen des Herstellers. Bei
unterschiedlichen Betriebsspannungen kann die Verwendung anderer Netzkabel und/
oder Anschlußstecker erforderlich werden.
Always use with the correct line voltage. Refer to the manufacturer’s operating
instructions for power requirements. Be advised that different operating voltages
may require the use of a different line cord and/or attachment plug.
4
5
Bauen Sie das Gerät nie in ein unbelüftetes Rack oder direkt über Wärme erzeu-
genden Geräten wie Verstärkern ein. Beachten Sie die in der Produktspezifikation
aufgeführte maximale Umgebungstemperatur für den Betrieb.
5
6
Do not install the unit in an unventilated rack, or directly above heat producing
equipment such as power amplifiers. Observe the maximum ambient operating
temperature listed in the product specification.
Schlitze und Öffnungen in der Box dienen der Belüftung, damit das Gerät zuverläs-
sig läuft und sich nicht überhitzt. Diese Öffnungen dürfen nicht abgedeckt oder
blockiert werden. Auch dürfen keine Gegenstände in sie hineingesteckt werden.
Verschütten Sie niemals Flüssigkeiten, gleich welcher Art, auf das Gerät.
Slots and openings on the case are provided for ventilation; to ensure reliable oper-
ation and prevent it from overheating, these openings must not be blocked or cov-
ered. Never push objects of any kind through any of the ventilation slots. Never
spill liquid of any kind on the unit.
6
7
Schließen Sie niemals Stromausgänge des Audioverstärkers direkt an das Gerät
an.
7
8
Never attach audio power amplifier outputs directly to any of the unit’s connectors.
To prevent shock or fire hazard, do not expose the unit to rain or moisture, or oper-
ate it where it will be exposed to water.
Zur Vermeidung von elektrischen Schlägen oder Brandgefahr darf das Gerät weder
Regen noch Feuchtigkeit ausgesetzt oder an Orten betrieben werden, wo es mit
Wasser in Berührung kommen kann.
9
Do not attempt to operate the unit if it has been dropped, damaged, exposed to liq-
uids, or if it exhibits a distinct change in performance indicating the need for ser-
vice.
8
9
Versuchen Sie nie, das Gerät zu betreiben, wenn es fallen gelassen, beschädigt
oder Flüssigkeiten ausgesetzt wurde oder wenn ein deutlicher Leistungsunter-
schied zu verzeichnen ist, der darauf hinweist, dass es gewartet werden muss.
10 This unit should only be opened by qualified service personnel. Removing covers
will expose you to hazardous voltages.
Dieser Apparat sollte nur von qualifizierten Fachleuten geöffnet werden. Das Abne-
hmen von Abdeckungen setzt Sie gefährlichen Spannungen aus.
This triangle, which appears on your component, alerts you to the presence
of uninsulated, dangerous voltage inside the enclosure…voltage that may be
sufficient to constitute a risk of shock.
Dieses Dreieck, welches auf Ihrem Bauteil angebracht ist, warnt Sie vor dem
Vorhandensein nicht isolierter gef hrlicher Spannung im Gerät. Diese Span-
nung kann so hoch sein, dass das Risiko eines Stromschlags besteht.
This triangle, which appears on your component, alerts you to important
operating and maintenance instructions in this accompanying literature.
Dieses Dreieck, welches auf Ihrem Bauteil angebracht ist, macht Sie auf
wichtige Betriebs- und Wartungshinweise in diesen Hinweisen aufmerksam.
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Introduction
Lexicon
ESPAÑOL
FRANÇAIS
INSTRUCTIONS IMPORTANTES RELATIVES À LA
SÉCURITÉ
INSTRUCCIONES DE SEGURIDAD IMPORTANTES
1
2
Guarde estas instrucciones para futuras referencias.
1
2
Conservez ces instructions pour pouvoir vous y référer ultérieurement.
Siga todas las instrucciones y tenga en cuenta las advertencias que aparecen en la
unidad y en las instrucciones de funcionamiento.
Suivez toutes ces instructions et tenez compte de tous les avertissements indiqués
sur l’appareil et dans la documentation fournie avec l’appareil.
3
Utilice siempre la tensión de línea correcta. Consulte las instrucciones del fabri-
cante, donde se especifican los requisitos de alimentación. Tenga en cuenta que
unas tensiones operativas diferentes pueden precisar de la utilización de difer-
entes cables de alimentación y/o enchufes.
3
4
5
Utilisez toujours la tension secteur correcte. Consultez les instructions du fabri-
cant précisant les caractéristiques d’alimentation à respecter. Attention, le type de
cordon secteur et/ou de prise secteur peut varier selon des tensions en vigueur
dans l’installation.
4
5
No instale la unidad en un rack sin ventilación, o directamente sobre equipos que
generen calor, como amplificadores de potencia. Tenga en cuenta la temperatura
operativa ambiental máxima que se detalla en las especificaciones del producto.
N’installez pas l’appareil dans un Rack mal ventilé ou directement au-dessus d’un
appareil dégageant de la chaleur comme un amplificateur de puissance. Respectez
la température maximale de fonctionnement précisée dans les caractéristiques
techniques.
Las ranuras y aberturas del equipo son para su ventilación - para garantizar un fun-
cionamiento fiable y evitar que la unidad se sobrecaliente, no bloquee, cubra o
inserte objetos en las aberturas. No derrame nunca líquidos de ningún tipo sobre
la unidad.
Les ouvertures dans le boîtier assurent la bonne ventilation de l’appareil, évitent
toute surchauffe et assurent le bon fonctionnement du système. Veillez à ne pas
obstruer, couvrir ou insérer d’objets dans ces ouvertures. Veillez à ne pas ren-
verser de liquide sur l’appareil.
6
7
8
Nunca conecte directamente salidas de amplificadores de potencia de audio a nin-
guno de los conectores de la unidad.
6
7
Ne reliez jamais directement les sorties audio des amplificateurs de puissance aux
connecteurs de l’appareil.
Para evitar descargas eléctricas o incendios, no exponga la unidad a la humedad o
la lluvia, ni la utilice donde pueda estar expuesta al agua.
Afin d’éviter tout risque d’électrocution ou d’incendie, n’exposez pas l’appareil à la
pluie ou à l’humidité ; ne l’utilisez pas dans des endroits exposés aux projections
de liquides.
No intente utilizar la unidad si ésta ha caído, se ha dañado, ha estado expuesta a
líquidos, o si muestra un cambio importante en sus prestaciones, lo cual indicaría
la necesidad de una reparación.
8
9
N’essayez pas d’utiliser l’appareil si celui-ci est tombé, a été endommagé, exposé à
des projections de liquides ou si vous constatez des dysfonctionnements nécessi-
tant l’intervention d’un technicien spécialisé.
9
Das Esta unidad deberá ser abierta únicamente por personal calificado. Si usted
quita las coberturas se expondrá a voltajes peligrosos.
Este triangulo, que aparece en su componente, alerta de la presencia de una
tensi n peligrosa no aislada en el interior del equipo - una tensi n que puede
ser suficiente como para constituir un riesgo de descarga el ctrica.
Cet appareil ne doit être ouvert que par un personnel de service qualifié. En enle-
vant les couvercles vous vous exposez à des tensions électriques dangereuses.
Le symbole de l’ clair fl ch dans un triangle quilat ral sert alerter l’utilisateur
sur la pr sence l’int rieur de l’appareil de tensions non isol es susceptibles
de constituer un risque d’ lectrocution.
Este triangulo, que aparece en su equipo, le alerta de instrucciones operati-
vas y de mantenimiento importantes en los documentos que acompa an el
producto.
Le point d’exclamation dans un triangle quilat ral sert alerter l’utilisateur sur
la pr sence de nombreuses instructions de maintenance dans le manuel
fourni avec l’appareil.
vi
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Introduction
ITALIANO
IMPORTANTI NORME DI SICUREZZA
PORTUGUESE
INSTRUÇÕES IMPORTANTES DE SEGURANÇA
1
2
Conservare le presenti norme per l’utilizzo futuro.
1
2
Guarde essas instruções para uso posterior.
Seguire sempre tutte le istruzioni e gli avvertimenti segnati sull’unità e nelle istruz-
ioni operative.
Siga todas as instruções e fique atento aos avisos marcados na unidade e nas
instruções de operação.
3
4
5
Utilizzare sempre la corretta tensione di alimentazione. Fare riferimento al manuale
del costruttore per le caratteristiche di alimentazione. Tensioni di rete diverse
necessitano anche di un diverso cavo con spine differenti.
3
4
5
Sempre use com a voltagem correta. Veja no manual de instruções do fabricante
qual a alimentação necessária. Lembre-se que voltagens de operação diferentes
podem precisar de um cabo ou plug diferentes.
Non installare l’unità in un rack poco ventilato, o direttamente sopra apparecchia-
ture che producono calore, come amplificatori di potenza. Controllare la massima
temperatura ambientale di esercizio sulle specifiche tecniche del prodotto.
Não instale a unidade em um suporte sem ventilação ou diretamente acima de
equipamentos que produzam calor, como transformadores. Observe a temperatura
ambiente máxima de operação indicada na especificação do produto.
Fori ed aperture nei pannelli sono necessari per garantire un corretta ventilazione e
prevenire surriscaldamenti. Queste aperture non devono essere coperte o ostruite.
Non inserire oggetti di alcun tipo nei fori di ventilazione. Evitare il contatto con liq-
uidi di qualsiasi genere.
O revestimento da unidade é provido de fendas e aberturas para ventilação – para
assegurar uma operação confiável e evitar que a unidade se superaqueça. Não blo-
queie, cubra ou insira objetos nas aberturas. Nunca derrube líquido de qualquer
espécie na unidade.
6
7
8
Evitare di collegare le uscite di un amplificatore di potenza direttamente a qualsiasi
connettore dell’unità.
6
7
8
Nunca ligue saídas de amplificadores de áudio diretamente a qualquer dos conec-
tores da unidade.
Per evitare il rischio di scosse elettriche non esporre il prodotto a pioggia o umid-
ità. Evitare l’uso dove possa essere esposto all’acqua.
Para evitar danos de choque ou fogo, não exponha a unidade à chuva ou umidade,
ou opere-a onde haja exposição à água.
Non tentare di utilizzare il prodotto se è caduto, se è stato a contatto con liquidi, o
mostra chiari segni di danneggiamento o cambio di prestazioni che indicano la
necessità di assistenza tecnica.
Não tente operar a unidade se ela for derrubada, danificada, exposta à líquidos ou
apresente uma mudança de performance notável, indicando a necessidade de
manutenção.
9
Ogni intervento sull’unità va eseguito esclusivamente da personale qualificato. La
rimozione della copertura comporta l’esposizione al pericolo di folgorazione.
9
Esta unidade só deveria ser aberta através de pessoal de serviço qualificado.
Removendo coberturas o exporão a voltagens perigosas.
Il presente triangolo impresso sul componente avverte la presenza di ten-
sioni pericolose non isolate all interno della copertura – tali tensioni rappre-
sentano un pericolo di folgorazione.
Esse triângulo que aparece no seu console, alerta para a presença de volta-
gem perigosa e não isolada no recinto – voltagem que pode ser suficiente
para constituir um risco de choque.
Il presente triangolo impresso sul componente avverte l utente della pre-
senza nella documentazione allegata di importanti istruzioni relative al funzi-
onamento ed alla manutenzione.
Esse triângulo ques aparece no seu console alerta para instruções impor-
tantes de operação e manutenção neste manual.
vii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Introduction
Lexicon
DANSK
SUOMI
VIGTIG INFORMATION OM SIKKERHED
TÄRKEITÄ TURVALLISUUSOHJEITA
1
2
3
Gem denne vejledning til senere brug.
Følg alle anvisninger og advarsler på apparatet.
1
2
3
Säilytä nämä ohjeet tulevaa käyttöä varten.
Seuraa kaikkia yksikköön merkittyjä ohjeita ja varoituksia.
Apparatet skal altid tilsluttes den korrekte spænding. Der henvises til brugsanvis-
ningen, der indeholder specifikationer for strømforsyning. Der gøres opmærksom
på, at ved varierende driftsspændinger kan det blive nødvendigt at bruge andre led-
nings- og/eller stiktyper.
Käytä aina oikeaa verkkojännitettä. Tehovaatimukset selviävät valmistajan käyttöo-
hjeista. Huomaa, että eri käyttöjännitteet saattavat vaatia toisenlaisen verkkojo-
hdon ja/tai-pistokkeen käytön.
4
5
Älä asenna yksikköä telineeseen jossa ei ole tuuletusta, tai välittömästi lämpöä tuo-
tavien laitteiden, esim. tehovahvistimien, yläpuolelle.Ympäristön lämpötila
käytössä ei saa ylittää tuotespesifikaation maksimilämpötilaa.
4
5
Apparatet må ikke monteres i et kabinet uden ventilation eller lige over andet
udstyr, der udvikler varme, f.eks. forstærkere. Den maksimale omgivelsestempera-
tur ved drift, der står opført i specifikationerne, skal overholdes.
Kotelo on varustettu tuuletusreiillä ja -aukoilla. Luotettavan toiminnan varmista-
miseksi ja ylilämpenemisen välttämiseksi näitä aukkoja ei saa sulkea tai peittää.
Mitään esineitä ei saa työntää tuuletusaukkoihin. Mitään nesteitä ei saa kaataa
yksikköön.
Der er ventilationsåbninger i kabinettet. For at sikre apparatets drift og hindre over
phedning må disse åbninger ikke blokeres eller tildækkes. Stik aldrig noget ind
igennem ventilationsåbningerne, og pas på aldrig at spilde nogen form for væske
på apparatet.
6
7
Älä kytke audiotehovahvistimen lähtöjä suoraan mihinkään yksikön liittimeen.
6
7
Udgangsstik fra audioforstærkere må aldrig sættes direkte i apparatet.
Sähköiskun ja palovaaran välttämiseksi yksikkö ei saa olla sateessa tai kosteassa,
eikä sitä saa käyttää märässä ympäristössä.
Apparatet må ikke udsættes for regn eller fugt og må ikke bruges i nærheden af
vand for at undgå risiko for elektrisk stød og brand.
8
9
Älä käytä yksikköä jos se on pudonnut, vaurioitunut, kostunut, tai jos sen suori-
tuskyky on huomattavasti muuttunut, mikä vaatii huoltoa.
8
9
Apparatet må aldrig bruges, hvis det er blevet stødt, beskadiget eller vådt, eller hvis
ændringer i ydelsen tyder på, at det trænger til eftersyn.
Yksikön saa avata vain laitteeseen perehtynyt huoltohenkilö. Kansien poisto
altistaa sinut vaarallisille jännitteille.
Dette apparat må kun åbnes af fagfolk. Hvis dækslet tages af, udsættes man for
livsfarlig højspænding.
Tämä kolmio, joka esiintyy komponentissasi, varoittaa sinua eristämättömän
vaarallisen jännitteen esiintymisestä yksikön sisällä. Tämä jännite saattaa
olla riittävän korkea aiheuttamaan sähköiskuvaaran.
Denne mærkat på komponenten advarer om uisoleret, farlig spænding i
apparatet - høj nok til at give elektrisk stød.
Denne mærkat på komponenten advarer om vigtig driftsog vedligeholdsin-
formation i den tilhørende litteratur.
Tämä kolmio, joka esiintyy komponentissasi, kertoo sinulle, että tässä tuote-
dokumentoinnissa esiintyy tärkeitä käyttö- ja ylläpito-ohjeita.
viii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Introduction
NORSK
SVENSKA
VIKTIG INFORMASJON OM SIKKERHET
VIKTIGA SÄKERHETSFÖRESKRIFTER
1
2
3
Ta vare på denne veiledningen for senere bruk.
1
2
3
Spara dessa föreskrifter för framtida bruk.
Följ alla anvisningar och varningar som anges på enheten.
Følg alle anvisningene og advarslene som er angitt på apparatet.
Apparatet skal alltid anvendes med korrekt spenning. Produktbeskrivelsen inne-
holder spesifikasjoner for strømkrav. Vær oppmerksom på at det ved ulike drift-
sspenninger kan være nødvendig å bruke en annen ledning- og/eller støpseltype.
Använd alltid rätt nätspänning. Se tillverkarens bruksanvisningar för information
om effektkrav. Märkväl, att andra matningsspänningar eventuellt kräver att en
annan typs nätsladd och/eller kontakt används.
4
5
Apparatet skal ikke monteres i skap uten ventilasjon, eller direkte over varmepro-
duserende utstyr, som for eksempel kraftforsterkere. Den maksimale romtempera-
turen som står oppgitt i produktbeskrivelsen, skal overholdes.
4
5
Installera inte enheten i ett oventilerat stativ, eller direkt ovanför utrustningar som
avger värme, t ex effektförstärkare. Se till att omgivningens temperatur vid drift inte
överskrider det angivna värdet i produktspecifikationen.
Apparatet er utstyrt med ventilasjonsåpninger. For at apparatet skal være pålitelig i
bruk\ og ikke veropphetes, må disse åpningene ikke blokkeres eller tildekkes. Stikk
aldri noe inn i ventilasjonsåpningene, og pass på at det aldri søles noen form for
væske på apparatet.
Behållaren är försedd med hål och öppningar för ventilering. För att garantera
tillförlitlig funktion och förhindra överhettning får dessa öppningar inte blockeras
eller täckas. Inga föremål får skuffas in genom ventilationshålen. Inga vätskor får
spillas på enheten.
6
7
Utgangsplugger fra audioforsterkere skal aldri koples direkte til apparatet.
6
7
Anslut aldrig audioeffektförstärkarutgångar direkt till någon av enhetens kontakter.
Unngå brannfare og elektrisk støt ved å sørge for at apparatet ikke utsettes for regn
eller fuktighet og ikke anvendes i nærheten av vann.
För att undvika elstöt eller brandfara får enheten inte utsättas för regn eller fukt,
eller användas på ställen där den blir våt.
8
9
Apparatet skal ikke brukes hvis det har blitt utsatt for støt, er skadet eller blitt vått,
eller hvis endringer i ytelsen tyder på at det trenger service.
8
9
Använd inte enheten om den har fallit i golvet, skadats, blivit våt, eller om dess pre-
standa förändrats märkbart, vilket kräver service.
Dette apparatet skal kun åpnes av fagfolk. Hvis dekselet fjernes, utsettes man for
livsfarlig høyspenning.
Enheten får öppnas endast av behörig servicepersonal. Farliga spänningar blir
tillgängliga när locken tas bort.
Komponenten er merket med denne trekanten, som er en advarsel om at det
finnes uisolert, farlig spenning inne i kabinettet - høy nok til å utgjøre en fare
for elektrisk støt.
Denna triangel, som visas på din komponent, varnar dig om en oisolerad far-
lig spänning inne i enheten. Denna spänning är eventuellt så hög att fara för
elstöt föreligger.
Komponenten er merket med denne trekanten, som betyr at den tilhørende
litteraturen inneholder viktige opplysninger om drift og ved.
Denna triangel, som visas på din komponent, anger att viktiga bruksanvisn-
ingar och serviceanvisningar ingår i dokumentationen i fråga.
ix
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Introduction
Lexicon
Unpacking and Inspection
Contenu de L’emballage et Inspection
After unpacking the unit, save all packing materials in case the unit
ever needs to be shipped. Thoroughly inspect the modules and
packing materials for signs of damage. Report any damage to the
carrier at once; report equipment malfunction to the dealer.
Après avoir ouvert l’emballage, conservez-le pour tout retour.
Inspectez avec soin les modules et les matériaux d’emballage pour
tout signe de dommage. Veuillez rapporter immédiatement les
dommages auprès du transporteur. Les dysfonctionnements du
matériel doivent être signalés à votre revendeur.
Auspacken und Überprüfung
Disimballaggio ed Ispezione
Bewahren Sie nach dem Auspacken des Geräts das
Verpackungsmaterial für den Fall auf, dass Sie das Gerät wieder
versenden müssen. Überprüfen Sie die Module und die Verpackung
sorgfältig auf Anzeichen von Beschädigung. Etwaige Schäden sind
dem Transporteur unverzüglich anzuzeigen; Funktionsstörungen
sind dem zuständigen Händler zu melden.
Dopo aver disimballato l’unità, salvi tutto il materiale
d’imballaggio, in caso Lei abbia bisogno di spedire l’unità. Ispezioni
attentamente i moduli ed il materiale d’imballaggio per vedere se
riportano segni di danno. Riporti subito ogni segno di danno al
corriere; riferisca il malfunzionamento dell’attrezzatura al suo
rivenditore.
Desembalaje e Inspección
Retirando a Embalagem e Inspecionando
Después de desembalar la unidad, guarde todos los materiales de
embalaje por si alguna vez transportar la unidad. Inspeccione con
atención los módulos y los materiales de embalaje para comprobar
que no muestren desperfectos. Informe inmediatamente de
cualquier desperfecto al transportista; informe de cualquier
problema de funcionamiento del equipo a su distribuidor.
Depois de desembalar a unidade, guarde a embalagem caso
precise enviar
a
unidade para manutenção. Inspecione
cuidadosamente o módulo e a embalagem procurando sinais de
dano. Avise à loja qualquer tipo de dano ou mal funcionamento do
equipamento.
x
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
1
Getting Started
About The MC-12 ...................................................................... 1-2
Highlights ................................................................................................ 1-4
Product Registration................................................................... 1-5
Installation Considerations.......................................................... 1-5
Remote Control Battery Installation ............................................ 1-6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting Started
Lexicon
ABOUT THE MC-12
Thank you for purchasing the MC-12 Digital Controller, a
reference-quality, 12-channel audio and video control center with
independent zone monitoring to provide control of input source
selection in three zones at the same time. As flexible as it is
powerful, the MC-12 includes 12 configurable inputs, each of
which can be assigned to its 13 digital audio, 8 analog audio,
5 composite video, 8 S-video, or 4 component video input
connectors. The analog audio input connectors can be configured
for stereo or 5.1-channel sources.
The MC-12 also offers LIVE! (Lexicon Intelligent Variable
Environment), designed to transform the way your listening room
sounds with the live sound that is created within the room by the
occupants of the room. LIVE! does not (nor is it meant to) work
with pre-recorded material. LIVE! provides a realistic illusion of a
larger, more reverberant listening space – ideal for musicians
wishing to practice or perform with the sound of a larger venue.
LIVE! is a unique, sophisticated reverberation system that uses a
combination of microphones and digital signal processing (DSP) to
enhance a room’s acoustics and create the illusion of a much larger
space. When you engage in normal conversation, it seems as if you
are in a large room. When you practice or perform with a musical
instrument, it seems as if you are in a concert hall. Choose from one
of three customizable presets to create an ambiance to liven up a
party or amaze your friends.
Beyond the standard 5.1-channel audio output connectors, the rear
panel includes stereo rear and stereo subwoofer connectors, as well as
stereo auxiliary connectors to provide even more audio channels. All
Main Zone audio output connectors include 24-bit/96kHz D/A
converters operating in dual differential mode. In addition, the MC-12
Balanced includes balanced audio output connectors for all Main Zone
and Zone 2 channels.
In addition to Logic 7 and LIVE!, the MC-12 is also equipped with
Dolby Digital Surround EX, Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby Pro Logic II,
Dolby Pro Logic IIx, DTS 96/24, DTS NEO:6, DTS-ES, THX Ultra2,
and THX Surround EX decoding. THX Ultra2 Certification guarantees
that the MC-12 meets the highest THX performance specifications.
Inside and out, the MC-12 is designed to remain viable in a future
of emerging technologies. Two RS-232 connectors are provided for
serial control, one to perform flash-memory software upgrades and
backup and restore configuration files, and another to support
future expansion. Inside, two expansion slots are available for
hardware upgrades, making it possible to more than quadruple the
MC-12’s processing power.
With four 32-bit floating-point SHARC™ digital signal processing
(DSP) engines, the MC-12 offers unparalleled processing power.
These DSP engines perform custom Lexicon processing such as
Logic 7 decoding, bass enhancement, dialog enhancement, auto
azimuth, 5-speaker enhancement, bass management, high-
precision digital crossovers, and tone controls. This processing is
available at sample rates up to 96kHz, with 24-bit resolution to
retain top performance from all input sources and listening modes.
A fifth DSP engine is dedicated to decoding multi-channel
compressed audio sources.
More than just an audio and video control center, the MC-12
features the latest version of Lexicon’s critically acclaimed Logic 7
decoding, which derives 7.1-channel output from stereo, 5.1-, and
6.1-channel sources. Unlike other decoders, Logic 7 is compatible
with all input sources and requires no special encoding. Because
the improvement it provides is clearly audible, Logic 7 decoding is
widely regarded as the finest available.
1-2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Getting Started
High-precision 24-bit/96kHz A/D converters can be used to convert
stereo and 5.1 analog audio input signals to digital signals,
allowing the MC-12 to provide the benefits of precise digital signal
processing without sacrificing signal integrity. Alternatively, stereo
and 5.1 analog signals can bypass A/D conversion and internal
processing to remain in the analog domain straight to the output
connectors.
Complementing its audio performance, the MC-12 features two
broadcast-quality video switchers. An ultra-wide bandwidth
component video switcher accepts analog component or RGB
video signals, while a composite and S-video switcher accepts high-
quality NTSC, PAL or SECAM video signals. The component video
switcher can pass High-Definition TV (HDTV) signals, and Standard-
Definition TV signals. Both switchers are designed to pass video
signals without alteration or degradation.
Digital audio input signals are processed through a two-stage
phase lock loop for extremely low intrinsic jitter and high rejection.
Lexicon’s proprietary auto azimuth technology corrects timing and
level imbalances in stereo sources, ensuring exceptionally accurate
playback of surround-encoded sources. A digital audio pass-
through option is available for recording digital signals with a CD
recorder or a similar component.
An unparalleled processor, the MC-12 conveys the best in music
and cinema with awesome power and leading-edge technological
sophistication. Even the most demanding enthusiasts will be
impressed with its exceptional performance. The MC-12 is a must-
have addition for any high-quality home theater.
1-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting Started
Lexicon
HIGHLIGHTS
•
•
•
•
12 channels
•
•
4 component video input connectors with
full HDTV compatibility
•
THX Ultra2 and THX Surround EX
decoding
12 configurable inputs
3 independent zones
BNC component video input and output
connectors
•
•
THX Ultra2 Certification
RS-232 connector for flash memory
software upgrades and configuration
backups
13 digital audio input connectors,
including 6 S/PDIF coaxial, 6 S/PDIF
optical, and 1 AES/EBU
•
•
•
•
•
8 S-video input connectors
5 composite video input connectors
Broadcast-quality video switching
Four 32-bit DSP engines
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
2 digital audio output connectors
3 trigger output connectors
Rear panel IR input connector
4 microphone input connectors
2 internal expansion slots
•
•
5.1-channel analog audio input connector
Analog bypass option for stereo and
5.1-channel
connectors
analog
audio
input
Separate DSP engine for decoding
compressed audio sources
•
•
•
•
Auto switching between digital and
analog audio input connectors
•
•
Logic 7 decoding
LIVE!
(Lexicon
Intelligent
Variable
Removable access panel
24-bit/192kHz D/A converters for all Main
Zone audio channels
Environment)
Balanced audio output connectors for all
Main Zone and Zone 2 channels (MC-12
Balanced only)
•
•
Dolby Digital Surround EX, Dolby Pro
Logic, Dolby Pro Logic II, and Dolby Pro
Logic IIx decoding
Stereo subwoofer and LFE output
connectors
•
EQ option available
Automatic and manual calibration of
speaker distances and output levels
DTS 96/24, DTS NEO:6, and DTS-ES
(discrete and matrix) decoding
1-4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Getting Started
PRODUCT REGISTRATION
Please register the MC-12 Digital Controller within 15 days of
purchase. Register online at www.lexicon.com or complete and
return the product registration card attached to the back cover of
this user guide. Retain the sales receipt as proof of warranty
coverage.
DO NOT place the MC-12 on a windowsill or any location exposed
to direct sunlight.
DO NOT obstruct the front-panel IR receiver window. The remote
control must be in line of sight with the IR receiver for proper
operation.
DO NOT install the MC-12 on a surface that is unstable or unable
to support all four feet, unless it is installed in an equipment rack.
INSTALLATION CONSIDERATIONS
The MC-12 requires special care during installation to ensure
optimal performance. Pay particular attention to instructions below
and to other precautions that appear throughout this user guide.
DO NOT stack the MC-12 directly above heat-producing
equipment such as a power amplifier.
DO install the MC-12 on a solid, flat, level surface such as a table or
shelf. The MC-12 can also be installed in a standard 19-inch
equipment rack using an optional rack-mount kit available from an
authorized Lexicon dealer.
CAUTION!
Before moving the MC-12, power the unit off using the
rear-panel power switch and unplug the power cord from
the wall outlet.
DO select a dry, well-ventilated location out of direct sunlight.
DO NOT expose the MC-12 to high temperatures, humidity,
steam, smoke, dampness or excessive dust. Avoid installing the
MC-12 near radiators and other heat-producing appliances.
DO NOT install the MC-12 near unshielded TV or FM antennas,
cable TV decoders, or other RF-emitting devices that might cause
interference.
DO NOT place the MC-12 on a thick rug or carpet, or cover the
MC-12 with a cloth, as this might prevent proper cooling.
1-5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting Started
Lexicon
REMOTE CONTROL BATTERY INSTALLATION
The remote control requires two AA batteries. The batteries should be replaced as needed. Alkaline batteries, which last longer without leaking,
are recommended. When battery power is low, the remote control enters a low-voltage condition, preventing it from operating the MC-12.
When this occurs, replace the batteries. Normal operation will resume when new batteries are installed.
To replace the remote control batteries:
1. Locate the battery compartment on the back of the remote control. Press the tab and lift the cover away from the remote control.
2. Remove old batteries (if applicable).
3. Observing the proper polarity, insert two AA batteries.
4. Align the cover over the battery compartment and gently press down until it snaps back into place.
5. Dispose of the old batteries (if applicable).
1-6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2
Basic Operation
Front-Panel Overview ................................................................ 2-2
Rear-Panel Overview .................................................................. 2-6
Remote Control Overview ....................................................... 2-10
Operation Considerations ....................................................................... 2-10
Main Menu ............................................................................................ 2-11
Menu Navigation ................................................................................... 2-11
Menu Item Selection .............................................................................. 2-11
Command Bank Activation ..................................................................... 2-13
Command Matrix .................................................................................. 2-14
About the Zones ..................................................................... 2-19
Two-line Status ........................................................................ 2-19
Status Menus .......................................................................... 2-20
Status Menu Descriptions ....................................................................... 2-21
Status Menu Parameter Descriptions ...................................................... 2-25
Status Menu Level Meters ........................................................ 2-26
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Operation
Lexicon
FRONT-PANEL OVERVIEW
The MC-12 is shown below. The MC-12 Balanced is shown on page 2-4. The front panels are identical, but the MC-12 Balanced has a larger chassis.
11
2
3
4
6
7
9
1
10
12
5
8
1. Standby Button
2. Front Panel Display
3. IR Receiver
7. Main Zone Input Selection Buttons
8. Main Zone Off Button
9. Zone 2 Input Selection Buttons
10. Zone 2 Off Button
4. Volume Knob
5. Mute Button
11. Record Zone Input Selection Buttons
12. Record Zone Off Button
6. Mode ꢁand ꢂ Buttons
2-2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Basic Operation
1 STANDBY BUTTON
4 VOLUME KNOB
Use the Standby button to activate or deactivate standby mode.
The Standby button performs no function when the MC-12 rear
panel power switch is powered off. When standby mode is
activated, all MC-12 zones that were active during the last session
are reactivated. The red LED in the standby button lights to indicate
that standby mode is activated. Power is still supplied to the MC-12
when it is put into standby mode.
Use the Volume knob to adjust volume level in all zones.
Note:
When MC-12 output levels are properly calibrated, the +0dB volume level
setting corresponds to the THX reference level (75dB).
To adjust the Main Zone volume level:
Rotate the volume knob clockwise or counter-
clockwise to increase or decrease the volume
level in 1dB increments. A horizontal bar
VOLUME
-34db
2 FRONT-PANEL DISPLAY
graph indicating the current Main Zone volume level appears in the
on-screen and front-panel displays. The Main Zone volume range is
–80 to +12dB.
Use the Front-Panel display to view the current input, listening
mode, input source, and volume level. The 2 x 20 character display
also functions as a display for messages and menus.
To adjust the Zone 2 or Record Zone volume level:
1. Press and hold the front panel Zone 2 or Record Zone input
selection button that corresponds with the current input
source. For example, if the current input source is DVD1, press
and hold the DVD1 input selection button.
3 IR RECEIVER
The IR Receiver receives infrared commands from the MC-12
remote control. There are three associated LEDs.
2. Push and hold a Zone 2 or Record Zone
ZONE 2 VOLUME -34db
•
The amber LED blinks when a remote control command is
received.
input selection button while rotating the
volume knob clockwise or counter-
clockwise to increase or decrease volume
level in 1dB increments. A horizontal bar
graph appears on the on-screen and front
panel displays. The Zone 2 or Record Zone volume range is –80
to +12dB.
•
•
The red LED lights when the A/D converters are overloading.
RECORD VOLUME -34db
The blue LED lights when the MC-12 is powered on and
activated – even if the FRONT PANEL DISPLAY menu STATUS
parameter is set to ALWAYS OFF.
3. When the Zone 2 or Record Zone volume level has been set,
release the input selection button.
Red LED
Blue LED
Amber LED
Remote control input selection buttons cannot be used to select
Zone 2 or Record Zone volume level adjustment, even if the Zone 2
or Record Zone command bank is activated.
2-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Operation
Lexicon
FRONT-PANEL OVERVIEW (continued)
The MC-12 Balanced, shown below, has a larger chassis than the MC-12, shown on page 2-2. Otherwise, they are identical.
11
2
3
4
6
7
9
1
10
12
5
8
5 MUTE BUTTON
Press the Mute button to mute the MC-12 Main Zone volume;
"MUTE ON" appears in the on-screen and front-panel displays. Press
the Mute button again to restore the MC-12 volume to its original
level. The VOLUME CONTROL SETUP and MUTE LEVEL parameter
can be used to set mute levels.
2-4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Basic Operation
Mute can be activated automatically or manually. For example, the
MC-12 briefly activates mute when changing input sources or
listening modes. The amber LED in the Mute button lights
whenever mute is activated.
Zones remain deactivated until a Main or Record Zone input is
selected.
10 ZONE 2 OFF BUTTON
Deactivates Zone 2.
6 MODE ꢁ AND ꢂ BUTTONS
Use the Mode buttons to scroll to the previous and next available
listening mode. Scrolling occurs in the order shown in the MODE
ADJUST menu. Press the Mode ꢁbutton to scroll upward through
available listening modes. Press the Mode ꢂ button to scroll
downward through available listening modes.
11 RECORD ZONE INPUT SELECTION BUTTONS
Selects the input in the Record Zone. When an input is selected, a
red LED lights on the corresponding input selection button. When
the Record Zone is deactivated, pressing a Record Zone input
selection button activates the Record Zone and selects the corre-
sponding input. The Main Zone and Zone 2 remain deactivated
until a Main Zone or Zone 2 input is selected.
7 MAIN ZONE INPUT SELECTION BUTTONS
Selects the input in the Main Zone. When an input is selected, a
blue LED lights on the corresponding input selection button. When
the Main Zone is deactivated, pressing a Main Zone input selection
button activates the Main Zone and selects the corresponding
input. Zone 2 and the Record Zone remain deactivated until a Zone
2 or Record Zone input is selected.
12 RECORD ZONE OFF BUTTON
Deactivates the Record Zone.
8 MAIN ZONE OFF BUTTON
Deactivates the Main Zone.
9 ZONE 2 INPUT SELECTION BUTTONS
Selects the input in Zone 2. When an input is selected, an amber
LED lights on the corresponding input selection button. When Zone
2 is deactivated, pressing a Zone 2 input selection button activates
Zone 2 and selects the corresponding input. The Main and Record
2-5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Operation
Lexicon
REAR-PANEL OVERVIEW
The MC-12 is shown below. The MC-12 Balanced, shown on page 2-8, includes balanced audio connectors for the Main Zone and Zone 2.
Otherwise both models are identical. The numbers in the rear-panel illustrations correspond with the numbered items.
9
6
1
14
10
16
9
11
INPUTS
SERIAL NO.
COMPONENT VIDEO
MC-12
DESIGNED AND
MAIN OUTPUTS
INPUT 1
INPUT 2
INPUT 4
INPUT 3
OUTPUT
RECORD OUTPUTS
1
2
3
4
5
LEXICON, INC.
Y
PR
PB
Y
PR
PB
Y
PR
PB
Y
ASSEMBLED IN U.S.A.
1 (OSD)
2
1
2
PR
PB
Y
PR
PB
VIDEO
VIDEO
L
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
FRONT
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
SIDE
REAR
AUX
Fix
Fix
Var
Var
ZONE 2
L
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
(L)
(R)
(C)
(LS)
(RS)
L
L
L
L
L
ATTENTION
RISQUE DE CHOC
ELECTRIQUE
(SUB)
NE PAS OUVRIR
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
AC 100-240V~, 50-60 Hz, 90W
LFE
MICROPHONE INPUTS
AUDIO
AUDIO
1
2
5
3
1
2
3
4
1
4
2
3
6
S/PDIF
RS 232
TRIGGER OUTPUTS
1
2
IR IN
4
6
5
LISTED
AUDIO
EQUIPMENT
OMJ
C
US
24PB
E216356
+
–
+
–
+
–
PWR
1
2
4
3
5
2
13
12
15
7
1. Power Switch
2. AC Input Adaptor
9. Video Input Connectors
10. Main Video Output Connectors
3. Digital Audio Input Connectors
4. Analog Audio Input Connectors
11. Record Zone Video Output Connectors
12. RS-232 Connectors
5. Main Zone Audio Output Connectors
6. Zone 2 Audio Output Connectors
7. Record Zone Audio Output Connectors
13. Trigger Output Connectors
14. IR In Connector
15. Microphone Input Connectors
16. Removable Access Panel
8. Balanced Audio Output Connectors (MC-12 Balanced)
2-6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Basic Operation
When a 5.1-channel analog audio source is present in the Main Zone,
input signals are sent to the Main Zone audio output connectors as
indicated in the table below. When a 5.1-channel analog source is
present in the Main Zone and the INPUT SETUP menu ZONE2 IN or
RECORD IN parameter is set to DMIX, only the (L) and (R) input
signals are sent to the Zone 2 or Record Zone audio output
connectors.
Caution!
Never make or break connections to the MC-12 unless the
MC-12 and all associated components are powered off.
1 POWER SWITCH
Use the Power switch to power the MC-12 on or off. The I and O
positions represent "on" and "off" status respectively. When the
MC-12 is powered on, the front-panel Standby button or remote
control On button can be used to activate and deactivate standby
mode. When the MC-12 is powered off, standby mode is not
available.
Input Connector
(L) & (R)
(C)
Output Connector
Front L/ R
Center
(SUB)
Subwoofer L/R & LFE
Side L/R and Rear L/R
(LS) & (RS)
2 AC INPUT CONNECTOR
Provides power to the MC-12 through the supplied power cord
(3 wire, 10 amp, IEC 320).
5 MAIN ZONE AUDIO OUTPUT CONNECTORS
Provide analog audio output in the Main Zone. Ten connectors labeled
Front L/R, Center, LFE, Subwoofer L/R, Side L/R, and Rear L/R are
available. Two connectors labeled Aux L/R are provided for future
expansion.
3 DIGITAL AUDIO INPUT CONNECTORS
(S/PDIF & AES/EBU)
Provide digital audio input in all zones. Six S/PDIF coaxial, six
S/PDIF optical (5 TosLink /1 OMJ), and one AES/EBU (XLR) input
connectors are available. These connectors are compatible with
PCM (44.1, 48, 88.2, and 96kHz), Dolby Digital, and DTS-ES
sources. These connectors are not compatible with MPEG or MP3
sources.
6 ZONE 2 AUDIO OUTPUT CONNECTORS
Provide analog audio output in Zone 2. Two stereo connectors labeled
Audio L/R are available. The connector labeled Fix passes audio at fixed
output levels. The connector labeled Var passes audio at variable output
levels and includes a built-in volume control.
4 ANALOG AUDIO INPUT CONNECTORS
Provide analog audio input. Eight stereo analog audio input
connectors labeled 1 to 8 are available. Connectors labeled 6, 7 and
8 can be configured as 5.1-channel connectors.
2-7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Operation
Lexicon
REAR-PANEL OVERVIEW (continued)
The MC-12 is shown on page 2-4. The MC-12 Balanced, shown below, includes balanced audio connectors for the Main Zone and Zone 2. Otherwise
both models are identical.
9
6
1
14
10
16
9
11
INPUTS 4
SERIAL NO.
MC-12
DESIGNED AND
COMPONENT VIDEO
RECORD OUTPUTS
MAIN OUTPUTS
INPUT 1
INPUT 2
INPUT 4
INPUT 3
OUTPUT
1
2
3
5
LEXICON, INC.
Y
PR
PB
Y
PR
PB
Y
PR
PB
Y
ASSEMBLED IN U.S.A.
1 (OSD)
2
1
2
PR
PB
Y
PR
PB
VIDEO
VIDEO
L
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Var
FRONT
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
SIDE
REAR
AUX
Fix
Fix
Var
ZONE 2
L
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
(L)
(R)
(C)
(LS)
(RS)
L
L
L
L
L
ATTENTION
RISQUE DE CHOC
ELECTRIQUE
(SUB)
NE PAS OUVRIR
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
AC 100-240V~, 50-60 Hz, 90W
LFE
MICROPHONE INPUTS
AUDIO
AUDIO
MAIN AUDIO OUTPUTS
4
1
2
5
3
1
2
3
1
1
2
2
3
3
S/PDIF
RS 232
TRIGGER OUTPUTS
1
2
IR IN
4
6
4
5
5
6
6
LISTED
AUDIO
EQUIPMENT
OMJ
C
US
+
–
+
–
+
–
24PB
E216356
PWR
1
2
L
FRONT
R
CENTER
LFE
L
SUBWOOFER
R
L
SDE
R
L
REAR
R
L
AUX
R
L
ZONE 2
R
4
3
8
5
8
2
13
12
15
7
Caution!
Never make or break connections to the MC-12 unless the MC-12 and all associated components are powered off.
2-8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Basic Operation
7 RECORD ZONE AUDIO OUTPUT CONNECTORS
10 MAIN VIDEO OUTPUT CONNECTORS
Provide analog and digital audio output in the Record Zone. Two
stereo connectors labeled Audio L/R are available for analog audio
output. The connector labeled Fix passes audio at fixed output
levels. The connector labeled Var passes audio at variable output
levels and includes a built-in volume control. Two S/PDIF
connectors (one coaxial and one optical) are available for digital
audio output.
Provide video output in the Main Zone. Two composite video
connectors, two S-video connectors, and one component video
connector (BNC) are available. The composite and S-video
connectors labeled 1 (OSD) incorporate the on-screen display.
Note:
• Composite video output connectors are available when a composite or S-
video source is present.
Alternatively, these connectors can be used to connect a recording
device. When the Record Zone audio output connector labeled Var
is sent to a recording device, you should set the VOLUME
CONTROL SETUP menu REC PWR ON parameter to +0dB to
achieve appropriate recording levels. The Record Zone audio
output connector labeled Var passes audio at variable output levels.
Adjusting Record Zone volume level will affect the recording.
• S-video output connectors are available when an S-video source is
present.
• Component video output connectors are available when a component
video source is present.
11 RECORD ZONE VIDEO OUTPUT CONNECTORS
Provide video output in the Record Zone. Two composite video
connectors and two S-video connectors are available. Alternatively,
these connectors can be used to connect a video recording device.
8 BALANCED AUDIO OUTPUT CONNECTORS
(MC-12 BALANCED)
Provide balanced analog audio output in the Main Zone and Zone
2. Ten connectors labeled Front L/R, Center, LFE, Subwoofer L/R,
Side L/R, and Rear L/R are available in the Main Zone. The
connectors labeled Aux L/R are provided for future expansion. Two
connectors labeled Zone 2 L/R are available in Zone 2.
12 RS-232 CONNECTORS
The RS-232 serial connector (1) is used to perform backup and
restoration of configuration files and flash memory software
upgrades. The RS-232 connector (2) is capable of supporting
future developments.
9 VIDEO INPUT CONNECTORS
Provide video input in the Main and Record Zones. Five composite
video connectors labeled Video 1 to 5, eight S-video connectors
labeled S-Video 1 to 8, and four component video connectors
(three RCA and one BNC) labeled INPUT 1 to 4 are available. The
component video connectors are not available for the Record Zone.
2-9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Operation
Lexicon
REAR-PANEL OVERVIEW (continued)
13 TRIGGER OUTPUT CONNECTORS
REMOTE CONTROL OVERVIEW
Provide 12V DC output to control connected components. Three
trigger output connectors are available on a removable terminal block.
The PWR connector – the power trigger output connector – is not
configurable. It is activated when the MC-12 is activated, and deacti-
vated when the MC-12 is deactivated. The trigger output connectors
(1) and (2) can be configured for remote or program operation.
The MC-12 remote control provides full operation of the MC-12,
including commands such as menu navigation that are not available
from the front-panel. The command matrix, beginning on page 2-14,
indicates the commands remote control buttons perform when each
command bank is active. The numbered items in the matrix corre-
spond with the remote control illustrations.
14 IR IN CONNECTOR
OPERATION CONSIDERATIONS
Accepts input of IR signals from infrared distribution equipment.
One 3.5mm jack that accepts a stereo plug (Tip/Ring/Sleeve
connection) or mono plug (Tip/Sleeve connection) is available.
The following factors can improve or impede remote control
operation.
Note the following before operating the MC-12 remote control:
15 MICROPHONE INPUT CONNECTORS
•
The remote control must be in line-of-sight with the front-
panel IR receiver. Eliminate obstructions between the remote
control and the IR receiver. The remote control may become
unreliable if strong sunlight or fluorescent light shines on the IR
receiver.
Provide microphone input for speaker distance and output level
calibration. Additionally, inputs 1 (left) and 2 (right) are used when
LIVE! is active. Four 3.5mm Tip/Ring/Sleeve connectors are
available.
•
For optimal performance, position the remote control at a 30
degree angle no more than 17 feet (5m) from the MC-12.
Placing the MC-12 inside a smoked glass cabinet will reduce
the remote control range.
16 REMOVABLE ACCESS PANEL
Accommodates connectors for emerging technologies.
•
•
Remote controls for different components can interfere with
one another. Avoid using remote controls for different compo-
nents at the same time.
Remote control batteries should be replaced as needed.
2-10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Basic Operation
MAIN MENU
MENU NAVIGATION
The MAIN MENU represents the beginning of
the menu structure. Use the MAIN MENU to
open the three main menu branches: MODE
ADJUST, AUDIO CONTROLS, and SETUP.
Use the remote control Menu and arrow buttons to navigate the
extensive menu structure shown in the Appendix. The table below
indicates the navigation commands remote control buttons
perform when the Main Zone command bank is activated.
MAIN MENU
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
Button
Navigation Function(s)
• When no menus are displayed, press the MENU button to open the MAIN MENU.
• When a menu is open, press the MENU button to close the menu structure.
• When no menus are displayed, press the ꢀarrow button to open the MAIN MENU.
• When a menu is open, press the ꢀarrow button to select the highlighted menu item.
• When a menu is open, press the ꢃarrow button to close the menu and, in most cases, open the previous menu. Sub-
sequent presses continue to close the current menu and open the previous menu until the MAIN MENU is closed.
When the MAIN MENU is closed, the menu structure is also closed.
• When no menus are displayed, pressing the ꢃarrow button performs no function.
• When a drop-down menu is open, press the ꢃ arrow button to select the current setting and close the drop-down
menu.
When a menu is open, press the ꢁor ꢂarrow buttons to scroll upward or downward through the complete list of menu
items. All menu items are displayed on-screen. A scroll bar appears on the right side of the menu when menu items exceed
the top and bottom margins of the display, and the cursor automatically advances to the next menu item when the first or
last menu item is passed. The highlighted menu item is displayed on the MC-12 front-panel.
2. When the desired menu item is highlighted, press the ꢀarrow
MENU ITEM SELECTION
button to select the highlighted item. If you select an option,
another menu displays. If you select a parameter, a parameter
menu or horizontal graph opens.
Use the remote control Menu arrows to select menu items.
To select a menu item:
1. Press the remote control ꢁ or ꢂ arrow buttons to highlight the
desired menu item.
2-11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Operation
Lexicon
displayed beneath the parameter name in the on-screen and
front-panel displays.
MENU OPTIONS
Selecting a menu option opens another menu within the menu
structure. For example, selecting SETUP from the MAIN MENU opens
the SETUP menu.
2. When the desired setting appears beneath the parameter
name, press the ꢃ arrow button to accept the setting and
close the drop-down menu.
SETUP
MAIN MENU
HORIZONTAL BAR GRAPHS
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGER
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
Selecting some menu parameters opens a horizontal bar graph. The
bar graph indicates the position the current parameter setting falls
within the entire parameter range. The setting appears to the right of
the parameter name in the on-screen and front-panel displays.
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
For example, selecting the DISPLAY SETUP menu A/V SYNC DELAY
parameter opens the horizontal bar graph shown below, which is
used to adjust the amount of audio delay.
MENU PARAMETERS
Selecting a menu parameter opens a drop-down menu or
horizontal bar graph that is used to select the desired setting.
OFF, 1 to 60ms
DISPLAY SETUP
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY
A/V SYNC DELAY
CUSTOM NAME
EDIT CUSTOM NAME
PARAMETER DROP-DOWN MENUS
OFF
OFF
Selecting a menu parameter opens a drop-down menu that
contains a list of available parameter settings. For example,
selecting the DISPLAY SETUP menu CUSTOM NAME parameter
opens a drop-down menu which is used to select the ON or OFF
setting.
To adjust a parameter setting with a horizontal bar graph:
1. When the horizontal bar graph appears, press the remote control
ꢁ or ꢂ arrow button to increase or decrease the setting in
designated increments.
ON
OFF
DISPLAY SETUP
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY
A/V SYNC DELAY
CUSTOM NAME
EDIT CUSTOM NAME
OFF
OFF
The setting appears to the right of the parameter name in the
on-screen and front-panel displays.
2. When you have finished adjusting the settings, press the ꢃarrow
To select a setting in a parameter drop-down menu:
button to select the setting and close the horizontal bar graph.
1. When the drop-down menu opens, press the remote control
ꢁ or ꢂ arrow button to scroll up or down through the
complete list of available settings. The current setting is
2-12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Basic Operation
COMMAND BANK ACTIVATION
Remote control buttons perform different commands depending on
whether the Main Zone, Zone 2, Record Zone, or Shift command
bank is activated. Pressing and releasing a remote control command
bank selection button – MAIN, ZONE, REC, or SHIFT – activates the
corresponding command bank. The selected command bank
remains activated until another command bank is activated.
The MAIN MENUꢀSETUPꢀDISPLAYSꢀON-SCREEN DISPLAY
menu REMOTE STATE parameter controls the remote control
command bank indicator that appears on the on-screen display.
When the REMOTE STATE parameter is set to ON, a command bank
indicator appears in the top-right corner of the on-screen display to
indicate the last command bank from which the MC-12 received a
command. A "Z" appears when the Zone 2 command bank is
active. An "R" appears when Record Zone command bank is active.
An "S" appears when the Shift command bank is active. No letter
appears when the Main Zone command bank is active. When the
REMOTE STATE parameter is set to OFF, no command bank
indicator appears on the on-screen display.
The command bank selection buttons themselves do not send
commands to the MC-12. When pressed and released, these
buttons activate the corresponding command bank. For example,
pressing and releasing the SHIFT button activates the Shift
command bank. When the Shift command bank is activated,
pressing and releasing the DVD-1 button turns off the DVD1 input
for the Main Zone.
Note:
To activate a command bank:
Remote control command bank selection buttons should not be pressed
and held.
1. Press and release a command bank selection button to activate
the desired command bank.
The command matrix that begins on the next page indicates
the commands remote control buttons perform when each
command bank is activated.
2. Press a remote control button to send a command to the MC-12.
2-13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Operation
Lexicon
COMMAND MATRIX
1
2
3
The command matrix describes the commands remote control buttons perform when each
command bank is active.
Button
Main Zone
Zone 2
Record Zone
Shift
Activates and deactivates standby mode when the MC-12 rear panel power switch is in the on position.
When standby mode is activated, pressing the standby button deactivates standby mode and activates
the MC-12, including all zones that were activated during the previous operating session. When standby
mode is deactivated, pressing the standby button activates standby mode and deactivates the MC-12.
The red front panel standby button LED lights to indicate that standby mode is activated.
1
4
Note: Power is still supplied to the MC-12 when standby mode is activated.
Activates the remote control back-light, illuminating remote control buttons making them more visible in
the dark. The back-light also illuminates whenever a remote control button is pressed. Once illuminated,
the back-light remains on for about 5 seconds before extinguishing.
2
3
Activates the Main Zone command bank, which includes commands that control the Main Zone.
Activates the Zone 2 command bank, which includes commands that control the Zone 2.
Activates the Record Zone command bank, which includes commands that control the Record and
Main Zones.
Activates the Shift command bank, which includes commands that control the Main Zone.
Selects the DVD1 input Selects the DVD1 input Selects the DVD1 input Deactivates the Main
4
for the Main Zone.
for Zone 2.
for the Record Zone.
Zone.
Selects the DVD2 input Selects the DVD2 input Selects the DVD2 input Deactivates Zone 2.
for the Main Zone. for Zone 2. for the Record Zone.
Selects the LD input for Selects the LD input for Selects the LD input for Deactivates the
the Main Zone. Zone 2. the Record Zone. Record Zone.
Selects the TV input for Selects the TV input for Selects the TV input for Sets the AUDIO
the Main Zone.
Zone 2.
the Record Zone.
CONTROLS menu
LOUDNESS parameter
to ON.
2-14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Basic Operation
Button
Main Zone
Zone 2
Record Zone
Shift
Selects the SAT input for Selects the SAT input for Selects the SAT input for Sets the AUDIO
4
the Main Zone.
Zone 2.
the Record Zone.
CONTROLS menu
LOUDNESS parameter
to OFF.
Selects the VCR input for Selects the VCR input for Selects the VCR input
the Main Zone. Zone 2. for the Record Zone.
Reserved for possible
future expansion.
4
Selects the CD input for Selects the CD input for Selects the CD input for Increases the AUDIO
the Main Zone.
for Zone 2.
the Record Zone.
CONTROLS menu BASS
parameter in 0.5dB
increments.
Selects the PVR input for Selects the PVR input for Selects the PVR input for Increases the AUDIO
the Main Zone.
Zone 2.
the Record Zone.
CONTROLS menu
TREBLE parameter in
0.5dB increments.
Selects the GAME input Selects the GAME input Selects the GAME input Increases the AUDIO
for the Main Zone.
for Zone 2.
for the Record Zone.
CONTROLS menu TILT
EQ parameter in 0.2dB
increments.
Selects the TAPE input Selects the TAPE input
for the Main Zone. for Zone2.
Selects the TAPE input Decreases the AUDIO
for the Record Zone.
CONTROLS menu BASS
parameter in 0.5dB
increments.
Selects the TUNER input Selects the TUNER input Selects the TUNER input Decreases the AUDIO
for the Main Zone.
for Zone 2.
for the Record Zone.
CONTROLS menu
TREBLE parameter in
0.5dB increments.
Selects the AUX input
for the Main Zone.
Selects the AUX input
for Zone 2.
Selects the AUX input
for the Record Zone.
Decreases the AUDIO
CONTROLS menu TILT
EQ parameter in 0.2dB
increments.
2-15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Operation
Lexicon
Button
Main Zone
Zone 2
Record Zone
Shift
Toggles the FRONT
PANEL DISPLAY menu
STATUS parameter
Sets Zone 2 volume
level to -15dB
Sets Record Zone
volume level to -15dB
Sets Main Zone volume
level to -15dB.
5
between ALWAYS OFF
and the current setting.
Toggles the ON SCREEN Sets Zone 2 volume
Sets Record Zone
volume level to -30dB
Sets Main Zone volume
level to -30dB.
6
7
DISPLAY menu BACK-
GROUND parameter
between ON and OFF.
level to -30dB
5
8
6
9
Toggles the ON
Reserved for possible
Reserved for possible
future expansion.
Sets the AUDIO
CONTROL menu BASS,
TREBLE, and TILT EQ
parameters to +0.0dB.
However, the screen
displays:
SCREEN DISPLAY menu future expansion.
STATUS parameter
between ALWAYS OFF
and the current setting.
7
EQ BALANCE
EQ OFF
10
Scroll to the previous or Activates (+) and
Activates (+) and
deactivates (-) the
trigger output
connector labeled 2
when the connector is
configured for remote
operation.
Activates (+) and
8
next available listening
deactivates (-) the
deactivates (-) standby
mode when the MC-12
is powered on with the
rear panel power switch.
mode, with the current trigger output
Main Zone input source. connector labeled 1
Scrolling occurs in the
order shown on the
MODE ADJUST menu.
when the connector is
configured for remote
operation.
Increases and decreases Increases and decreases Increases and decreases Increases and decreases
Main Zone volume level Zone 2 volume level in Record Zone volume Main Zone volume level
level in 1dB increments. in 1dB increments.
9
in 1dB increments.
1dB increments.
Toggles between
lowering Main Zone
volume level and
restoring Main Zone
volume to the original
level.
Toggles between full
Zone 2 muting and
unmuting Zone 2
volume to the original Zone volume to the
level. original level.
Toggles between full
Record Zone muting
and unmuting Record
Toggles between full
Main Zone muting and
unmuting Main Zone
volume to the original
level.
10
2-16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Basic Operation
Button
Main Zone
Zone 1
Record Zone
Shift
Displays the Main Zone Displays the Zone 2
Displays the Record Opens and closes the
11
status menu for the
two-line status for 2
seconds.
two-line status for 2
seconds.
Zone two-line status
current input source.
for 2 seconds.
When a menu is open, Centers the AUDIO
Centers the AUDIO
CONTROLS menu
RECORD BALANCE
parameter.
Centers the AUDIO
CONTROLS menu
Main Zone BALANCE
and FADER parameters.
12
13
pressing the MENU
button closes the
structure. When no
menus are open,
pressing the MENU
button opens the MAIN
MENU.
CONTROLS menu
ZONE2 BALANCE
parameter.
11
12
Adjusts the AUDIO
CONTROLS menu
ZONE2 BALANCE
parameter left and
right.
Adjusts the AUDIO
CONTROLS menu
RECORD BALANCE
parameter left and
right.
Adjusts the AUDIO
CONTROLS menu
Main Zone BALANCE
parameters left and right.
Closes the current (ꢃ)
menu or opens the
menu structure and
selects the highlighted
menu item (ꢀ).
13
14
13
15
Scroll upward and
downward through
menu items.
Increase and decrease
subwoofer output levels future expansion.
applied to the current
Reserved for possible Adjusts the AUDIO
CONTROLS menu
Main Zone FADER
listening mode.
parameters forward (ꢁ)
and backward (ꢂ).
Toggles between 7- and Reserved for possible
Reserved for possible Adjusts the MAIN ADV
14
15
5-channel playback.
future expansion.
future expansion.
menu INPUT SELECT
parameter, cycling
through the ANALOG,
DIGITAL, and AUTO
settings.
NOTE:
Use of this button during
LIVE! voids the LIVE!
calibration.
Toggles between the
Reserved for possible
Reserved for possible Toggles the MAIN ADV
current listening mode future expansion.
and the 2-CHANNEL
listening mode.
future expansion.
menu ANALOG BYPASS
parameter between ON
and OFF.
2-17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Operation
Lexicon
Button
Main Zone
Zone 1
Record Zone
Shift
Selects the THX mode
family for the current
input source.
Reserved for possible
future expansion.
Reserved for possible
future expansion.
Activates the 5.1 THX
ULTRA2, 5.1 THX SurEX,
or 5.1 THX listening
mode when a
16
5.1-channel Dolby
Digital source is present.
Selects the Dolby mode Reserved for possible
Reserved for possible
future expansion.
Activates the Dolby
Digital EX or Dolby
Digital listening mode
family for the current
input source.
future expansion.
when a 5.1-channel
Dolby Digital source is
present.
Selects the LOGIC 7 FILM Reserved for possible
Reserved for possible
future expansion.
Activates the
PANORAMA listening
mode.
mode family for the
current input source.
future expansion.
Selects the LOGIC 7 TV Reserved for possible
Reserved for possible
future expansion.
Activates the MONO
LOGIC listening mode
for 2-channel sources
and the 5.1 MONO
mode family for the
current input source.
future expansion.
LOGIC listening mode
for 5.1 channel sources.
16
Selects the DTS mode
family for the current
input source.
Reserved for possible
future expansion.
Reserved for possible
future expansion.
When a DTS-ES source
is present, pressing the
dts button toggles the
ES DECODING
parameter, cycling
through the AUTO,
ON, and OFF settings.
Selects the LOGIC 7
MUSIC mode family for future expansion.
Reserved for possible
Reserved for possible
future expansion.
Activates the L7 MUSIC
SURR listening mode.
the current input
source.
2-18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Basic Operation
ABOUT THE ZONES
The MC-12 features three zones of operation: the Main Zone, Zone
2, and the Record Zone. The Main Zone controls audio and video
sources in the primary listening space. Zone 2 controls audio
sources in the secondary listening space. The Record Zone controls
audio and video sources sent to recording devices or to a third
listening space.
3. When the MAIN MENUꢀSETUPꢀINPUTSꢀINPUT SETUP menu
ZONE2 IN or RECORD IN parameter is set to ANLG, the Zone 2 or
Record Zone audio output connectors are not available during
5.1a BYPASS listening mode. However, it is possible to have a
5.1-channel analog audio source present in the Main Zone and a
digital audio source present in Zone 2 or the Record Zone.
These zones have separate digital audio receivers and dedicated
analog source selectors that allow for independent input selection
in each zone. The MC-12 can process input sources in three zones
at the same time. For example, the MC-12 can play a DVD in the
Main Zone, while playing a CD in Zone 2, while sending satellite
receiver signals to a VCR in the Record Zone.
TWO-LINE STATUS
The two-line status opens on the on-screen and front panel displays
whenever the MC-12 detects a status change such as a new input
source or listening mode. The information included on the two-line
status differs depending on the zone in which the MC-12 last
detected a status change. For example, the Main Zone two-line
status opens when a Main Zone status change is detected.
The following are exceptions to independent zone operation:
1. When a Dolby Digital or DTS-ES source is present in the Main
Zone, the same Dolby Digital or DTS-ES source can also be
present in Zone 2 or the Record Zone. However, a different
Dolby Digital or DTS-ES source cannot be present in Zone 2 or
the Record Zone.
MAIN ZONE TWO-LINE STATUS
Opens on the on-screen and front panel
displays whenever the MC-12 detects a Main
Zone status change. The Main Zone two-line
DVD1
FILM
D
VOL
-34dB
2. Main Zone multi-channel audio can be down-mixed in Zone 2 or
the Record Zone when all of the following conditions are met:
status indicates the current input, listening mode, input source, and
volume level selected in the Main Zone.
•
•
A Dolby Digital or DTS-ES source is present in the Main Zone.
The Main Zone input is also selected in Zone 2 or the
Record Zone. For example, if the DVD1 input is selected in
the Main Zone, the DVD1 input must also be selected in
Zone 2 or the Record Zone.
ZONE 2 TWO-LINE STATUS
Opens on the on-screen and front panel
displays whenever the MC-12 detects a Zone
2 status change. The Zone 2 two-line status
DVD1
ZONE 2
D
VOL
-34dB
•
The MAIN MENUꢀSETUPꢀINPUTSꢀINPUT SETUP menu
ZONE2 IN or RECORD IN parameter is set to DMIX.
indicates the current input, input source, and volume level selected
in Zone 2.
2-19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Operation
Lexicon
To open and navigate the STATUS menu for the current input
source:
RECORD ZONE TWO-LINE STATUS
Opens on the on-screen and front panel
displays whenever the MC-12 detects a
Record Zone status change. The Record Zone
two-line status indicates the current input, input source, and
volume level selected in the Record Zone.
DVD1
ZONE 2
D
VOL
-34dB
1. Press and release the remote control SHIFT button.
2. Press and release the remote control STAT button.
The first page of the STATUS menu for the current input source
appears in the on-screen and front-panel displays.
The ON-SCREEN DISPLAY menu STATUS parameter can control the
length of time for which the two-line status appears on the
on-screen and front panel displays. The ON-SCREEN DISPLAY menu
POSITION parameter can control the vertical alignment of the
two-line status on the display device screen.
If the STATUS menu includes a second page, the PG1 indicator
appears in the top-right corner of the menu. Press and release
the STAT button again to open the second page. If the STATUS
menu does not include a second page, pressing and releasing
the STAT button again closes the menu.
3. When the desired STATUS menu page opens, press the remote
control MAIN button, then press the ꢁ or ꢂ arrow button to
scroll up or down through the list of available parameters.
Note:
When the display device is connected to a component video output con-
nector and the ADVANCED menu COMPONENT OSD parameter is set to
OFF, the display device does not show the on-screen display, including the
two-line status.
4. Press the STAT button to close the STATUS menu. In some
cases, you must press STAT twice in succession to close the
STATUS menu.
Note:
STATUS MENUS
STATUS menu parameters provide information about the current
input source and listening mode. These parameters cannot be
adjusted.
The STATUS menu contains parameters that provide information about
the current input source and listening mode. STATUS menus are
available for 2-channel, Dolby Digital, DTS-ES analog, digital, and LIVE!
input sources.
STATUS menu parameters provide information about the current
input source and listening mode. Some STATUS menus also include
level meters that indicate fluctuating audio input levels. Unlike most
other menus, STATUS menus cannot be opened by selecting menu
options. The remote control command sequence outlined below
must be executed.
2-20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Basic Operation
STATUS MENU DESCRIPTIONS
D STATUS
The table beneath each description lists the default and possible
settings for each parameter.
Provides information about Dolby Digital input sources. Features L,
C, R, SL, SR and SUB level meters.
2CH STATUS
Parameter
Possible Settings
Provides information about 2-channel input sources. Features L and
R level meters.
INPUT
The current input
The current listening mode
3/2.1, 3/2, 3/1, 2/2, 2/1, 2/0, 1/0
32 to 640kbps
MODE
CHANNELS
BIT RATE
Parameter
Possible Settings
INPUT
The current input
EX ENCODING
SAMPLE RATE
2.0 ENCODING
DIALOG OFFSET
MIX ROOM
CENTER MIX LVL
SURR MIX LVL
MATRIX, NO
MODE
The current listening mode
ANLG, PCM
48kHz
INPUT TYPE
SAMPLE RATE
MATRIX, NONE
44.1kHz, 48kHz, 88.2kHz, 96kHz
-27 to +4dB
SMALL, LARGE
-3.0dB, -4.5dB, -6.0dB
+0.0dB, -3.0dB, -6.0dB
2CH STATUS
INPUT
MODE
INPUT TYPE
SAMPLE RATE
D STATUS
INPUT
MODE
CHANNELS
BIT RATE
PG1
D STATUS
PG2
L
R
dB
0
-6
-15
-30
SAMPLE RATE
2.0 ENCODING
DIALOG OFFSET
MIX ROOM
CENTER MIX LVL
SURR MIX LVL
-45
EX ENCODING
L
C
R
SL
LFE
dB
SR
0
-6
-15
-30
-45
2-21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Operation
Lexicon
STATUS
5.1 ANALOG STATUS
Provides information about DTS-ES input sources. Includes L, C, R,
SL, SR, SB and LFE level meters.
Provides information about 5.1-channel analog sources. Includes L,
C, R, SL, and LFE level meters.
Parameter
Possible Settings
Parameter
Possible Settings
INPUT
The current input
INPUT
The current input
MODE
The current listening mode
3/3.1, 3/2.1
MODE
The current listening mode
ANLG
CHANNELS
BIT RATE
INPUT TYPE
SAMPLE RATE
754.5 to 1509.7kbps
DISCRETE, MATRIX, OFF
16 bits, 20 bits, 24 bits
44.1kHz, 48kHz, 88.2kHz, 96kHz
44.1kHz, 48kHz, 88.2kHz, 96kHz
ES ENCODING
WORD LENGTH
SAMPLE RATE
Note:
The only possible sample rate for 5.1 analog sources is 96kHz, as they
are converted to 96kHz PCM at the MC-12 input (when MAIN
ADVANCED ꢀANALOG BYPASS is set to OFF).
STATUS
WORD LENGTH
SAMPLE RATE
STATUS
INPUT
MODE
CHANNELS
BIT RATE
PG1
PG1
5.1 ANALOG STATUS
STATUS
PG1
INPUT
MODE
INPUT TYPE
SAMPLE RATE
WORD LENGTH
SAMPLE RATE
ENCODING
dB
L
C
R
SL
LFE
SR
0
-6
-15
-30
dB
L
C
R
SL
LFE
SR
0
-6
-15
-30
-45
-45
2-22
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Basic Operation
5.1a BYPASS STATUS
2CH BYPASS STATUS
Provides information about 5.1-channel analog input sources when
the MAIN ADV menu ANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to ON.
Provides information about 2-channel analog input sources when
the MAIN ADV menu ANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to ON.
Parameter
Possible Settings
Parameter
Possible Settings
INPUT
The current input
5.1a BYPASS
BYPASS
INPUT
The current input
2CH BYPASS
BYPASS
MODE
MODE
INPUT TYPE
INPUT TYPE
5.1a BYPASS STATUS
2CH BYPASS STATUS
INPUT
MODE
INPUT TYPE
INPUT
MODE
INPUT TYPE
2-23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Operation
Lexicon
DIGITAL STATUS
LIVE! STATUS
Provides information about digital input sources for which a sample
rate is detected, but no audio is present in the input signal.
Provides information about LIVE! input sources.
Parameter
Possible Settings
Parameter
Possible Settings
INPUT
The current input
INPUT
The current input
MODE
The current listening mode
MODE
The current listening mode
---
INPUT TYPE
SAMPLE RATE
MIC
INPUT TYPE
SAMPLE RATE
48kHz
44.1kHz, 48kHz, 88.2kHz, 96kHz
2CH STATUS
DIGITAL STATUS
INPUT
MODE
INPUT TYPE
SAMPLE RATE
INPUT
MODE
INPUT TYPE
SAMPLE RATE
L
R
dB
0
-6
-15
-30
-45
2-24
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Basic Operation
Possible settings for Dolby Digital input sources include 3/2.1, 3/2,
3/1, 2/2, 2/1, 2/0 and 1/0. Current settings for DTS-ES input
sources include 3/3.1 and 3/2.1.
STATUS MENU PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS
2.0 ENCODING
MATRIX, NONE
DIALOG OFFSET
-27 to +4dB
Indicates whether or not a matrix-encoded source is detected.
When the parameter setting is MATRIX, a matrix-encoded source is
detected. When the parameter setting is NONE, a matrix-encoded
source is not detected. The MC-12 cannot automatically detect
matrix encoding in non-flagged input sources.
Indicates the dialog normalization value applied to the input signal.
Dolby Digital input sources reproduce dialog at 27 decibels below
full-scale (-27dBFS). When the dialog normalization value of the
incoming signal is higher or lower, the DIALOG OFFSET parameter
indicates the amount of adjustment the MC-12 makes to normalize
dialog to -27dBFS.
BIT RATE
32 to 640 kbps or 754 to 1509.7kbps
Indicates the rate at which the input signal is encoded. A higher bit rate
indicates that less compression was used during the encoding process.
Possible settings for Dolby Digital sources range from 32 to 640 kbps.
Possible settings for DTS-ES sources range from 754 to 1509.7kbps.
ES ENCODING
DISCRETE, MATRIX, OFF
Indicates whether or not a DTS-ES-encoded source is detected.
When the parameter setting is DISCRETE, a discrete 6.1-channel
DTS-ES source is detected. When the parameter setting is MATRIX,
a 5.1-channel DTS-ES source with a surround-encoded back
channel is detected. When the parameter setting is OFF, a standard
DTS source with no DTS-ES encoding is detected.
CENTER MIX LVL
-3.0dB, -4.5dB, -6.0dB
Indicates the relative level of the center channel that was used
during the mixing process.
EX ENCODING
MATRIX, NONE
CHANNELS
3/3.1, 3/2.1, 3/2, 3/1, 2/2, 2/1, 2/0, 1/0
Indicates whether or not a Dolby Digital Surround EX-encoded
source is detected. When the parameter setting is MATRIX, a
5.1-channel Dolby Digital source recorded with Dolby Digital
Surround EX is detected. When the parameter setting is NONE, a
standard 5.1-channel Dolby Digital source recorded without Dolby
Digital Surround EX-encoding is detected. The MC-12 cannot
automatically detect Dolby Digital Surround EX encoding in
non-flagged input sources.
Indicates the number of channels present in the input source. The
first digit indicates the number of front channels present. The digit
after the slash indicates the number of surround channels present.
The digit after the decimal point indicates the presence of LFE (low
frequency effects) information. For example, if the CHANNELS
parameter is set to 3/2.1 and LFE=ON, LFE information (the .1
channel) is sent to the LFE output. If the CHANNELS parameter is
set to 3/2.1 and LFE=OFF, LFE information is sent to the subwoofer
output(s) and/or speakers, depending on crossover settings.
2-25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Operation
Lexicon
INPUT
STATUS MENU LEVEL METERS
Indicates the selected input (for example, DVD1).
Most STATUS menus contain level meters that indicate fluctuating
input levels in the front left (L), center (C), front right (R), surround left
(SL), surround right (SR), surround back (SB) and subwoofer (SUB)
channels. These level meters indicate input levels for both analog and
digital input sources. For example, the level meters indicate digital
audio input levels when a digital audio source is present.
INPUT TYPE
ANLG, BYP, PCM, MIC, ---
Indicates the input source that is present. When the parameter
setting is ANLG, a 2-channel analog audio source is present and the
ADVANCED menu 2-CH ANLG BYP parameter is set to OFF. When
the parameter setting is BYP (Bypass), a 2-channel analog audio
source is present and the 2-CH ANLG BYP parameter is set to ON.
When the parameter setting is PCM, a 2-channel digital audio
source is present. When the parameter setting is MIC, a micro-
phone source is present. When the parameter setting is ---, an
unknown digital audio source is present.
Different combinations of level meters appear on each STATUS menu,
depending on the source that is present. The SB level meter appears
when a 6.1-channel source is present, or when a 5.1-channel source
is present and the ES DECODING parameter is set to ON.
Level meters appear in combinations of green, yellow and red when
the on-screen display is configured for a blue-screen background.
Green indicates low levels, yellow indicates normal levels, and red
indicates high levels and the onset of overload. Level meters appear
in white when the on-screen display is not configured for a blue
screen background.
MIX ROOM
SMALL, LARGE
Indicates the size of the mixing room that was used during the mixing
process. When the parameter setting is LARGE, you should set the
RE-EQUALIZATION parameter to ON for THX listening modes.
MODE
Indicates the activated listening mode (e.g., L7 FILM).
SAMPLE RATE
44.1kHz, 48kHz, 88.2kHz, 96kHz
Indicates the sample rate of the input source that is present.
SURR MIX LVL
+0.0dB, -3.0dB, -6.0dB
Indicates the relative surround channel level that was used during
the mixing process.
WORD LENGTH
16 bits, 20 bits, 24 bits
Indicates the word length of the audio data present in the input signal.
2-26
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Setup
Manual Calibration ................................................................................ 3-52
On-Screen Display ................................................................................. 3-63
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
SETUP
Selecting SETUP from the MAIN MENU opens the SETUP menu.
REAR PANEL CONFIG
SETUP
REAR PANEL CONFIG
MAIN MENU
SETUP
Opens the REAR PANEL CONFIG menu, to configure the analog audio input
connectors as eight stereo connectors or as five stereo and one 5.1-channel
connectors. See “REAR PANEL CONFIG” on page 3-59 for more
information.
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
DISPLAYS
SETUP
DISPLAYS
Opens the DISPLAY SETUP menu, to customize the on-screen and
front-panel displays, restore audio/video synchronization, and
create and activate a custom unit name. See “DISPLAY SETUP” on
INPUTS
SETUP
INPUTS
Prompts for an input selection (e.g., DVD1), and opens the corre-
sponding INPUT SETUP menu. When the menu is open, you can
change input names, assign audio and video input connectors, select
preferred listening modes, and configure Main Zone, Zone 2 and
information.
VOLUME CONTROLS
SETUP
VOLUME CONTROLS
Opens the VOLUME CONTROL SETUP menu, to configure Main Zone,
Zone 2, and Record Zone volume levels. See “VOLUME CONTROL
SPEAKERS
SETUP
SPEAKERS
TRIGGERS
Opens the SPEAKER SETUP menu, to configure the Main Zone
audio output connectors for the desired speaker setup. See
SETUP
TRIGGERS
Prompts the selection of a desired trigger output connector (1 or 2)
and opens the corresponding TRIGGER SETUP menu for configu-
ration of remote or program operation. See “TRIGGER SETUP” on
3-2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
SETUP
LOCK OPTIONS
SETUP
LIVE! CALIBRATION
Opens the LOCK OPTIONS menu, to protect MODE ADJUST,
AUDIO CONTROLS and SETUP menu branch settings from
accidental changes. See “LOCK OPTIONS” on page 3-70 for more
information.
Opens the LIVE! CALIBRATION menu, to perform the necessary
calibration before using the LIVE! modes. See “LIVE! Calibration” on
page 3-71 for more information.
3-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
INPUT SETUP
SETUP
INPUTS
(INPUT)
INPUT SETUP
Selecting the SETUP menu INPUTS option prompts the selection of a desired input (e.g., DVD1). Selecting an input opens the corresponding
INPUT SETUP menu, which changes input names, assigns audio and video input connectors, selects preferred listening modes, and configures
advanced Main Zone, Zone 2, and Record Zone settings.
SETUP
MAIN MENU
INPUT SETUP
DVD1 INPUT SETUP
NAME
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
DVD1
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
DVD1
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
COAX-1
NONE
AUTO
S-VIDEO-1
1
VCR
CD
FILM
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
D
5.1 FILM
FILM
5.1a
MIC
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
RECORD ADVANCED
The DVD1 INPUT SETUP menu is shown here as an example, and will continue to be shown as an example throughout this section. Whenever it appears, any other INPUT SETUP
menu can be substituted. Likewise, whenever the DVD1 input appears as a step in a menu path, any other input can be substituted.
All INPUT SETUP menus are shown in the Appendix on page A-6. The parameters on the left side of the INPUT SETUP menus are identical
regardless of which input is selected. The parameter settings on the right side are adjustable. The INPUT SETUP menus shown in the Appendix
indicate factory-default parameter settings for each input.
3-4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
CHANGING INPUT NAMES
Selecting the INPUT SETUP menu NAME parameter opens the INPUT NAME menu, to customize or restore the factory-default name of the selected
input. Factory-default input names correspond to front-panel and remote control input selection button labels.
DVD1 INPUT SETUP
NAME
SETUP
INPUT SETUP
DVD1 INPUT NAME
EDIT INPUT NAME
DVD1
MAIN MENU
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
DVD1
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
VCR
CD
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
DVD1
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
EDIT INPUT NAME
RESTORE DEFAULT NAME
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
COAX-1
NONE
BUTTONS TO EDIT
UP TO 8 CHARACTERS
BUTTON TO ADVANCE
AUTO
S-VIDEO-1
1
FILM
D
5.1 FILM
FILM
INPUT SETUP
5.1a
MIC
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
RT-20
(DVD1)
DVD2
MAIN ADVANCED
LD
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
TV
SAT
RECORD ADVANCED
VCR
CD
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
EDIT INPUT NAME
SETUP
INPUTS
DVD1
NAME
EDIT INPUT NAME
Opens the EDIT INPUT NAME editing menu, to customize the name
of the selected input. Custom input names can include up to eight
characters.
2. When the editing menu opens, the current input name appears
on the second line. Use the remote control ꢁ and ꢂ arrow
buttons to change the character above the cursor (^).
3. When the character you want is displayed, press the ꢀ arrow
button to advance to the next character space. The cursor will
automatically wrap to the first character space when the last
character space is passed.
To customize the name of the selected input:
1. Follow the EDIT INPUT NAME menu path to open the EDIT
INPUT NAME editing menu.
3-5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
CHANGING INPUT NAMES (continued)
Note:
The custom input name appears in the on-screen and front-panel
displays. Both the custom and factory-default input names appear
in the INPUT SETUP menu. The custom input name appears against
the left margin of the on-screen display, and the factory-default
input name appears in parentheses against the right margin.
Pressing the ꢃarrow button closes the menu and returns to the INPUT
NAME menu.
4. Repeat step 3 to enter all characters in the new name. When the
input name you want is displayed, press the ꢃarrow button to
close the menu and return to the INPUT NAME menu.
SETUP
DVD1 INPUT SETUP
NAME
MAIN MENU
INPUT SETUP
DVD1 INPUT NAME
PRESS MENU
RESTORE INPUT NAME
V
TO
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
DVD1
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
DVD1
EDIT INPUT NAME
RESTORE DEFAULT NAME
DVD2
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
COAX-1
NONE
LD
TV
AUTO
SAT
S-VIDEO-1
1
VCR
CD
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
FILM
D
5.1 FILM
FILM
5.1a
MIC
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
RECORD ADVANCED
To restore the factory-default name of the selected input:
RESTORE DEFAULT NAME
1. Follow the RESTORE DEFAULT NAME menu path to open the
INPUT NAME menu.
DVD1
RESTORE DEFAULT NAME
SETUP
INPUTS
NAME
2. When the INPUT NAME menu opens, press the remote control ꢁ
Restores the factory-default name of the selected input. Factory-
default input names correspond to front-panel and remote control
input selection button labels.
or ꢂbuttons to highlight the RESTORE DEFAULT NAME option.
3. Press theꢀarrow button to select this option. The message:
“PRESS MENU V TO RESTORE INPUT NAME” appears in the on-
screen and front-panel displays.
4. Press theꢀbutton to restore the factory-default name and close
the message. (Press theꢃbutton to close the message without
restoring the factory-default name of the selected input.)
3-6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
ASSIGNING AUDIO & VIDEO INPUT CONNECTORS
The MC-12 has 12 inputs, each of which can be assigned to any (depending on compatibility) of its 13 digital audio, 8 analog audio, 5
composite video, 8 S-video, or 4 component video input connectors.
MAIN MENU
SETUP
INPUT SETUP
DVD1 DIGITAL IN
DVD1 INPUT SETUP
NAME
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
DVD1
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
DVD1
COAX-1
COAX-2
COAX-3
COAX-4
COAX-5
COAX-6
OPTICAL-1
OPTICAL-2
OPTICAL-3
OPTICAL-4
OPTICAL-5
OPTICAL-6
AES/EBU
NONE
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
COAX-1
NONE
AUTO
S-VIDEO-1
1
VCR
CD
FILM
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
D
5.1 FILM
FILM
5.1a
MIC
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
RECORD ADVANCED
The table below indicates the INPUT SETUP menu parameters that
can be used to assign audio and video input connectors. The ANLG
IN LVL parameter can be used to adjust 2-channel and 5.1 analog
audio input levels for the selected input.
Note:
The digital audio input connectors are compatible with PCM (44.1, 48,
88.2, and 96kHz), Dolby Digital and DTS(-ES) sources. The digital
audio input connectors are not compatible with MPEG or MP3 sources.
Parameter
Possible Settings
DIGITAL IN
COAX-1 TO 6, OPTICAL-1 TO 6, AES/EBU, NONE
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
COAX-1 to 6, OPTICAL-1 to 6, AES/EBU, NONE
ANALOG-1 to 8, 5.1 ANLG (6-8), LIVE!, NONE
AUTO, -18dB to +12dB
DVD1
DIGITAL IN
SETUP
INPUTS
Opens the DIGITAL IN menu, to assign a digital audio input
connector for the selected input. A digital audio input connector
must be assigned if no analog audio input connector is assigned.
COMPOSITE-1 to 5, S-VIDEO-1 to 8, NONE
COMPONENT IN COMPONENT-1 to 4
When no analog audio input connector is assigned, the MC-12
automatically sets the:
•
•
•
MAIN ADV menu INPUT SELECT parameter to DIGITAL
INPUT SELECT menu ZONE2 IN parameter to DIGITAL
INPUT SELECT menu RECORD IN parameter to DIGITAL
3-7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
ASSIGNING AUDIO & VIDEO INPUT CONNECTORS (continued)
ANALOG IN
ANALOG-1 TO 8, 5.1 ANLG (6-8), LIVE!, NONE
INPUTS
DVD1
ANALOG IN
SETUP
Opens the ANALOG IN menu, to assign an analog audio input
connector for the selected input. An analog audio input connector
must be assigned if no digital audio input connector is assigned.
When no digital audio input connector is assigned, the MC-12
automatically sets the:
•
•
•
MAIN ADV menu INPUT SELECT parameter to ANALOG
INPUT SELECT menu ZONE2 IN parameter to ANLG
INPUT SELECT menu RECORD IN parameter to ANLG
The appearance of the ANALOG IN menu depends on the configu-
ration of the analog audio input connectors.
•
•
The ANALOG IN menu (A below) appears when the REAR
PANEL CONFIG menu 8 STEREO INPUTS option is selected.
Note:
LIVE! cannot be selected until LIVE! CALIBRATION is run. When the
ANALOG IN selection is LIVE!, no other analog inputs (1-8) or digital
inputs can be selected for that input.
The ANALOG IN menu (B below) appears when the REAR
PANEL CONFIG menu 5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG option is
selected.
INPUT SETUP
DVD1 INPUT SETUP
NAME
DVD1 ANALOG IN
DVD1 ANALOG IN
MAIN MENU
SETUP
OR
DVD1
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
DVD1
ANALOG-1
ANALOG-2
ANALOG-3
ANALOG-4
ANALOG-5
ANALOG-6
ANALOG-7
ANALOG-8
NONE
ANALOG-1
ANALOG-2
ANALOG-3
ANALOG-4
ANALOG-5
5.1 ANLG (6-8)
NONE
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
COAX-1
NONE
AUTO
S-VIDEO-1
1
VCR
CD
FILM
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
D
5.1 FILM
FILM
LIVE!
5.1a
MIC
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
LIVE!
B
MAIN ADVANCED
A
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
RECORD ADVANCED
3-8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
ANLG IN LVL
AUTO, -18 to +12 dB
Note:
SETUP
INPUTS
DVD1
ANGL IN LVL
Adjustments made on the ANLG IN LVL menu are applied to the stereo
analog audio input connector assigned for the selected input. When
another stereo analog audio input connector is assigned, these
adjustments are automatically applied to the new connector.
Opens the ANLG IN LVL menu, to adjust the 2-channel (and
5.1-channel when the MAIN ADVANCEDꢀANALOG BYPASS
parameter is set to OFF) analog audio input levels for the selected
input. Analog audio sources have a wide range of levels. To
compensate, the MC-12 allows independent input level adjustment
of each stereo analog audio input connector. The input level of the
5.1-channel analog audio input connector is only adjustable when
the ANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to OFF.
AUTO
ON, OFF
SETUP
INPUTS
DVD1
ANGL IN LVL
AUTO
Provides automatic adjustment of 2-channel (and 5.1-channel
when the MAIN ADVANCEDꢀANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to
OFF) analog audio input levels. When set to ON, the input levels are
automatically monitored and optimized. When the input signal is
too high, the input levels are quickly decreased to avoid overload.
When the input signal is too low, the input levels are slowly
increased to maximize the signal-to-noise ratio and dynamic range.
Parameter
Possible Settings
AUTO
ON, OFF
MANUAL
AUTO GAIN*
-18 to +12dB
-18 to +12dB
* This parameter cannot be adjusted.
When set to OFF, the 2-channel and 5.1 analog audio input levels
are not automatically monitored and optimized. Instead, input
levels must be adjusted with the ANLG IN LVL MANUAL parameter.
SETUP
INPUT SETUP
MAIN MENU
DVD1 ANLG IN LVL
ON
DVD1 INPUT SETUP
NAME
OFF
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
DVD1
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
VCR
CD
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
AUTO
MANUAL
ON
+0dB
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
DVD1
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
COAX-1
NONE
-18 to +12dB
AUTO
S-VIDEO-1
1
+0.0dB
AUTO GAIN
L
R
dB
0
-6
-15
-30
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
FILM
D
5.1 FILM
FILM
-45
5.1a
MIC
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
RECORD ADVANCED
3-9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
ASSIGNING AUDIO & VIDEO INPUT CONNECTORS (continued)
When the AUTO parameter is OFF, the AUTO GAIN parameter
indicates the amount of input level adjustment as set by the
MANUAL parameter.
MANUAL
-18 to +12 dB
DVD1
MANUAL
SETUP
INPUTS
ANGL IN LVL
Provides manual adjustment of 2-channel (and 5.1-channel when
the MAIN ADVANCEDꢀ ANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to OFF)
analog audio input levels. Lower levels cause more noise, while
higher levels pose a risk of overload distortion. When manual
adjustments are made, the MC-12 automatically sets the ANLG IN
LVL menu AUTO parameter to OFF, deactivating automatic input
level adjustment. Manual input level adjustments are retained when
the AUTO parameter is ON.
When AUTO GAIN is set to OFF
DVD1 ANLG IN LVL
OFF
+3dB
AUTO
MANUAL
The MANUAL parameter...
is reflected by the AUTOGAIN value
+3.0dB
AUTO GAIN
Note:
When the AUTO parameter is ON, the AUTO GAIN parameter
continues to indicate the amount of manual input level adjustment
until automatic adjustments have been made.
When the AUTO parameter is ON, the MC-12 will not make adjustments
that exceed the ANLG IN LVL menu MANUAL parameter setting.
LEVEL METERS
AUTO GAIN
DVD1
AUTO GAIN
SETUP
INPUTS
ANGL IN LVL
Indicate fluctuating input levels in the front left (L) and front right (R)
channels for the selected input. Meters are also present for center
(C), side left (SL), side right (SR), and sub (LFE) when the input is set
up for 5.1-analog. Like the STATUS menu level meters, ANLG IN LVL
menu level meters indicate input levels for both analog and digital
audio sources. However, ANLG IN LVL menu input level adjustments
only affect 2-channel (or 5.1-channel sources when the MAIN
ADVANCEDꢀANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to OFF) analog
audio sources.
Indicates the current amount of input level adjustment for the
selected 2-channel (and 5.1-channel when the MAIN ADVANCEDꢀ
ANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to OFF) analog audio input
connector. This parameter cannot be directly adjusted. When the
ANLG IN LVL menu AUTO parameter is ON, the AUTO GAIN
parameter indicates the amount of automatic input level
adjustment.
When AUTO GAIN is set to ON
Level meters appear in combinations of green, yellow and red when
the on-screen display is configured for a blue-screen background.
Green indicates low levels; yellow indicates normal levels; and red
indicates the onset of overload. Occasional flashes from yellow into
red are normal peak indicators. Level meters appear in white when
the on-screen display is not configured for a blue-screen
background.
DVD1 ANLG IN LVL
The AUTO parameter...
AUTO
MANUAL
ON
+0dB
is reflected by the AUTOGAIN value
AUTO GAIN
+0.0dB
3-10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
VIDEO IN
COMPOSITE-1 TO 5, S-VIDEO-1 TO 8, NONE
COMPONENT IN
COMPONENT 1 to 4
DVD1
DVD1
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
SETUP
INPUTS
SETUP
INPUTS
Opens the VIDEO IN menu, to assign a composite or S-video input
connector for the selected input.
Opens the COMPONENT IN menu, to assign a component video
input connector for the selected input.
Note:
Note:
•
Composite video output connectors are available only when a
composite video source is present.
Component video output connectors are only available when a
component video source is present.
•
S-video output connectors are available when an S-video or Com-
posite source is present.
SETUP
MAIN MENU
INPUT SETUP
DVD1 VIDEO IN
DVD1 INPUT SETUP
NAME
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
DVD1
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
COMPOSITE-1
COMPOSITE-2
COMPOSITE-3
COMPOSITE-4
COMPOSITE-5
S-VIDEO-1
S-VIDEO-2
S-VIDEO-3
S-VIDEO-4
S-VIDEO-5
S-VIDEO-6
S-VIDEO-7
S-VIDEO-8
NONE
DVD1
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
COAX-1
NONE
AUTO
S-VIDEO-1
1
VCR
CD
FILM
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
D
5.1 FILM
FILM
5.1a
MIC
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
RECORD ADVANCED
DVD1 COMPONENT IN
COMPONENT-1
COMPONENT-2
COMPONENT-3
COMPONENT-4
3-11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
SELECTING PREFERRED LISTENING MODES
The MC-12 allows the selection of five preferred listening modes for
each Main Zone input: one listening mode each for 2-channel,
Dolby Digital, DTS(-ES), 5.1-channel analog, and MIC (LIVE!)
sources. The table below indicates the INPUT SETUP menu param-
eters that can be used to select preferred listening modes.
When a preferred listening mode is selected, it is activated
whenever a new input is selected or an appropriate input source is
present. (In the menus at the bottom of the page, the INPUT SETUP
menu has been modified for the following examples.)
The following example describes when a preferred listening mode is
activated:
Preferred Listening Mode Selection Parameters
2-CH Selects a preferred listening mode for 2-channel sources
If the DVD1 input is selected and a 2-channel source is present, the
L7 FILM listening mode is activated. If a 5.1-channel analog source
is present, the 5.1a L7 FILM listening mode is activated. If a
DTS(-ES) source is present, the DTS(-ES) L7 FILM listening mode is
activated.
Selects a preferred listening mode for Dolby Digital sources
Selects a preferred listening mode for DTS(-ES) sources
D
5.1a Selects a preferred listening mode for 5.1-channel analog sources
MIC Selects a preferred listening mode for microphone source (LIVE!)
Menus showing DVD1 parameters selected as preferred listening modes.
MAIN MENU
INPUT SETUP
SETUP
DVD1 INPUT SETUP
DVD1
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
NAME
DVD1
COAX1
NONE
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
DVD1 2-CH MODE
AUTO
FILM
TV
MUSIC
MUSIC SURR
PLII +
PLII MOVIE
S-VIDEO-1
1
FILM
5.1 FILM
FILM
VCR
CD
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
D
PLII MUSIC
5.1a
MIC
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
RECORD ADVANCED
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
PL +
PRO LOGIC
NIGHTCLUB
CONCERT HALL
CHURCH
DVD1
D MODE
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
5.1 FILM
5.1
5.1
TV
MUSIC
CATHEDRAL
PANORAMA
2-CH SURROUND
2-CHANNEL
MONO LOGIC
MONO SURROUND
MONO
DVD1
MODE
FILM
MUSIC
DVD1 5.1a MODE
DIGITAL
5.1a
5.1a
5.1a
5.1a STANDARD
5.1a 2-CHANNEL
USE LAST
FILM
MUSIC
5.1 2-CHANNEL
5.1 MONO LOGIC
5.1 MONO SURR
5.1 MONO
DVD1 MIC MODE
LIVE! SMALL
LIVE! MED
LIVE! LARGE
USE LAST
2-CHAN
USE LAST
USE LAST
USE LAST
3-12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
2-CH
SETUP
D
SETUP
DVD1
D
INPUTS
DVD1
INPUTS
2-CH
Opens the 2-CH MODE menu, which selects a preferred listening
mode for 2-channel input sources. The MC-12 activates the
preferred listening mode whenever a new input is selected or a new
2-channel source is present. When set to USE LAST, the MC-12
automatically uses the listening mode that was activated the last
time a 2-channel source was present.
Opens the Dolby DIGITAL MODE menu, to select a preferred
listening mode for Dolby Digital input sources. The MC-12
automatically activates the preferred listening mode whenever a
new input is selected or a new Dolby Digital source is present.
When the
D parameter is set to USE LAST:
Note:
•
The MC-12 automatically uses the Dolby Digital listening mode
that was activated the last time a Dolby Digital source was
present.
The remote control 2 CH button toggles between the 2-CHANNEL
listening mode and the previous listening mode, and ignores the USE
LAST setting. Instead, it uses the listening mode (for example, L7 FILM)
that was activated before the 2-CHANNEL listening mode.
•
If the 5.1 THX MUSIC listening mode was activated the last
time a Dolby Digital source was present, then the 5.1 THX
MUSIC listening mode is used. Normally, the 5.1 THX MUSIC
listening mode cannot be selected as the preferred listening
mode for Dolby Digital sources.
When the 2-CH parameter is set to USE LAST:
•
•
•
A DTS Neo:6 listening mode is used if a DTS Neo:6 listening mode
was activated the last time a 2-channel source was present.
However, DTS Neo:6 listening modes cannot be selected as the
preferred listening mode for 2-channel sources.
The MC-12 requires the presence of a 44.1kHz or 48kHz PCM
digital source to activate a DTS Neo:6 listening mode. The DTS
Neo:6 listening modes are not available with 88.2kHz or
96kHz, Dolby Digital or analog sources.
A Dolby PLIIx listening mode is used if a Dolby PLIIx listening
mode was activated the last time a 2-channel source was
present. However, the Dolby PLIIx listening modes cannot be
selected as the preferred listening mode for 2-channel sources.
3-13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
SELECTING PREFERRED LISTENING MODES (continued)
5.1a
DVD1
5.1a
SETUP
INPUTS
DVD1
SETUP
INPUTS
Opens the 5.1a MODE menu, which selects a preferred listening
mode for 5.1-channel analog input sources. The MC-12 automati-
cally activates the preferred listening mode whenever a new input is
selected or a new 5.1-channel analog source is present.
Opens the DTS(-ES) MODE menu, which selects a preferred
listening mode for DTS(-ES) input sources. The MC-12 automati-
cally activates the preferred listening mode whenever a new input is
selected or a new DTS(-ES) source is present.
When the DTS(-ES) parameter is set to USE LAST:
When the 5.1a parameter is set to USE LAST:
•
•
The MC-12 uses the listening mode that was activated the last
time a DTS(-ES) source was present.
•
•
The MC-12 uses the listening mode that was activated the last
time a 5.1-channel analog source was present.
The DTS THX MUSIC listening mode is used if this listening
mode was activated the last time a DTS(-ES) source was
present. Normally, the DTS THX MUSIC listening mode cannot
be selected as the preferred listening mode for DTS(-ES)
sources.
The 5.1a THX MUSIC listening mode is used if this listening
mode was activated the last time a 5.1-channel analog source
was present. Normally, the 5.1a THX MUSIC listening mode
cannot be selected as the preferred listening mode for 5.1-
channel analog sources.
MIC
DVD1
MIC
SETUP
INPUTS
Opens the MIC MODE menu, which selects a preferred listening
mode for the LIVE! source. The MC-12 automatically activates the
preferred listening mode when the ANALOG IN selection is LIVE!
When the MIC parameter is set to USE LAST:
•
The MC-12 uses the listening mode that was activated the last
time a MIC source was present.
3-14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
CONFIGURING ADVANCED INPUT SETTINGS
SETUP
MAIN MENU
INPUT SETUP
DVD1 MAIN ADV
DIGITAL
ANALOG
AUTO
DVD1 INPUT SETUP
NAME
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
DVD1
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
DVD1
DIGITAL
OFF
AUTO
ON
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
COMPONENT OSD
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
COAX-1
NONE
AUTO
OFF
AUTO
S-VIDEO-1
1
OFF
VCR
CD
ON
OFF
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
FILM
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
D
5.1 FILM
FILM
5.1a
MIC
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
ANLG
DMIX
RECORD IN
RECORD ADVANCED
The MC-12 allows the assignment of one digital and one analog
audio input connector for each input. The table below indicates the
INPUT SETUP menu parameters that can be used to control the
interaction of these connectors, as well as other advanced Main
Zone, Zone 2, and Record Zone input settings.
The parameters on the left side of the MAIN ADV menu are identical
regardless of which input is selected. The parameter settings on the
right side are adjustable. The MAIN ADV menu shown in the
Appendix indicates factory-default parameter settings for each input.
Parameter
Possible Settings
Parameter
Possible Settings
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
COMPONENT OSD
DIGITAL, ANALOG, AUTO
ON, OFF
AUTO, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
Refer to the next column
DIGITAL, ANLG, DMIX
DIGITAL, ANLG, DMIX
Refer to 3-20
RECORD ADVANCED
MAIN ADVANCED
SETUP
INPUTS
DVD1
MAIN ADVANCED
The MAIN ADV menu controls the interaction of the digital and analog
audio input connectors assigned to the current Main Zone input, and
other advanced Main Zone input settings.
3-15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
CONFIGURING ADVANCED ZONE SETTINGS (continued)
•
•
When LIVE! is the selected analog input, the MAIN
ADVANCED ꢀ INPUT SELECT parameter is forced to ANALOG
and ANALOG BYPASS is disabled.
INPUT SELECT
DIGITAL, ANALOG, AUTO
SETUP
INPUTS
DVD1
MAIN ADVANCED
INPUT SELECT
Controls the interaction of the digital and analog audio input
connectors assigned to the current Main Zone input. The table on
the next page describes INPUT SELECT parameter settings.
When OFF, the MC-12 passes analog input signals through A/D
conversion and internal processing before passing them to the
Main Zone audio output connectors. This allows analog
sources to use bass management, speaker crossovers, speaker
distance calibration, and tone controls.
Note:
Note:
When the Shift button activates the shift command bank, the 7/5
button adjusts the INPUT SELECT parameter by cycling through the
DIGITAL, ANALOG, and AUTO settings.
When the Shift command bank is activated, pressing the 2CH button
toggles ANALOG BYPASS between ON and OFF.
ANALOG BYPASS
ON, OFF
S-VIDEO 16:9
AUTO, OFF
SETUP
INPUTS
DVD1
MAIN ADVANCED
ANALOG BYPASS
SETUP
INPUTS
DVD1
MAIN ADVANCED
S-VIDEO 16:9
Forces analog sources to bypass A/D conversion and internal
processing. When ON, analog input signals pass directly to the
Main Zone audio output connectors.
Controls the passage of anamorphic trigger signals present in some
video sources. When set to AUTO, the MC-12 allows anamorphic
video input signals to pass through the S-video switcher, enabling
compatible display devices to automatically switch between
anamorphic and non-anamorphic display modes.
•
•
When a 2-channel analog source is present, analog input signals
pass directly to the Front L/R output connectors.
When OFF, the MC-12 prevents anamorphic video input signals
from passing through the S-video switcher, preventing compatible
display devices from automatically switching between anamorphic
and non-anamorphic display modes.
When a 5.1-channel analog source is present, analog input
signals pass to the Main Zone audio output connectors as
3-16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
INPUT SELECT PARAMETER SETTINGS
DIGITAL
ANALOG
AUTO
The MC-12 sends the digital audio from the The MC-12 sends the analog audio from the The MC-12 toggles between sending digital or
assigned input to the Main Zone audio assigned input to the Main Zone audio output analog audio input to the Main Zone audio output
output connectors. The assigned analog connectors. The assigned digital audio input connectors based on the input source that is
audio input connector is ignored.
connector is ignored.
present.
The digital audio input connectors are Note the following:
Example:
compatible with PCM (44.1, 48, 88.2,
•
•
•
The MC-12 automatically sets the INPUT
SELECT parameter to ANALOG when no
digital audio input connector is assigned.
•
The MC-12 selects the assigned digital
and 96kHz), Dolby Digital, and DTS(-ES)
sources. The digital audio input
connectors are not compatible with
MPEG or MP3 sources.
audio input when a compatible digital
source is present. The MC-12 does not
select the assigned analog audio input
when a compatible digital source is
present.
The
INPUT
SETUP ꢀ ANALOG
IN
parameter can assign an analog audio
input connector for the selected input.
Note the following:
•
The MC-12 selects the assigned analog
audio input connector when no compatible
digital source is present.
When LIVE! is the selected analog input,
the MAIN ADVANCED ꢀ INPUT SELECT
parameter is forced to ANALOG and
ANALOG BYPASS is disabled.
•
•
The MC-12 automatically sets the
INPUT SELECT parameter to DIGITAL
when no analog audio input
connector is assigned.
•
•
The MC-12 selects the assigned analog
connector if no digital source is present.
The INPUT SETUP ꢀ DIGITAL IN
parameter can assign a digital audio
input connector for the selected
input.
The MC-12 selects the assigned analog
audio input connector when an analog
source, such as an SACD, is present.
Note the following:
•
The MC-12 automatically sets the MAIN
ADVANCED ꢀ INPUT SELECT parameter to
AUTO when both digital and analog audio
input connectors are assigned.
•
Use the AUTO setting for components, such as
DVD/SACD players, that generate both digital
and analog output signals.
3-17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
CONFIGURING ADVANCED ZONE SETTINGS (continued)
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
ON, OFF
COMPONENT OSD
ON, OFF
DVD1
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
DVD1
COMPONENT OSD
MAIN ADVANCED
MAIN ADVANCED
SETUP
INPUTS
SETUP
INPUTS
Controls the on-screen display aspect ratio when the display device
is connected to a Main Zone S-Video output connector. Aspect ratio
refers to the size of the picture or the display device screen. A 4:3
aspect ratio is almost square. A 16:9 aspect ratio, often referred to
as widescreen, is almost twice as wide as it is high.
Controls the appearance of the on-screen display when the display
device is connected to the component video output connector.
When ON, the display device shows the on-screen display as a 480i
video signal on a full blue screen background. To minimize viewing
distractions, the two-line status does not appear in the on-screen
display. When OFF, the display device does not show the on-screen
display, including the two-line status.
When ON, the on-screen display appears in a 4:3 aspect ratio
regardless of the incoming video input signal. When OFF, the on-
screen display appears in the same aspect ratio as the incoming
video input signal.
Note:
When the ON-SCREEN DISPLAY menu BACKGROUND parameter is
OFF, the display device using the component video output connector
will not show the on-screen display.
The on-screen display appears horizontally stretched across the
display device screen when all of the following conditions are
present:
ZONE2 IN & RECORD IN
DIGITAL, ANLG, DMIX
OR
•
•
•
The S-VIDEO OSD (4:3) parameter is OFF.
An anamorphic video input signal is present.
SETUP
INPUTS
DVD1
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
Controls the interaction of the digital and analog audio input
connectors assigned to the current Zone 2 and Record Zone inputs.
The table of the next page describes ZONE2 and RECORD IN
parameter settings.
A 16:9 display device (widescreen) is connected to an S-video
output connector.
CAUTION!
When the ZONE2 or RECORD IN parameter is set to
DIGITAL or ANLG, the MC-12 recognizes some DTS-
encoded sources as audio signals (not data signals) and
outputs loud digital noise from the Zone 2 or Record Zone
audio output connectors.
3-18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
ZONE2 & RECORD IN PARAMETER SETTINGS
DIGITAL
ANLG (Analog)
DMIX (Downmix)
The MC-12 passes a downmixed version of Main Zone audio to the
Zone 2 or Record Zone audio output connectors. Zones cannot be
independently monitored. Downmixing is possible when all of the
following conditions are met:
The MC-12 passes digital audio The MC-12 passes analog audio from
from the the assigned input to the the assigned input to the Zone 2
the Zone 2 or Record Zone audio or Record Zone audio output
output connectors. The assigned connectors. The assigned digital audio
analog audio input is ignored. input is ignored. Zones can be
Zones can be independently independently monitored.
monitored.
•
The same input is selected in both Main Zone and Zone 2 or in
both Main Zone and Record Zone. Otherwise, the Zone 2 or
Record Zone audio output connectors will mute.
Note the following:
•
The 5.1a BYPASS listening mode is not activated.
Note the following:
•
The MC-12 passes analog sources
to all Zone 2 or Record Zone
audio output connectors.
•
The MC-12 passes digital
sources to all Zone 2 or Record
Zone audio output connectors.
Note the following:
•
•
A downmix of all channels is sent to Zone 2.
•
The MC-12 passes analog input
signals directly to the Zone 2 or
Record Zone analog audio output
connectors. The MC-12 converts
analog input signals to digital
(A/D conversion) before passing
them to the Record Zone digital
audio output connectors.
•
The MC-12 passes digital input
signals directly to the Record
Zone digital audio output
connectors. The MC-12 sends
digital input signals through
D/A conversion before passing
them to the Zone 2 or Record
Zone analog audio output
connectors.
Main Zone listening mode activation affects the Zone 2 and
Record Zone audio output connectors. For example, when the
MONO listening mode is activated, the Zone 2 and Record Zone
audio output connectors will generate mono output signals.
•
•
Set the ZONE2 IN and RECORD IN parameters to DMIX when
using a playback device (DVD player) that does not have built-in
Dolby Digital or DTS(-ES) decoding, and the recording device is a
VCR or Personal Video Recorder (PVR).
•
•
When no digital audio input is
assigned, ZONE2 IN and
RECORD IN are set to ANALOG.
The MC-12 automatically downmixes multi-channel sources
(except LOGIC 7 FILM and MUSIC sources) to stereo output
signals for listening and recording. Also, 5.1-channel analog
sources can be downmixed when the MAIN
ADVANCED ꢀ ANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to OFF. Upon
playback, these downmixes are compatible with matrix decoders,
but sound best through a Logic 7 listening mode.
•
•
When no analog audio input is
assigned, ZONE2 IN and
RECORD IN are set to DIGITAL.
The INPUT SETUP menu
ANALOG IN parameter can be
used to assign an analog audio
input connector for the selected
input.
The INPUT SETUP menu
DIGITAL IN parameter can be
used to assign a digital audio
input connector for the
selected input.
3-19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
CONFIGURING ADVANCED ZONE SETTINGS (continued)
RECORD ADVANCED
ANLG IN LVL
-18 to +12dB
SETUP
INPUTS
DVD1
RECORD ADVANCED
SETUP
INPUTS
DVD1
RECORD ADVANCED
ANLG IN LVL
Opens the RECORD ADV menu, which configures advanced Record
Zone input settings.
Allows adjustment of analog audio input levels for input signals sent to
the Record Zone digital audio output connectors. Adjustments are
applied to input signals before passing them to the Record Zone digital
audio output connectors. This parameter can be adjusted when an input
source is present to prevent the internal A/D converter from overloading.
The parameters on the left side of the RECORD ADV menu are
identical regardless of the selected input. The parameter settings on
the right side are adjustable. The RECORD ADV menu shown in the
Appendix indicates factory-default parameter settings.
DIGITAL BYPASS
ON, OFF
SETUP
INPUTS
DVD1
RECORD ADVANCED
DIGITAL BYPASS
Parameter
Possible Settings
Allows direct digital recording (digital sources bypass sample rate
conversion). When ON, digital input signals pass directly to the
Record Zone digital audio output connectors, preserving the
original input signal sample rate. When OFF, the sample rate of the
digital signals is converted, then passed to the Record Zone digital
audio output connectors. The sample rate of the output signal then
matches the sample rate of the recording device. DIG OUT RATE
parameter settings have no effect when the DIGITAL BYPASS
parameter is set to ON.
ANLG IN LVL
DIGITAL BYPASS
DIG OUT RATE
RECORD
-18 to +12dB
ON, OFF
INPUT, 96kHz, 88.2kHz, 48kHz, 44.1kHz
BLOCKED, ENABLED
MAIN MENU
INPUT SETUP
SETUP
DVD1 RECORD ADV
DVD1 INPUT SETUP
NAME
-18 to +12dB
DVD1
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
VCR
CD
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
ANLG IN LVL
DIGITAL BYPASS
DVD1
+0dB
OFF
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
COAX-1
NONE
ON
OFF
DIG OUT RATE
RECORD
44.1kHz
ENABLED
AUTO
S-VIDEO-1
1
INPUT
96kHz
88.2 kHz
48kHz
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
FILM
D
5.1 FILM
FILM
44.1kHz
5.1a
MIC
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
BLOCKED
ENABLED
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
RECORD ADVANCED
3-20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
DIG OUT RATE
INPUT, 44.1kHz, 48kHz, 88.2kHz, 96kHz
RECORD
BLOCKED, ENABLED
SETUP
INPUTS
DVD1
RECORD ADVANCED
DIG OUT RATE
SETUP
INPUTS
DVD1
RECORD ADVANCED
RECORD
Controls the sample rate of digital and analog input signals sent to
the Record Zone digital audio output connectors. When INPUT is
selected, the sample rate of input signals is not converted.
Therefore, the original sample rate is maintained from the input
connectors through to the Record Zone digital audio output
connectors.
Prevents recording device feedback loops. When BLOCKED is
selected, the MC-12 blocks the Record Zone audio output
connectors to prevent feedback loops. However, video input signals
are still passed to the Record Zone video output connectors. When
ENABLED is selected, audio and video input signals are passed to
the Record Zone audio and video output connectors.
When a value is selected, input signals pass through the selected
value of sample rate conversion, then pass to the Record Zone
digital audio output connectors. Set the DIG OUT RATE parameter
to the appropriate value when using a recording format that
operates on a single sample rate, such as CD-R format (44.1kHz).
3-21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
SPEAKER SETUP
Note:
SETUP
SPEAKERS
The MC-12 Balanced also includes 10 balanced Main Zone audio
output connectors labeled Front L/R, Center, LFE, Subwoofer L/R, Side
L/R, and Rear L/R. Two additional audio output connectors labeled Aux
L/R are provided for future expansion.
Selecting the SETUP menu SPEAKERS option opens the SPEAKER
SETUP menu, which configures the Main Zone audio output
connectors for the desired speaker setup. The Main Zone includes
10 unbalanced audio output connectors labeled Front L/R, Center,
LFE, Subwoofer L/R, Side L/R, and Rear L/R. Two additional audio
output connectors labeled Aux L/R are provided for future
expansion.
C
R
O
S
S
OV
E
R
S
ETUP
SETUP
MAIN MENU
SPEAKER SETUP
CUSTOM SETUP
THX SETUP
RR
80Hz
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
MANUAL
R
SR
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
C
M
SUB
L
SL
RL
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
Note:
SETTING CROSSOVER POINTS
It is important to set crossover points before calibrating output levels or
LIVE! Otherwise, setting crossover points afterwards could invalidate
calibrated output levels and will invalidate the LIVE! calibration.
SET CROSSOVERS
SETUP
SPEAKERS
Selecting the SPEAKER SETUP menu SET CROSSOVERS option
opens the CROSSOVER SETUP menu, which configures a custom or
THX speaker setup.
3-22
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
CUSTOM SETUP
MAIN MENU
SETUP
SPEAKER SETUP
C
R
O
S
S
OV
E
R
S
ETUP
FRONT L/R
CENTER
SIDE L/R
REAR L/R
SUB L/R
SUB XOVER
LFE
80 Hz
80 Hz
80 Hz
80 Hz
MONO
80 Hz
OFF
INPUTS
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
CUSTOM SETUP
THX SETUP
RR
80Hz
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
MANUAL
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
R
SR
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
TRIGGERS
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
LOCK OPTIONS
C
ULTRA2 SUB OFF
LIVE! CALIBRATION
BGC
ASA
N/A
APART
M
SUB
L
SL
RL
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
CUSTOM SPEAKER SETUPS
SETUP
SPEAKERS
SET CROSSOVERS
CUSTOM SETUP
Selecting the CROSSOVER SETUP menu CUSTOM SETUP option
opens the CUSTOM SETUP menu, which assigns independent
crossover points for each Main Zone audio output connector.
Crossover points can be selected in 10Hz increments within a 30 to
120Hz range. The graphs shown on the next page indicate the
frequency response of each crossover point.
•
Select the subwoofer crossover point equal to the lowest
crossover point of any of the other speakers. For example, if
CUSTOM SETUP menu parameters are set as shown above, set
the SUB XOVER parameter to 80Hz – the lowest crossover point
of the other speakers.
In a custom setup, low frequencies are generally redirected from
speakers with the highest crossover points to speakers with the
lowest crossover points. Signals lower than the lowest crossover
point are redirected to the subwoofer. If the lowest crossover point
is FULL, low frequency signals, excluding LFE information, are not
redirected to the subwoofer.
To configure a custom speaker setup:
•
Select the crossover point closest to the low frequency rating of
the associated speakers. For example, set the FRONT L/R
parameter to the crossover point closest to the low frequency
rating of the front speakers.
Low frequencies between the Subwoofer L/R and any or all of the
other speaker channels can be duplicated. To do this, select the
FULL + SUB crossover setting for the front, center, side or rear
speakers. Making this selection can result in excessive bass.
3-23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
SETTING CROSSOVER POINTS (continued)
High-pass Filter
Low-pass Filter
High-pass filters attenuate low frequencies at 24dB per octave. The curves in the graph
above indicate the frequency response of each crossover setting. From left to right, the
curves represent crossover settings from 30Hz to 120Hz. The graph above does not
show the THX 80Hz crossover point, which is 12dB per octave.
Low-pass filters attenuate high frequencies at 24dB per octave. The curves in the graph
above indicate the frequency response of each crossover setting. From left to right, the
curves represent crossover settings from 30Hz to 120Hz.
3-24
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
C
R
O
S
S
OV
E
R
S
ETUP
SETUP
C
R
O
S
S
OV
E
R
S
ETUP
SPEAKER SETUP
THX SPEAKER SETUP
THX SETUP
CUSTOM SETUP
THX SETUP
RR
80Hz
!CAUTION!
PRESSING THE
BUTTON WILL
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
CUSTOM SETUP
THX SETUP
RR
80Hz
FRONT L/R
CENTER
SIDE L/R
REAR L/R
SUB L/R
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
MONO
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
MANUAL
AUTOMATICALLY CHANGE
THE OUTPUTS TO A THX
SPEAKER
R
SR
R
SR
SUB XOVER THX 80Hz
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
LFE
OFF
ULTRA2 SUB OFF
N/A
CONFIGURATION
C
C
80Hz
BGC
ASA
M
SUB
M
SUB
APART
L
SL
RL
80Hz
L
SL
RL
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
THX SPEAKER SETUPS
When a THX speaker setup is selected, the MC-12 applies a THX
80Hz crossover point with a 12dB-per-octave filter to the Front L/R,
Center, Side L/R, and Rear L/R output connectors. The MC-12
applies a THX 80Hz crossover point with a 24dB-per-octave filter to
the Subwoofer L/R output connectors.
SET CROSSOVERS
THX SETUP
SETUP
SPEAKERS
Selecting CROSSOVER SETUPꢀTHX SETUP opens the THX SPEAKER
SETUP screen, which indicates that pressing the ꢀarrow button will
automatically configure the Main Zone audio output connectors for
a THX speaker setup. You should use THX-certified speakers in a
THX speaker setup.
Notes:
•
A THX speaker setup is not required to activate THX listening
modes.
When the THX SPEAKER SETUP screen opens:
•
In the THX SETUP menu, only the REAR L/R, THX ULTRA2 SUB,
BGC, and ASA parameters can be changed.
•
Press theꢀarrow button to configure the Main Zone audio
output connectors for a THX speaker setup. The THX SETUP
menu will open on the on-screen display.
•
Press theꢃarrow button to close the message without config-
uring the Main Zone audio output connectors for a THX
speaker setup.
3-25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
SPEAKER SETUP PARAMETERS
SETUP
SPEAKERS
SET CROSSOVERS
CUSTOM SETUP
SET CROSSOVERS
THX SETUP
SETUP
SPEAKERS
or
The table below indicates the speaker setup parameters for config-
uring the Main Zone audio output connectors for the desired
speaker setup. These parameters are available on the CUSTOM
SETUP and THX SETUP menus.
Speaker setup parameters perform the same function regardless of
the selected speaker setup. When a parameter setting is adjusted on
one menu, the corresponding parameter setting is automatically
adjusted on the other menu. For example, when a THX speaker
setup is selected, the speaker setup parameters on the CUSTOM
SETUP menu are set to THX 80Hz.
CUSTOM SETUP Menu
THX SETUP Menu
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Setting
Default Setting
Possible Settings
THX 80Hz
FRONT L/R*
CENTER*
SIDE L/R*
REAR L/R
SUB L/R*
SUB XOVER*
LFE*
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
MONO
80Hz
OFF
FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz
FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz, NONE
FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz, NONE
FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz, NONE
MONO, STEREO, NONE
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
MONO
THX 80Hz
ON
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz, NONE
MONO
FULL, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz
ON, OFF
THX 80Hz
ON
THX ULTRA2 SUB
BGC
OFF
ON, OFF
OFF
ON, OFF
N/A†
APART
ON, OFF
N/A†
ON, OFF
ASA
APART, CLOSE, TOGETHER
APART
APART, CLOSE, TOGETHER
* These parameters cannot be adjusted on the THX SETUP menu.
† When the THX ULTRA2 SUB parameter is set to OFF, the BGC parameter is not available (N/A).
3-26
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
CUSTOM SETUP
SETUP
C
R
O
S
S
OV
E
R
S
ETUP
SPEAKER SETUP
MAIN MENU
FRONT L/R
CENTER
SIDE L/R
REAR L/R
SUB L/R
SUB XOVER
LFE
40Hz
60Hz
60Hz
60Hz
MONO
40Hz
OFF
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
CUSTOM SETUP
THX SETUP
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
MANUAL
R
SR
RR
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
C
ULTRA2 SUB OFF
BGC
ASA
N/A
APART
M
SUB
L
SL
RL
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
SUB XOVER
SUBWOOFERS L/R
REAR L/R SPEAKERS
SIDE L/R SPEAKERS
CENTER SPEAKER
FRONT L/R SPEAKERS
FULL
MONO
FULL
FULL
FULL
FULL
30Hz
STEREO
FULL + SUB
FULL + SUB
FULL + SUB
FULL + SUB
40Hz
NONE
30Hz
30Hz
30Hz
30Hz
50Hz
40Hz
40Hz
40Hz
40Hz
60Hz
50Hz
50Hz
50Hz
50Hz
70Hz
60Hz
60Hz
60Hz
60Hz
80Hz
70Hz
70Hz
70Hz
70Hz
THX 80Hz
90Hz
100Hz
110Hz
120Hz
80Hz
THX 80Hz
90Hz
100Hz
110Hz
120Hz
NONE
80Hz
THX 80Hz
90Hz
100Hz
110Hz
120Hz
NONE
80Hz
THX 80Hz
90Hz
100Hz
110Hz
120Hz
NONE
80Hz
THX 80Hz
90Hz
100Hz
110Hz
120Hz
•
•
Select FULL to send a full-range signal to the front speakers.
Otherwise, select the crossover point closest to the low
frequency rating of the front speakers.
FRONT L/R
FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz
SETUP
SPEAKERS
SET CROSSOVERS
CUSTOM SETUP
FRONT L/R
Select FULL + SUB to send a full-range signal to the front
speakers and duplicate bass frequencies to the SUB L/R
outputs. (The set crossover point of the SUB L/R parameter
determines the upper range of duplicate bass.) Selecting the
FULL + SUB option can result in excessive bass.
Assigns a crossover point for the Main Zone audio output
connectors labeled FRONT L/R when a custom speaker setup is
selected. Opens the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS menu to select a
crossover point for the FRONT L/R output connectors.
3-27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
SETTING CROSSOVER POINTS (continued)
SIDE L/R
FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz, NONE
SET CROSSOVERS
THX SETUP
SETUP
SPEAKERS
SETUP
SPEAKERS
SET CROSSOVERS
CUSTOM SETUP
SIDE L/R
When a THX speaker setup is selected, a THX 80Hz crossover point
is applied to the FRONT L/R output connectors, and the FRONT L/R
parameter cannot be adjusted.
Assigns a crossover point for the Main Zone audio output connector
labeled SIDE L/R when a custom speaker setup is selected. Opens
the SIDE L/R SPEAKERS menu to select a crossover point for the SIDE
L/R output connectors.
CENTER
FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz, NONE
•
Select FULL to send a full-range signal to the side speakers.
Otherwise, select the crossover point closest to the low
frequency rating of the side speakers.
SETUP
SPEAKERS
SET CROSSOVERS
CUSTOM SETUP
CENTER
Assigns a crossover point for the Main Zone audio output connector
labeled CENTER when a custom speaker setup is selected. Opens
the CENTER SPEAKER menu to select a crossover point for the
CENTER output connector.
•
Select FULL + SUB to send a full-range signal to the side
speakers and duplicate bass frequencies to the SUB L/R
outputs. (The set crossover point of the SUB L/R parameter
determines the upper range of duplicate bass.) Selecting the
FULL + SUB option can result in excessive bass.
•
Select FULL to send a full-range signal to the center speaker.
Otherwise, select the crossover point closest to the low
frequency rating of the center speaker.
•
Select NONE when the speaker setup does not include side
speakers. The MC-12 will redirect side channel signals to the
Rear L/R output connectors. If the REAR L/R parameter is also
set to NONE, the MC-12 will redirect surround channel signals
to the Front L/R output connectors.
•
Select FULL + SUB to send a full-range signal to the center
speaker and duplicate bass frequencies to the SUB L/R outputs.
(The set crossover point of the SUB L/R parameter determines
the upper range of duplicate bass.) Selecting the FULL + SUB
option can result in excessive bass.
Note:
When the SIDE L/R parameter is set to NONE, Dolby Digital Surround
EX, THX Ultra2, THX Surround EX, DTS(-ES) decoding, the ASA
parameter, and PLIIx modes are not available.
•
Select NONE when the speaker setup does not include a center
speaker. The MC-12 then redirects center channel signals to the
Front L/R output connectors – unless the 5.1a BYPASS listening
mode is activated. In this case, configure the speaker setup with the
associated DVD-A/SACD player to redirect center channel signals.
SET CROSSOVERS
THX SETUP
SETUP
SPEAKERS
When a THX speaker setup is selected, a THX 80Hz crossover point
is applied to the SIDE L/R output connectors, and the SIDE L/R
parameter cannot be adjusted.
SET CROSSOVERS
THX SETUP
SETUP
SPEAKERS
When a THX speaker setup is selected, a THX 80Hz crossover point
is applied to the Center output connector, and the CENTER
parameter cannot be adjusted.
3-28
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
SETUP
SPEAKER SETUP
C
R
O
S
S
OV
E
R
S
E
TUP
THX SETUP
MAIN MENU
THX SPEAKER SETUP
FRONT L/R
CENTER
SIDE L/R
REAR L/R
SUB L/R
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
MONO
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
!CAUTION!
PRESSING THE
BUTTON WILL
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
CUSTOM SETUP
THX SETUP
RR
80Hz
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
MANUAL
AUTOMATICALLY CHANGE
THE OUTPUTS TO A THX
SPEAKER
R
SR
SUB XOVER THX 80Hz
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
LFE
OFF
ULTRA2 SUB OFF
N/A
CONFIGURATION
C
BGC
ASA
M
SUB
APART
L
SL
RL
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
THX REAR SPEAKERS
THX 80Hz
NONE
REAR L/R FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz, NONE
SET CROSSOVERS
THX SETUP
REAR L/R
SETUP
SPEAKERS
SETUP
SPEAKERS
SET CROSSOVERS
CUSTOM SETUP
REAR L/R
When a THX speaker setup is selected, the REAR L/R parameter
opens the THX REAR SPEAKERS menu shown above, to activate and
deactivate the REAR L/R output connectors.
Assigns a crossover point for the Main Zone audio output connector
labeled REAR L/R when a custom speaker setup is selected. Opens
the REAR L/R SPEAKERS menu to select a crossover point for the
REAR L/R output connectors.
•
Select THX 80Hz to activate and configure the Rear L/R output
connectors for a 7.1-channel THX speaker setup.
•
Select NONE to deactivate the Rear L/R output connectors,
configuring the Main Zone audio output connectors for a
5.1-channel THX speaker setup.
•
Select FULL to send a full-range signal to the rear speakers.
Otherwise, select the crossover point closest to the low
frequency rating of the rear speakers.
•
Select FULL + SUB to send a full-range signal to the rear
speakers and duplicate bass frequencies to the SUB L/R
outputs. (The set crossover point of the SUB L/R parameter
determines the upper range of duplicate bass.) Selecting the
FULL + SUB option can result in excessive bass.
Note:
When the REAR L/R parameter is set to NONE, Dolby Digital Surround
EX, THX Ultra2, THX Surround EX, and PLIIx modes, DTS(-ES) decoding,
and the ASA parameter are not available.
•
Select NONE when the speaker setup does not include rear speakers.
The MC-12 then redirects rear channel signals to the Side L/R output
connectors. If the SIDE L/R parameter is also set to NONE, surround
channel signals are sent to the Front L/R output connectors.
3-29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
SETTING CROSSOVER POINTS (continued)
SUB L/R
MONO, STEREO, NONE
SUB XOVER
FULL, 30 to 120Hz, THX 80Hz, NONE
SETUP
SPEAKERS
SET CROSSOVERS
CUSTOM SETUP
SUB XOVER
SETUP
SPEAKERS
SET CROSSOVERS
CUSTOM SETUP
SUB L/R
Assigns a crossover point for the Main Zone audio output
connectors labeled SUBWOOFER L/R when a custom speaker setup
is selected. Opens the SUB XOVER menu to select a crossover point
for the SUBWOOFER L/R output connectors.
Configures the Main Zone audio output connectors labeled
SUBWOOFER L/R for a speaker setup that includes one, two, or no
subwoofer(s).
When a custom speaker setup is selected, the SUB L/R parameter
opens the SUBWOOFERS L/R menu, to select a configuration for the
SUBWOOFER L/R output connectors.
Select FULL to send a full-range signal to the subwoofer(s).
Otherwise, select the crossover point equal to the lowest crossover
point of the other speakers.
•
Select MONO if the speaker setup includes one subwoofer. The
MC-12 sends low frequency front, center, and surround
channel signals to the SUBWOOFER L/R output connectors.
SET CROSSOVERS
THX SETUP
SETUP
SPEAKERS
When a THX speaker setup is selected, a THX 80Hz crossover point
is applied to the SUBWOOFER L/R output connectors, and the
SUB L/R parameter cannot be adjusted.
•
Select STEREO if the speaker setup includes two subwoofers.
The MC-12 sends low frequency front left, center, and
surround left channel signals to the SUBWOOFER L output
connector and low frequency front right, center, and surround
right channel signals to the SUBWOOFER R output connector.
LFE
ON, OFF
SETUP
SPEAKERS
SET CROSSOVERS
CUSTOM SETUP
LFE
•
Select NONE if the speaker setup does not include a subwoofer.
The MC-12 redirects low frequency signals to the speakers with
the lowest crossover points – unless the 5.1a BYPASS listening
mode is activated. In this instance, configure the speaker setup
with the associated DVD-A/SACD player to redirect low
frequency signals.
Activates and deactivates the Main Zone audio output connector
labeled LFE when a custom speaker setup is selected.
When a custom speaker setup is selected:
•
•
Select ON to activate the LFE output connector. LFE information is
SET CROSSOVERS
THX SETUP
SETUP
SPEAKERS
sent to the LFE output connector.
When a THX speaker setup is selected, the SUBWOOFER L/R output
connectors are configured for a speaker setup that includes one
subwoofer, and the SUB L/R parameter cannot be adjusted.
Select OFF to deactivate the LFE output connector. LFE signals
are redirected to the SUBWOOFER L/R output connectors. If
the SUB L/R parameter is set to OFF, LFE signals are redirected
to the speakers with the lowest crossover point.
3-30
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
THX ULTRA2 SUB
ON, OFF
ULTRA2 SUB
ULTRA2 SUB
SET CROSSOVERS
THX SETUP
SETUP
SPEAKERS
SETUP
SPEAKERS
SET CROSSOVERS
SET CROSSOVERS
CUSTOM SETUP
THX SETUP
When a THX speaker setup is selected, the LFE information is redirected to
the SUBWOOFER L/R output connectors, and the LFE parameter cannot
be adjusted.
or
SETUP
SPEAKERS
Enables boundary gain compensation (BGC) for THX Ultra2-
certified subwoofers.
SETUP
SPEAKER SETUP
C
R
O
S
S
OV
E
R
S
ETUP
MAIN MENU
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
CUSTOM SETUP
THX SETUP
RR
80Hz
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
MANUAL
R
SR
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
C
M
SUB
L
SL
RL
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
THX SETUP
CUSTOM SETUP
THX SPEAKER SETUP
ON
OFF
FRONT L/R
CENTER
SIDE L/R
REAR L/R
SUB L/R
THX 80Hz
FRONT L/R
CENTER
SIDE L/R
REAR L/R
SUB L/R
SUB XOVER
LFE
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
MONO
80Hz
OFF
!CAUTION!
PRESSING THE
BUTTON WILL
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
MONO
APART
CLOSE
TOGETHER
AUTOMATICALLY CHANGE
THE OUTPUTS TO A THX
SPEAKER CONFIGURATION
SUB XOVER THX 80Hz
LFE
OFF
ULTRA2 SUB OFF
N/A
ULTRA2 SUB OFF
BGC
ASA
BGC
ASA
N/A
APART
APART
•
Select ON if the subwoofer using the Main Zone audio output
connectors labeled Subwoofer L/R is THX Ultra2-certified.
When ON is selected, the BGC parameter can be used to adjust
boundary gain compensation.
•
Select OFF if the subwoofer using the Main Zone audio output
connectors labeled Subwoofer L/R is not THX Ultra2-certified.
When OFF is selected, the BGC parameter is not available
(N/A).
3-31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
To maximize the effectiveness of ASA processing, configure a
7.1-channel speaker setup so the rear speakers are placed close
together facing the center of the listening space.
BGC (BOUNDARY GAIN COMPENSATION)
ON, OFF
SETUP
SPEAKERS
SET CROSSOVERS
CUSTOM SETUP
BGC
BGC
or SETUP
SPEAKERS
SET CROSSOVERS
THX SETUP
•
•
•
Select APART if the distance between the rear speakers is
greater than 4 feet (1.2m).
Adjusts boundary gain compensation when the THX ULTRA2 SUB
parameter is set to ON.
Select CLOSE if the distance between the rear speakers is
greater than 1 foot (0.3m), but less than 4 feet (1.2m).
Select TOGETHER if the distance between the rear speakers is
less than 1 foot (0.3m).
•
•
Select ON to apply a highpass 55Hz filter to all Main Zone
audio output connectors and listening modes.
Select OFF, and no filtering is applied to the Main Zone audio
output connectors and listening modes.
You can use the remote control 7/5 button to toggle between
7- and 5-channel playback. When you use the 7/5 button , the
MC-12 automatically:
Note:
•
•
•
Activates ASA processing during 7-channel playback.
Deactivates ASA processing during 5-channel playback.
Switches between the 5.1 THX ULTRA2 and THX, DTS THX ULTRA2
and DTS THX, or 5.1a THX ULTRA2 and 5.1a THX listening modes.
BGC compensates for increased bass energy that is caused by the
proximity of the speakers to the listening room walls.
ASA (ADVANCED SPEAKER ARRAY)
ON, OFF
SETUP
SPEAKERS
SET CROSSOVERS
CUSTOM SETUP
ASA
ASA
or SETUP
SPEAKERS
SET CROSSOVERS
THX SETUP
ASA is a proprietary THX technology that processes rear channel signals to
optimize the listening experience for THX Ultra2 listening modes, including
5.1 THX ULTRA2, 5.1 THX MUSIC, DTS THX ULTRA2, DTS THX MUSIC,
5.1a THX ULTRA2, or 5.1a THX MUSIC. Applied to film sources, ASA
processing blends surround channel signals to optimize ambient and direc-
tional surround sounds. Applied to music sources, ASA processing places
surround channel signals on a wide, stable rear soundstage.
ASA processing is not available unless:
•
•
One of the THX ULTRA2 listening modes is activated.
Both side and rear speakers are present.
The ASA parameter can be changed in any mode, but the change
will have no effect unless the above conditions are met.
3-32
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
CALIBRATING SPEAKER DISTANCES & OUTPUT LEVELS
The MC-12 offers both automatic and manual calibration of speaker distances and output levels. Calibration helps to ensure accurate output
signal arrival time and level at the primary listening position. However, it is not a substitute for proper speaker placement.
Before calibrating speaker distances and output levels:
SPEAKER CALIBRATION PARAMETERS
The table on the next page indicates the speaker calibration param-
eters that can be used to set speaker distances and output levels for
the speakers connected to the corresponding Main Zone audio
output connectors. These parameters are available on the speaker
distance and output level menus shown throughout this section. All
parameters perform the same function whether automatic or
manual calibration is selected.
•
Set crossover points for the Main Zone audio output connec-
tors. Setting crossover points afterwards could invalidate
calibrated output levels. (The CUSTOM or THX SETUP menu
can be used to set crossover points.)
•
•
Eliminate extraneous noise in the listening space, including
conversation, air conditioners, and sounds that filter in through
open doors and windows.
Move or remove objects – including people – blocking the
line-of-sight path between the microphones or SPL meter and the
speakers.
SPEAKER DISTANCE PARAMETERS +0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m
Determine the distance between the primary listening position and
the speaker connected to the corresponding Main Zone audio
output connector.
OUTPUT LEVEL PARAMETERS
-18.0db to +12.0dB
Determine the output level of signals sent to the speaker connected
to the corresponding Main Zone audio output connector.
3-33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
UNITS
FEET, METERS
SETUP
SPEAKERS
MANUAL
SPEAKER DISTANCES
UNITS
Determines the unit of measurement in which speaker distances are calculated on ALL speaker distance menus. When FEET is selected, the
MC-12 calculates speaker distances in feet. When METERS is selected, the MC-12 calculates speaker distances in meters. When the UNITS
parameter setting is adjusted, the MC-12 automatically adjusts speaker distances to the closest available value in the selected unit of
measurement.
Speaker Distance Settings
Output Level Settings
Default Setting
Possible Setting
Default Setting
Possible Setting
Parameter
FRONT L/R
+0.0ft
+0.0ft
+0.0ft
+0.0ft
+0.0ft
+0.0ft
+0.0ft
+0.0ft
N/A†
N/A†
FEET
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m
FEET, METERS
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
N/A†
-18.0 to +12.0dB
-18.0 to +12.0dB
-18.0 to +12.0dB
-18.0 to +12.0dB
-18.0 to +12.0dB
-18.0 to +12.0dB
-18.0 to +12.0dB
-18.0 to +12.0dB
-18.0 to +12.0dB
-18.0 to +12.0dB
CENTER
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE LEFT
REAR LEFT
REAR RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
MONO SUB*
SUB RIGHT
LFE
N/A†
UNITS
* When one subwoofer is included in the speaker setup, this parameter is labeled MONO SUB. When two subwoofers are included in the speaker setup, this parameter is labeled SUB LEFT.
† When a speaker is not included in the speaker setup, the corresponding speaker distance or output level parameter is not available (N/A).
3-34
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION
The MC-12 offers automatic calibration of speaker distances, output levels, or both. The table below indicates available automatic calibration
options. A successful microphone check is required before automatic calibration can be performed.
Automatic Options
Details
MICROPHONE CHECK
•
•
Confirms that the microphones are properly connected and functioning.
Calculates an average level for the microphones connected to the microphone input connectors,
allowing the MC-12 to compensate for individual microphone sensitivities during automatic calibration.
•
Ensures that microphone levels are consistent, eliminating automatic calibration errors from individual
microphone levels.
DISTANCES & LEVELS
•
•
Activates automatic calibration of speaker distances and output levels.
Offers accurate calibration with minimal interaction, automatically applying calibrated speaker distances
and output levels.
•
•
Calibrates speaker distances within 0.5 foot (.2m) of the physical distance between the primary listening
position and the speaker.
Calibrates individual speaker output levels within +/-0.5dB of each other and overall speaker output
levels within +/-3.0dB of THX reference levels (75dB).
DISTANCES
LEVELS
•
•
Activates automatic calibration of speaker distances.
Provides a comparison between original and calibrated speaker distances, allowing selection of the
desired values.
•
Calibrates speaker distances within 0.5 foot (.2m) of the physical distance between the primary listening
position and the speaker.
•
•
Activates automatic calibration of output levels.
Provides a comparison between original and calibrated output levels, allowing selection of the desired
values.
•
Calibrates individual speaker output levels within +/-0.5dB of each other and overall speaker output
levels within +/-3.0dB of THX reference levels (75dB).
3-35
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
CONNECTING THE MICROPHONES
MC-12 Rear Panel
CAUTION!
•
The microphones included in the Lexicon Microphone Kit
require careful handling. Dropping or otherwise physically
abusing the microphones might cause errors during use or
irreparable damage to the microphone.
•
•
The microphone wires also require careful handling. Do not
sharply bend the wires or place objects on them.
Never make or break microphone input connections unless
the MC-12 is powered off with the rear panel power switch
OR standby mode is activated with the front panel or
remote control standby button.
1. Make sure the MC-12 is powered off OR in standby mode.
2. Connect the microphones included in the Lexicon Microphone
Kit to the microphone input connectors on the MC-12 rear
panel as shown above. Make sure the microphone cable plug is
fully inserted for a solid connection.
Note the following:
•
•
•
Automatic calibration requires the microphones included in the
Lexicon Microphone Kit available at authorized Lexicon dealers.
Performing automatic calibration with microphones other than
those in the kit will produce unpredictable results.
During the microphone check, the microphones will be
referred to as 1, 2, 3, and 4 based on the input connector to
which the microphone is connected. You should label the
microphones for troubleshooting purposes.
Proper microphone placement is essential to achieving the
desired automatic calibration results. Pay particular attention to
the microphone placement instructions and illustrations
included in this section.
3. Power on the MC-12 OR deactivate standby mode.
It is important to read and observe the care and handling docu-
mentation included with the Lexicon Microphone Kit to ensure
optimal microphone performance.
3-36
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
POSITIONING THE MICROPHONES FOR THE MICROPHONE CHECK
Refer to the microphone placement examples that begin below to position the microphones for the microphone check.
PROPER
microphone positioning for the microphone check
During the microphone check, position
the microphones:
3 As close together as possible
3 Relatively centered between and equidistant
from the front left and right speakers
Rear
Left
3 In a clear line-of-sight path with the speakers
Side
Left
Rear
3 In a location unobstructed by furniture and
other fixtures, where echoes will not obscure
calibration noise signals
Right
3 At least 2 feet (0.61m) from all speakers and
Side
Right
walls, but within 30 feet (9.14m) of all speakers.
The illustration to the right provides an example of
proper microphone placement during the microphone
check. All of the microphones are positioned as close
together as possible in an unobstructed location that is
equidistant from the front left and right speakers.
Front
Left
Microphone
Center
Subwoofer
Front
Right
3-37
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
IMPROPER
microphone positioning for the microphone check
During the microphone check, do not:
7 Separate the microphones
7 Scatter the microphones throughout the listening
space
7 Obstruct the line-of-sight path between the micro-
phones and the speakers
Rear
Left
7 Position the microphones on the floor, on seat
cushions, or in locations obstructed by furniture and
other fixtures, where echoes might obscure
calibration noise signals
Side
Left
Rear
Right
7 Position the microphones within 2 feet (0.61m) of
speakers and walls or more than 30 feet (9.14m)
from any one speaker.
Side
Right
Front
Left
The illustration to the right provides an example of
improper microphone placement during the microphone
check. The microphones are scattered throughout the
listening space rather than positioned as close together as
possible in a location that is equidistant from the front left
and right speakers.
Microphone
Center
Subwoofer
Front
Right
3-38
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
CHECKING THE MICROPHONES
C
H
E
C
K
M
IC
GROUP M
INTO A BU
MIDDLE O
PRESS BEGIN
MIC C CK
R
O
P
HONES
PHONES
E IN THE
E ROOM
SETUP
SPEAKER SETUP
MAIN MENU
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
I
CR
O
N
DL
T
F
H
MANUAL
TO
H
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
E
APART
Note the following:
3. Press the ꢀ arrow button to begin the microphone check. The
following screens appear in the on-screen display as the micro-
phone check is performed:
•
The MC-12 outputs calibration noise signals between 55 and
95dB, beginning with 55dB and increasing in 5dB increments
until the microphones detect the required level. If the calibra-
tion noise signal becomes too loud, press the ꢃ arrow button
to cancel the microphone check.
CHECKING FOR SILENCE
Appears in the on-screen display while
C
H
E
C
K
MICROPHONES
•
Although the calibration noise signal is output at a fixed
volume level, you should set all volume controls for associated
components (i.e. speakers, subwoofers, and power amplifiers)
to a reasonable level before performing automatic calibration.
When the procedure is finished, the MC-12 automatically
reverts to the last volume level that was selected before
automatic calibration began.
the MC-12 determines the relative noise
level of the listening space and the
internal noise level of the microphones.
After eliminating microphones that are
not detected or not functioning, the MC-12 calculates an aver-
age level for all microphones.
CHECKING FOR SILENCE
PLEASE WAIT
•
During automatic calibration, you should refer to the on-screen
display instead of the front panel display, as additional informa-
tion and instructions are available on the on-screen display.
CHECKING MICROPHONES
Appears in the on-screen display while
C
H
E
C
K
MICROPHONES
the MC-12 confirms the microphone
level calculated during the silence
check. To do this, the MC-12 sends
alternating calibration noise signals to
CHECKING MICROPHONES
PLEASE WAIT
1. Select the SPEAKER SETUP menu CHECK MICROPHONES
option as shown above.
the front left and right speakers. These signals are output
between 55 and 95dB, beginning with 55dB and increasing in
5dB increments until the microphones detect the required
2. The first CHECK MICROPHONES screen opens in the on-screen
display, indicating the importance of proper microphone
placement to achieve accurate automatic calibration results.
3-39
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
CHECKING THE MICROPHONES (continued)
level. If the signal becomes too loud, press the ꢃarrow button
to cancel the microphone check.
4. Press the ꢁ and ꢂ arrow buttons to highlight the desired
microphone parameter. The MC-12 refers to the microphones
according to the input connector to which the microphone is
connected.
The MC-12 uses the calibration noise signal to eliminate micro-
phones that register the signal at a level that is too low or too
high. Then, the MC-12 determines the appropriate output level
for the calibration noise signal used during automatic calibration.
5. Press the ꢀ arrow button to view more detailed results for the
selected microphone. A message similar to the one shown at
the bottom of the previous column opens in the on-screen
display. Refer to the table on the next page for information
about all possible microphone check messages.
CHECK MICROPHONES Results
Appears on-screen when the MC-12 is finished checking the
microphones. This display indicates the individual check results
for each microphone.
Note the following:
•
•
The MC-12 retains the calculated microphone level until the
SPEAKER SETUP menu is closed. Once this menu is closed,
another microphone check is required before automatic cali-
bration can be performed.
•
•
An OK result indicates that the microphone passed the
microphone check.
An ERROR result indicates that the microphone did not pass
the microphone check.
For best results, you should perform automatic calibration with
four microphones that have passed the microphone check.
However, the MC-12 will perform automatic calibration as long
as at least one microphone passes the microphone check. In
this circumstance, place the successfully checked microphones
in the primary listening position.
CHECK MICROPHONES
(MICROPHONE)
OK
MIC 1
MIC 2
MIC 3
MIC 4
OK
OK
ERROR
OK
•
If a microphone check was successful, do not disconnect the
microphones from the microphone input connectors. If the
microphones are disconnected, you should perform the micro-
phone check again before proceeding to automatic calibration.
PRESS TO VIEW
DETAILS
3-40
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
Message
Description
Troubleshooting
The microphone detected the calibration
noise signal without error.
•
N/A
(MICROPHONE)
OK
The MC-12 did not detect the micro-
phone during the silence check.
•
•
•
•
Examine microphone input connections to ensure that the microphones are properly con-
nected to the MC-12 and that microphone cable plugs are fully inserted for a solid connection.
(MICROPHONE)
NOT DETECTED
The microphone might be damaged. Contact an authorized Lexicon dealer for assistance.
The MC-12 detected the microphone
during the silence check. However, the
microphone level determined during the
silence check was not confirmed during
the microphone check.
Examine microphone input connections to ensure that the microphones are properly con-
nected to the MC-12 and that microphone cable plugs are fully inserted for a solid connection.
(MICROPHONE)
SIGNAL TOO LOW
The microphones might be positioned too far from the front speakers. Refer to the microphone
ately positioned for the microphone check.
•
•
•
The microphone might be damaged. Contact an authorized Lexicon dealer for assistance.
The microphone level is more than 20dB
below the highest microphone level.
Examine microphone input connections to ensure that the microphones are properly con-
nected to the MC-12 and that microphone cable plugs are fully inserted for a solid connection.
(MICROPHONE)
OUT OF RANGE
The microphones might be positioned too far from the front speakers. Refer to the microphone
ately positioned for the microphone check.
•
•
•
The microphone might be damaged. Contact an authorized Lexicon dealer for assistance.
The microphone level could not be deter-
mined because of excessive room noise in
the listening space.
Eliminate extraneous noises in the listening space, including conversations, air conditioners,
and sounds that filter in through open doors and windows.
(MICROPHONE)
TOO MUCH ROOM NOISE
The microphone might be damaged. Contact an authorized Lexicon dealer for assistance.
POSITIONING THE MICROPHONES FOR AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION
Proper microphone placement is essential to achieving the desired
automatic calibration results. Microphone placement determines
whether the MC-12 calibrates optimal speaker distances and output
levels for a single listening position, several listening positions in a
single row, or several listening positions in the listening space.
Refer to the microphone placement examples that begin on the
next page to position the microphones for automatic calibration.
Select the microphone placement that best meets the needs of the
listening space.
3-41
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
POSITIONING THE MICROPHONES FOR AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION (continued)
PROPER
microphone placement to achieve the best results for a single listening position
When calibrating for a single listening
position, place the microphones:
3 As close together as possible in a single listening
position (the primary listening position)
3 At the approximate spot where the listener’s
head will be during listening
Rear
Left
3 In a clear line-of-sight path with the speakers
Side
Left
Rear
Right
3 In a location unobstructed by furniture and
other fixtures, where echoes will not obscure
calibration noise signals
Side
Right
3 At least 2 feet (0.61m) from all speakers and
walls, but within 30 feet (9.14m) of all speakers.
Front
Left
The illustration to the right provides an example of
proper microphone placement when calibrating for a
single listening position. The microphones are
positioned as close together as possible in a single
listening position, allowing the MC-12 to calibrate
optimal speaker distances and output levels for that
position.
Microphone
Center
Subwoofer
Front
Right
3-42
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
PROPER
microphone placement to achieve the best results for multiple listening positions in a single row
When calibrating for multiple listening
positions in a single row, position the
microphones:
3 At the approximate spot where the listener’s
head will be during listening
3 In a clear line-of-sight path with the speakers
Rear
Left
3 In a location unobstructed by furniture and
other fixtures, where echoes will not obscure
calibration noise signals
Side
Left
Rear
Right
3 At least 2 feet (0.61m) from all speakers and
walls, but within 30 feet (9.14m) of all speakers.
Side
Right
The illustration to the right provides an example of
proper microphone placement when calibrating for
multiple listening positions in a single row. Each micro-
phone is positioned in a single listening position within
a single row, allowing the MC-12 to calibrate optimal
speaker distances and output levels for that row at the
expense of a single listening position.
Front
Left
Microphone
Center
Subwoofer
Front
Right
3-43
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
POSITIONING THE MICROPHONES FOR AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION (continued)
PROPER
microphone placement to achieve the best results for multiple listening positions in multiple rows
When calibrating for multiple listening
positions in multiple rows, position the
microphones:
3 At the approximate spot where the listener’s
head will be during listening
Rear
Left
3 In a clear line-of-sight path with the speakers
Side
Left
3 In a location unobstructed by furniture and
other fixtures, where echoes will not obscure
calibration noise signals
Rear
Right
3 At least 2 feet (0.61m) from all speakers and
Side
Right
walls, but within 30 feet (9.14m) of all speakers.
The illustration to the right provides an example of
proper microphone placement when calibrating for
multiple listening positions in multiple rows. Each
microphone is positioned in a single listening position
within rows, allowing the MC-12 to calibrate optimal
speaker distances and output levels for a larger
listening area at the expense of a single listening
position.
Front
Left
Microphone
Center
Subwoofer
Front
Right
3-44
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
IMPROPER
microphone positioning for automatic calibration
During the automatic calibration, do not:
7 Arrange the microphones along the perimeter of
the listening positions or space
7 Position the microphones in spots where the
listeners’ heads will not be during listening
Rear
Left
Side
Left
7 Obstruct the line-of-sight path between the
Rear
Right
microphones and the speakers
7 Position the microphones on the floor, on seat
cushions, or in locations obstructed by furniture
and other fixtures, where echoes might obscure
calibration noise signals
Side
Right
7 Position the microphones within 2 feet (0.61m) of
speakers and walls or more than 30 feet (9.14m)
from any one speaker.
Front
Left
Microphone
Center
The illustration to the right provides an example of
improper microphone placement during the micro-
phone check. The microphones are positioned on the
floor along the perimeter of the listening space,
making it difficult for the MC-12 to calibrate optimal
speaker distances and output levels for the actual
listening positions.
Subwoofer
Front
Right
3-45
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
POSITIONING THE MICROPHONES FOR AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION (continued)
IMPROPER
microphone positioning for automatic calibration
During the automatic calibration, do not:
7 Arrange the microphones along the perimeter of
the listening positions or space
7 Position the microphones at spots where the
listeners’ heads will not be during listening
Rear
Left
7 Obstruct the line-of-sight path between the
Side
Left
Rear
Right
microphones and the speakers
7 Position the microphones on the floor, on seat
cushions, or in locations obstructed by furniture
and other fixtures, where echoes might obscure
calibration noise signals
Side
Right
7 Position the microphones within 2 feet (0.61m) of
speakers and walls or more than 30 feet (9.14m)
from any one speaker.
Front
Left
Microphone
Center
The illustration to the right provides an example of
improper microphone placement during the microphone
check. The microphones are positioned on seat cushions
rather than in spots where the listener’s heads will be
during listening.
Subwoofer
Front
Right
3-46
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
PERFORMING AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION
SETUP
SPEAKER SETUP
A
U
T
O
SPE
DISTANCES
DISTANCES
OUTPUT LE EL
PLACE MICROPHONES
A
K
E
R
SETUP
A
U
T
O
SPE
!CA
HIGH AU
YOU WILL E 10 SEC
TO LEAVE
SIT QU
PRESS
A
K
E
R
SETUP
N!
IOLEVELS
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP
MAIN MENU
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
&
L
E
VELS
U
D
TI
O
TEST WILL BEGIN IN
10
V
S
MANUAL
T
H
A
V
PRESS TO SKIP
COUNTDOWN
IN PRIMARY LISTENING
HE
R
OOM OR
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
I
E
TLY
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
POSITIONS
APART
T
O
BEGIN
COUNTDOWN
Follow the procedures in the appropriate table column for the desired type of automatic calibration.
STEP
DISTANCES
DISTANCES & LEVELS
LEVELS
Select the SPEAKER SETUP menu AUTOMATIC option as shown in the menu illustration above.
•
If a microphone check is successful, the AUTO SPEAKER SETUP menu becomes available on the on-screen display. Press
the ꢁ or ꢂ arrow button to highlight the automatic calibration option you want. Then, press the ꢀ arrow button to select
this option. Refer to the table on page 3-35 for more information about automatic calibration options.
M I C C H E C K R E Q U I R E D
FOR AUTO CALIBRATION
1
•
If a microphone check is unsuccessful, one of the error messages shown at the right appears on the on-screen display, indicat-
ing that a successful microphone check is required before automatic calibration is available, and also the reason the previous
check failed. If this occurs, go back to “Connecting the Microphones” on page 3-36 and work your way forward to this page.
NO MICROPHONE
DETECTED
The following AUTO SPEAKER SETUP messages display on-screen before automatic calibration begins:
•
The !CAUTION! HIGH AUDIO LEVELS message indicates that the MC-12 generates loud calibration noise signals during automatic calibration. If the
signals become too loud, press the ꢃ arrow button to cancel automatic calibration. Press the ꢀ arrow button to open the next AUTO SPEAKER
SETUP menu.
2
•
The countdown display notifies you that automatic calibration will begin in 10 seconds. The primary reason for the 10 second delay is to give you time
to leave the listening space before automatic calibration begins. If you choose to remain in the room, your movements could affect the calibration
results. If you leave the room, you can return in about 10 minutes (the calibration procedure should be completed). Press the ꢀ arrow button to
skip the countdown and begin automatic calibration. The MC-12 automatically activates automatic calibration when the countdown ends.
3-47
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
PERFORMING AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION (continued)
SETTING DISTANCES
SETTING DISTANCES
SETTING LEVELS
SETTING LEVELS
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
N/A
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
12.0ft
10.5ft
12.0ft
4.5ft
ERROR
6.0ft
4.5ft
N/A
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
0.0dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
N/A
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
-2.0dB
ERROR
-2.0dB
-4.5dB
-3.0dB
-3.0dB
-4.5dB
N/A
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
MONO SUB
SUB RIGHT
LFE
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
MONO SUB
SUB RIGHT
LFE
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
MONO SUB
SUB RIGHT
LFE
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
MONO SUB
SUB RIGHT
LFE
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
STEP
DISTANCES
DISTANCES & LEVELS
LEVELS
This step does not occur when the AUTO
SPEAKER SETUP menu LEVELS option is
selected.
The SETTING DISTANCES screen displays when the MC-12 calibrates speaker distances.
•
During speaker distance calibration, the MC-12 sends calibration noise signals to the Main Zone
audio output connectors in the order shown on the SETTING DISTANCES screen. The cursor auto-
matically scrolls downward through speaker calibration parameters, highlighting each parameter
while the MC-12 calculates a distance for the corresponding speaker. As it finishes each parameter,
the MC-12 enters the calibrated value or an ERROR message to the right of the parameter label.
3
•
Because of the way low frequency signals propagate in most listening spaces, automatic speaker dis-
tance calibration often produces unreliable results for subwoofers and LFE subwoofers. For this reason
the MC-12 does not send calibration noise signals to the Subwoofer L/R and LFE output connectors
during speaker distance calibration. Instead, the MC-12 automatically calibrates subwoofer and LFE
subwoofer distances to the shortest distance of the other speakers. These distances can be manually
This step does not occur when the AUTO SPEAKER
SETUP menu DISTANCES option is selected.
The SETTING LEVELS screen displays when the MC-12 calibrates output levels.
•
The MC-12 sends calibration noise signals to the Main Zone audio output connectors in the
order shown on the SETTING LEVELS screen. The cursor automatically scrolls downward
through speaker calibration parameters, highlighting each parameter while the MC-12 calcu-
lates an output level for the corresponding speaker. As it finishes each parameter, the MC-12
enters the calibrated value or an ERROR message to the right of the parameter label.
4
3-48
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
DISTANCES
STEP
DISTANCES & LEVELS
LEVELS
AUTO LEVELS
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP
AUTO DISTANCES
FRONT LEFT
OK
FRONT LEFT
OK
DISTANCES
LEVELS
OK
ERROR
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
-2.0dB
ERROR
-2.0dB
-4.5dB
-3.0dB
-3.0dB
-4.5dB
N/A
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
12.0ft
10.5ft
12.0ft
4.5ft
ERROR
6.0ft
4.5ft
N/A
Refer to the table on page
3-51 for information about
all possible speaker calibra-
tion messages.
Refer to the table on page
3-51 for information about
all possible speaker calibra-
tion messages.
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
MONO SUB
SUB RIGHT
LFE
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
MONO SUB
SUB RIGHT
LFE
AUTO VALUES APPLIED
PRESS TO VIEW
DETAILS
When the MC-12 is finished calibrating
speaker distances and output levels, the
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP screen displays,
indicating the results for each calibration
procedure.
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
When the MC-12 is finished calibrating
speaker distances, the AUTO DISTANCES
screen displays, indicating the results for
each individual speaker.
When the MC-12 is finished calibrating
output levels, the AUTO LEVELS screen
displays, indicating the results for each
individual speaker.
•
•
•
An OK message indicates that no errors
occurred during the calibration proce-
dure.
An ERROR message indicates that a value
was calculated, but at least one error
occurred during calibration.
•
A value indicates that no errors occurred
during the calibration procedure.
•
A value indicates that no errors occurred-
during the calibration procedure.
5
•
An ERROR message indicates that a value
was calculated, but at least one error
occurred during the calibration proce-
dure.
•
An ERROR message indicates that a value
was calculated, but at least one error
occurred during the calibration proce-
dure.
Press the ꢁ or ꢂ arrow button to high-
light the desired calibration procedure.
DISTANCES displays the AUTO DIS-
TANCES screen shown in the left column
of this table.
•
•
Press the ꢁ or ꢂ arrow button to high-
light the speaker calibration parameter
you want. Then, press the ꢀ button to
view more detailed results for the
selected speaker. A message similar to
the one shown above will display.
•
•
Press the ꢁ or ꢂ arrow button to high-
light the desired speaker calibration
parameter. Then, press the ꢀ arrow
button to view more detailed results for
the selected speaker. A message similar
to the one shown above displays.
LEVELS displays the AUTO LEVELS screen
shown in the right column of this table.
•
•
Press the ꢀ arrow button to select this
procedure.
tion about all possible speaker calibration
messages.
mation about all possible speaker calibra-
tion messages.
Refer to the instructions in the appropri-
ate column to view more detailed results
for each individual speaker.
To fine-tune individual speaker distances and output levels, refer to the MANUAL CALIBRATION section that begins on page 3-52. You should also
configure BASS PEAK LIMITERS parameter settings. (See “SETTING BASS PEAK LIMITERS” on page 3-57.)
Note:
3-49
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
PERFORMING AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION (continued)
STEP
DISTANCES
DISTANCES & LEVELS
LEVELS
SET DISTANCES
AUTO DISTANCES
AUTO DISTANCES*
SET LEVELS
AUTO LEVELS
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP
AUTO DISTANCES
ORIGINAL DISTANCES
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
12.0ft
10.5ft
12.0ft
4.5ft
ERROR
6.0ft
4.5ft
N/A
DISTANCES
LEVELS
OK
ERROR
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
12.0ft
10.5ft
12.0ft
4.5ft
ERROR
6.0ft
4.5ft
N/A
AUTO LEVELS
ORIGINAL LEVELS
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
-2.0dB
ERROR
-2.0dB
-4.5dB
-3.0dB
-3.0dB
-4.5dB
N/A
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
MONO SUB
SUB RIGHT
LFE
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
MONO SUB
SUB RIGHT
LFE
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
MONO SUB
SUB RIGHT
LFE
AUTO VALUES APPLIED
PRESS TO VIEW
DETAILS
R
C
SR
RR
0.0ft
R
SR
RR
0.0dB
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0dB
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0dB
C
0.0dB
M
SUB
M
SUB
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
L
SL RL
0.0ft
L
SL RL
0.0dB
0.0dB
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0dB
0.0dB
Use the SET DISTANCES menu to select
the desired speaker distances.
Use the AUTO SPEAKER SETUP menu to
select speaker distances or levels.
Use the SET LEVELS menu to select the
desired speaker levels.
1 Press the ꢃ arrow button to return to the
1 Press the ꢃ arrow button to return to
1 Press the ꢃ arrow button to return to
the SET DISTANCES menu.
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP results screen.
the SET LEVELS menu.
6
2 Press the ꢁ or ꢂ arrow button to tog-
gle between calibrated speaker distances
(AUTO) and original speaker distances.
The speaker graphics at the bottom of
the menu update to indicate the selected
values.
2 To select the other calibration procedure,
follow the instructions in Step 5. Otherwise,
press the ꢃ button to return to the
SPEAKER SETUP menu.
•
Press the ꢁ and ꢂ arrow buttons to
toggle between calibrated output levels
(AUTO) and original output levels. The
speaker graphics at the bottom of the
menu update to indicate the selected val-
ues.
The AUTO DISTANCES screen is shown above
as an example. The AUTO LEVELS screen can
be substituted.
•
•
Press the ꢀ arrow button to apply the
selected values. A confirmation message
displays to indicate the applied values.
3 Press the ꢀ button to apply the
selected values. A confirmation message
displays to indicate the applied values.
Press the ꢃ arrow button twice in suc-
cession to return to the SPEAKER SETUP
menu.
4 Press the ꢃ button twice in succession
to return to the SPEAKER SETUP menu.
3-50
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
Message
Description
Troubleshooting
The MC-12 successfully calibrated the value
for the selected speaker without error.
•
•
N/A
(SPEAKER)
OK
The selected speaker is not present in the
speaker setup
Set the corresponding CUSTOM or THX SETUP menu parameter to include the selected
speaker in the speaker setup. (The MC-12 only calibrates values for speakers that are included
in the speaker setup.)
(SPEAKER)
SPEAKER IS NOT ENABLED
The microphones detected out-of-phase
calibration noise signals, but the cali-
brated value is still accurate.
•
•
Examine speaker/associated amplifier connections to ensure that speaker wires are not crossed.
(SPEAKER)
SPEAKER OUT OF PHASE
Dipolar speakers could cause this error. However, the MC-12 does not report this error unless
at least half of the microphones detect out-of-phase calibration noise signals.
•
•
Reflections from room objects can cause an out of phase error.
Drivers intentionally wired out-of-phase.
The microphones detected calibration
noise signals at an unusually low level.
•
•
The microphones might be positioned more than 30 feet (9.14m) from the selected speaker or in a
location where echoes obscure calibration noise signals. Refer to the placement examples on pages
3-42 to 3-46 to confirm that the microphones are appropriately positioned for automatic calibration.
(SPEAKER)
SIGNAL TOO LOW
Examine microphone input connections to ensure that the microphones are properly con-
nected to the MC-12 and that microphone cable plugs are fully inserted for a solid connection.
The microphones did not detect calibra-
tion noise signals or the MC-12 could not
calculate a value.
•
•
Refer to the microphone placement examples on pages 3-42 to 3-46 to confirm that the
microphones are appropriately positioned for automatic calibration.
(SPEAKER)
UNABLE TO CALCULATE
Examine microphone input connections to ensure that the microphones are properly con-
nected to the MC-12 and that microphone cable plugs are fully inserted for a solid connection.
One or more microphones did not detect
calibration noise signals at a reasonable
level. The calibrated value could be inac-
curate.
•
Refer to the microphone placement examples on pages 3-42 to 3-46 to confirm that the
microphones are appropriately positioned for automatic calibration.
(SPEAKER)
MAY NOT BE ACCURATE
The microphones detected calibration
noise signals at an unusually high level.
•
•
Decrease associated amplifier volume levels – including (if applicable) powered subwoofer amplifiers.
(SPEAKER)
SPKR OUTPUT TOO HIGH
The microphones may be positioned too close (within 2 feet [0.61m]) of the selected speaker.
Refer to the microphone placement examples on pages 3-42 to 3-46 to confirm that the micro-
phones are appropriately positioned for automatic calibration.
The microphones detected calibration
noise signals at an unusually low level.
•
•
Increase associated amplifier volume levels – including (if applicable) powered subwoofer amplifiers.
(SPEAKER)
SPKR OUTPUT TOO LOW
The microphones may be positioned too far away (more than 30 feet [9.14m]) from the
selected speaker. See the microphone placement examples on pages 3-42 to 3-46 to confirm
that the microphones are appropriately positioned for automatic calibration.
3-51
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
MANUAL CALIBRATION
SETUP
SPEAKERS
MANUAL
Selecting the SPEAKER SETUP menu MANUAL option displays the MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP menu, to manually calibrate speaker distances and
output levels. The table below indicates available manual calibration options.
MAIN MENU
SETUP
SPEAKER SETUP
M
A
N
U
A
L
S
P
EA
SPEAKER DISTANCE
LEVELS CALIBRATION
K
ER SETUP
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
S
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
MANUAL
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
0.0dB
R
SR
RR
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
0.0dB
0.0dB
C
LIVE! CALIBRATION
0.0dB
M
SUB
L
SL RL
0.0dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
Manual Options
DetailsB
SPEAKER DISTANCES
LEVELS CALIBRATION
Provides manual calibration and individual adjustment of speaker distances.
Provides manual calibration and individual adjustment of output levels.
INTERNAL NOISE TEST
Automatically sends an internal calibration noise signal to each Main Zone audio output connector, allowing
for simultaneous output level adjustment.
EXTERNAL NOISE TEST
• Requires an external calibration source such as an audio calibration disc.
• Activates an appropriate listening mode based on the current Main Zone input source.
BASS PEAK LIMITERS
• Provides amplitude limits for low frequency signals sent to the Main Zone audio output connectors labeled
Subwoofer L/R and LFE, and low frequency signals redirected to other Main Zone audio output connectors.
• Protects speakers against input sources that produce low frequency signal peaks.
3-52
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
PERFORMING MANUAL SPEAKER DISTANCE CALIBRATION
SETUP
SPEAKERS
MANUAL
SPEAKER DISTANCES
Selecting the MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP menu SPEAKER DISTANCES option displays the SPEAKER DISTANCES menu, to manually calibrate
speaker distances.
SETUP
SPEAKER DISTANCES
MAIN MENU
SPEAKER SETUP
MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
N/A
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
SPEAKER DISTANCES
LEVELS CALIBRATION
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
MONO SUB
SUB RIGHT
LFE
MANUAL
R
C
SR
RR
0.0ft
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m
M
SUB
N/A
FEET
L
SL RL
0.0ft
METERS
FEET
UNITS
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
To manually calibrate speaker distances:
3. To determine the appropriate speaker distance, measure the
distance between the primary listening position and the front
of the speaker.
1. Follow the menu path shown above to select SPEAKER
DISTANCES. The SPEAKER DISTANCES menu shown above will
open on the on-screen display.
For example, when the FRONT LEFT parameter is selected,
measure the distance between the primary listening position
and the front of the front left speaker (connected to the Main
Zone audio output connector labeled Front L).
2. Press the ꢁ or ꢂ arrow buttons to highlight the desired
speaker distance parameter. Then, press the ꢀ arrow button
to select the highlighted speaker distance parameter.
4. When the speaker distance has been measured, press the ꢁ
and ꢂ arrow buttons to set the parameter to the closest
available value.
3-53
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
PERFORMING MANUAL OUTPUT LEVEL CALIBRATION
SETUP
SPEAKERS
MANUAL
LEVELS CALIBRATION
Selecting the MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP menu LEVELS CALIBRATION option displays the LEVELS CALIBRATION menu to manually calibrate
output levels.
Note the following:
•
•
You should use a Sound Pressure Level (SPL) meter to manually
calibrate output levels. An SPL meter is a device that measures
the relative loudness of the speakers to ensure accurate output
level calibration. SPL meters are available at Radio Shack.
•
Output levels for speakers that are not included in the speaker
setup cannot be adjusted during the internal noise test. These
output levels can be adjusted during the external noise test,
but there is no need to do so.
Output levels should be calibrated from the primary listening
position, placing the SPL meter at the approximate location
where the listener’s head will be during listening.
SETUP
LEVELS CALIBRATION
MAIN MENU
SPEAKER SETUP
MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
INTERNAL NOISE TEST
EXTERNAL NOISE TEST
BASS PEAK LIMITERS
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
SPEAKER DISTANCES
LEVELS CALIBRATION
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
MANUAL
R
SR
RR
0.0dB
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
0.0dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
INTERNAL NOISE
SPEAKER LEVEL ADJUST
C
!CAUTION!
HIGH AUDIO LEVELS
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
+0.0dB
0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
N/A
M
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
MONO SUB
SUB RIGHT
LFE
L
SL RL
0.0dB
SUB
0.0dB
0.0dB
UNITS
N/A
-18.0 to +12.0dB
3-54
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
INTERNAL NOISE TEST
INTERNAL NOISE TEST
SETUP
SPEAKERS
MANUAL
LEVELS CALIBRATION
To manually calibrate output levels during the internal noise test:
Opens the INTERNAL NOISE message shown on the previous page,
which indicates that the internal noise test generates loud
calibration noise signals.
1. Set the SPL meter to “C” weighting and “SLOW” response.
2. Press the ꢁ or ꢂ arrow button to highlight the desired
output level parameter. Then, quickly press the ꢀ button to
select this output level parameter. The horizontal bar graph
shown on the previous page will open on the on-screen display
and automatic scrolling will stop.
When the INTERNAL NOISE message opens:
•
Press the ꢀ arrow button to open the SPEAKER LEVEL ADJUST
menu shown on the previous page. When the SPEAKER LEVEL
ADJUST menu opens, the internal noise test automatically
begins.
Note:
•
Press the ꢃ button to skip the internal noise test.
During the internal noise test, it is possible to select an output level
parameter just as the cursor is about to automatically scroll to the
next parameter, causing the MC-12 to send the calibration noise
signal to both speakers. If this occurs, reselect the desired speaker.
During the internal noise test, the MC-12 sends calibration noise
signals to each speaker in the order shown on the SPEAKER LEVEL
ADJUST menu. The cursor automatically scrolls through output level
parameters, highlighting each parameter as the MC-12 sends the
calibration noise signal to the corresponding speaker. The
calibration noise signal is sent to each speaker for about 4 seconds.
3. When the horizontal bar graph opens, press the ꢁ or ꢂ
button to select the output level that achieves a 75dB SPL
meter reading from the primary listening position.
Note:
4. Press ꢃ to close the parameter. The internal noise test will
continue and automatic scrolling will resume.
When the internal noise test begins, the MC-12 automatically sets
volume level to +0dB. Avoid adjusting the master volume level while
the test is in progress to achieve THX reference levels (75dB).
5. Repeat steps 2, 3, and 4 until all desired output levels have
been set.
INTERNAL NOISE TEST LEVELS CALIBRATION MANUAL SPEAKERS SETUP
3-55
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
EXTERNAL NOISE TEST
EXTERNAL NOISE TEST
SETUP
SPEAKERS
MANUAL
LEVELS CALIBRATION
Selecting the LEVELS CALIBRATION menu EXTERNAL NOISE TEST
option opens the SPEAKER LEVEL ADJUST menu shown on page
3-54, which manually calibrates output levels.
Note:
When the external noise test begins, the MC-12 automatically sets
volume level to +0dB. Avoid adjusting the master volume level while
the test is in progress to achieve THX reference levels (75dB).
The external noise test requires an external calibration source such
as an audio calibration disc. When the external noise test is
conducted, the MC-12 activates a listening mode based on the
current Main Zone input source. Refer to the table below for more
information about external noise test listening mode activation.
To manually calibrate output levels during the external noise test:
1. Set the SPL Meter to “C” weighting and “SLOW” response.
2. Place the SPL Meter at the primary listening position.
When a listening mode is activated during the external noise test,
all custom listening mode menu parameter settings are ignored.
The listening mode is applied to the current Main Zone input
source in its factory-default condition. When the external noise test
is finished, the listening mode returns to its custom condition.
3. Press the ꢁ or ꢂ arrow button to highlight the output level
parameter you want. Then, press the ꢀ button to select this
output level parameter.
The horizontal bar graph shown on page 3-54 displays.
4. Begin playback of the external calibration source and press the
ꢁ or ꢂ arrow button to select the output level that achieves a
75dB SPL Meter reading.
EXTERNAL NOISE TEST LEVELS CALIBRATION MANUAL SPEAKERS SETUP
INPUT SOURCE
LISTENING MODE
5. After selecting the output level, press the ꢃ arrow button to
2-Channel
PLII MOVIE,
DIGITAL**
PLIIx MOVIE*
close the horizontal bar graph.
Dolby Digital
DTS(-ES)
6. Repeat steps 2, 3, and 4 until you have set all the output levels
you want.
*
5.1-Channel Analog 5.1a STANDARD
* These listening modes depend on the speaker configuration. Dolby Pro Logic IIx MOVIE
will only load when side and rear speakers are present.
**These listening mode names differ depending on the current input source, speaker
setup, and parameter settings. Refer to the Listening Mode Descriptions section
beginning on page 5-5 for more information.
3-56
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
SETTING BASS PEAK LIMITERS
BASS PEAK LIMITERS
SETUP
SPEAKERS
MANUAL
LEVELS CALIBRATION
The BASS PEAK LIMITERS option displays the BASS PEAK LIMITERS menu to set amplitude limits on low frequency signals sent to the Main Zone
audio output Subwoofer L/R and LFE connectors. This menu also sets amplitude limits on low frequency signals redirected to other Main Zone
audio output connectors. The MC-12 is equipped with an internal limiter to prevent low frequency signals from exceeding a designated output
level. This is essential for Dolby Digital and DTS(-ES) sources that produce low frequency signal peaks at much higher output levels than
2-channel sources. In home theaters, there is a danger of the subwoofers and their associated amplifiers overloading when attempting to
reproduce low frequency signals.
LEVELS CALIBRATION
BASS PEAK LIMITERS
MAIN MENU
SETUP
SPEAKER SETUP
MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
SPEAKER DISTANCES
LEVELS CALIBRATION
INTERNAL NOISE TEST
EXTERNAL NOISE TEST
BASS PEAK LIMITERS
CAL NOISE
L/R LIMITER
L/R LIMIT ADJ
LFE LIMITER
LFE LIMIT ADJ
ON
ON
100dB
ON
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
MANUAL
R
SR
RR
0.0dB
100dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
C
!CAUTION!
HIGH AUDIO LEVELS
0.0dB
M
L
SL RL
0.0dB
SUB
75 to 120dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
ON
OFF
Note:
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Setting
You should configure BASS PEAK LIMITERS menu parameter settings
whether output levels are automatically or manually calibrated.
CAL NOISE
L/R LIMITER
ON
ON
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
L/R LIMIT ADJ 100dB
LFE LIMITER ON
LFE LIMIT ADJ 100dB
75 to 120dB
ON, OFF
75 to 120dB
3-57
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
CAL NOISE
ON, OFF
L/R LIMIT ADJ
75 to 120dB
SETUP
SPEAKERS
MANUAL
LEVELS CALIBRATION
BASS PEAK LIMITERS
SETUP
SPEAKERS
MANUAL
LEVELS CALIBRATION
BASS PEAK LIMITERS
L/R LIMITER ADJ
CAL NOISE
Determines whether bass peak limiters are set with an internal or
external calibration source.
Specifies the output level restriction applied to the Subwoofer L/R
output connectors, and to other Main Zone audio output
connectors to which low frequency signals are redirected.
To set the CAL NOISE parameter:
To set the L/R LIMIT ADJ parameter:
•
•
Select ON to activate an internal calibration noise signal to set
bass peak limiters.
1. Select the L/R LIMIT ADJ parameter.
Select OFF to deactivate the internal calibration noise signal.
The parameter initally sets to 75dB.
Setting bass peak limiters with the calibration noise set to OFF
requires an external calibration source such as an audio calibra-
tion disc.
2. Press the ꢁ and ꢂ arrow buttons to change the parameter
value.
The selected output level restriction is applied when the L/R
LIMITER parameter is set to ON.
L/R LIMITER
ON, OFF
SETUP
SPEAKERS
MANUAL
LEVELS CALIBRATION
BASS PEAK LIMITERS
LFE LIMITER
ON, OFF
L/R LIMITER
SETUP
SPEAKERS
MANUAL
LEVELS CALIBRATION
BASS PEAK LIMITERS
Limits low frequency signals sent to the subwoofer or redirected to
other speakers.
LFE LIMITER
Limits low frequency signals sent to the LFE subwoofer or redirected
to other speakers.
To set the L/R LIMITER parameter:
•
•
Select ON to restrict the output level of the low frequency
To set the LFE LIMITER parameter:
signals to the L/R LIMIT ADJ parameter setting.
•
•
Select ON to restrict the output level of the low frequency
Select OFF to allow an unrestricted signal output level, regard-
less of the L/R LIMIT ADJ parameter setting.
signals to the LFE LIMIT ADJ parameter setting.
Select OFF to allow an unrestricted signal output level, regard-
less of the LFE LIMIT ADJ parameter setting.
3-58
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
To set the LFE LIMIT ADJ parameter:
LFE LIMITER ADJ
75 to 120dB
SETUP
SPEAKERS
MANUAL
LEVELS CALIBRATION
BASS PEAK LIMITERS
1. Select the LFE LIMIT ADJ parameter.
LFE LIMITER ADJ
The parameter initally sets to 75dB.
Specifies the output level restriction the MC-12 applies to the LFE
output connector.
2. Press the ꢁ and ꢂ arrow buttons to change the parameter
value.
The selected output level restriction is applied when the LFE
LIMITER parameter is set to ON.
REAR-PANEL CONFIGURATION
8 STEREO INPUTS
SETUP
REAR PANEL CONFIG
SETUP
REAR PANEL CONFIG
8 STEREO INPUTS
Selecting the REAR PANEL CONFIG option displays the REAR PANEL
CONFIG menu shown below, to configure the analog audio input
connectors as eight (Left/Right) stereo connectors or as five
(Left/Right) stereo connectors and one 5.1-channel configuration
(Front L/R, Center, Subwoofer, Side L/R)
Select the 8 STEREO INPUTS option to configure the analog audio
input connectors as eight stereo connectors.
When 8 STEREO INPUTS is selected:
•
All analog audio input connectors are configured as stereo
connectors.
REAR PANEL CONFIG
SETUP
MAIN MENU
8 STEREO INPUTS
OR
5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
•
•
The 5.1-channel connector is not available.
Input sources that were assigned to the 5.1-channel connector
are reassigned to the stereo connector labeled 6.
5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG
FOR REAR PANEL CFG
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
8 STEREO INPUTS
FOR REAR PANEL CFG
3-59
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG
SETUP
REAR PANEL CONFIG
5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG
Select the 5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG option to configure the analog audio
input connectors as five stereo and one 5.1-channel connectors.
•
The 5.1-channel input is sent to the Main Zone audio output
connectors as indicated in the table below.
When 5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG is selected:
Input Connector(s)
Output Connector(s)
•
•
•
•
The 5.1-channel connector should only be used with
5.1-channel analog sources such as DVD-As and SACDs.
(L) & (R)
(C)
Front L/R
Center
The analog audio input connectors labeled 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5 are
configured as stereo connectors.
(SUB)
Subwoofer L/R & LFE
The analog audio input connectors labeled 6, 7, and 8 are
configured as 5.1-channel connectors.
(LS) & (RS) 5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG Side L/R & Rear L/R
8 STEREO INPUTS REAR PANEL CONFIG SETUP
Input sources that were assigned to the stereo connectors
labeled 6, 7, and 8 are reassigned to conform to the
5.1-channel configuration.
3-60
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
DISPLAY SETUP
SETUP
DISPLAYS
The DISPLAYS option displays the DISPLAY SETUP menu, to customize the on-screen and front-panel displays, restore audio/video synchroni-
zation, and create and activate a custom unit name.
SETUP
MAIN MENU
DISPLAY SETUP
OFF, 1 to 60ms
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY
A/V SYNC DELAY
CUSTOM NAME
EDIT CUSTOM NAME
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
ON
OFF
OFF
OFF
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
CUSTOM NAME
ON, OFF
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Setting
SETUP
DISPLAYS
CUSTOM
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
Activates the display of the custom unit name, which can be
created with the EDIT CUSTOM NAME menu. When ON is selected,
the custom unit name scrolls across the on-screen and front panel
displays whenever the MC-12 is activated. When OFF is selected,
the custom unit name does not scroll across the on-screen and
front- panel displays when the MC-12 is activated.
A/V SYNC DELAY
CUSTOM NAME
OFF
OFF
OFF, 1 to 60ms
ON, OFF
A/V SYNC DELAY
OFF, 1 to 60ms
SETUP
DISPLAYS
A/V SYNC DELAY
Restores audio/video synchronization when the MC-12 is
connected to components such as video processors that introduce
video signal delays. Select a value between 1 and 60ms to activate
an audio signal delay to compensate for the video signal delay.
3-61
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
DISPLAY SETUP (continued)
MAIN MENU
DISPLAY SETUP
SETUP
EDIT CUSTOM NAME
MC-12
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY
A/V SYNC DELAY
CUSTOM NAME
EDIT CUSTOM NAME
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
OFF
OFF
BUTTONS TO EDIT
UP TO 20 CHARACTERS
BUTTON TO ADVANCE
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
EDIT CUSTOM NAME
SETUP
DISPLAYS
EDIT CUSTOM NAME
Opens the EDIT CUSTOM NAME drop-down menu shown above,
which can be used to create a custom unit name. The factory
default unit name is MC-12.
•
Pressing ꢃ will close the EDIT CUSTOM NAME drop-down
menu.
4. When the desired custom unit name has been entered,
press ꢃuntil the EDIT CUSTOM NAME menu closes.
To create a custom unit name:
1. Follow the EDIT CUSTOM NAME menu path shown above to
open the EDIT CUSTOM NAME drop-down menu.
2. When the EDIT CUSTOM NAME menu drops down, locate the
current unit name on the second line. The cursor automatically
appears beneath the first character in the current unit name.
3. Use the following remote control commands to enter a unit
name:
•
Press the ꢁ or ꢂ arrow button to change the character
above the cursor.
•
Press the ꢀ button to advance to the next character space.
The cursor will automatically wrap to the first character
space when the last (twentieth) character space is passed.
3-62
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
SETUP
DISPLAYS
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
The ON-SCREEN DISPLAY option opens the ON-SCREEN DISPLAY menu, to customize the on-screen display.
SETUP
MAIN MENU
DISPLAY SETUP
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
ALWAYS ON
2 SECONDS
ALWAYS OFF
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY
A/V SYNC DELAY
CUSTOM NAME
EDIT CUSTOM NAME
STATUS
2 SECONDS
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
POSITION
FORMAT
BACKGROUND
REMOTE STATE
TOP
NTSC
ON
OFF
OFF
TOP
CENTER
BOTTOM
ON
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
SECAM
PAL
ON
OFF
NTSC
for two seconds whenever a new input source is present or a new
command is received. When ALWAYS OFF is selected, the on-screen
display remains deactivated at all times, and will not reactivate until the
STATUS parameter is set to ALWAYS ON or 2 SECONDS.
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
STATUS
2 SECONDS
ALWAYS ON, 2 SEC-
ONDS, ALWAYS OFF
TOP, CENTER, BOTTOM
SECAM,PAL, NTSC
ON, OFF
Note:
POSITION
TOP
NTSC
ON
FORMAT
When the ON-SCREEN DISPLAY menu STATUS parameter is set to
ALWAYS OFF, the on-screen display immediately deactivates. Press the
OSD button or use the front-panel display as a guide to reset the
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY menu STATUS parameter to ALWAYS ON or 2
SECONDS.
BACKGROUND
REMOTE STATE
ON
ON, OFF
STATUS
ALWAYS ON, 2 SECONDS, ALWAYS OFF
POSITION
TOP, CENTER, BOTTOM
SETUP
DISPLAYS
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
STATUS
SETUP
DISPLAYS
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
POSITION
Controls the activation of the on-screen display when the display
device is connected to a Main Zone video output connector. When
ALWAYS ON is selected, the on-screen display remains activated at all
times. When 2 SECONDS is selected, the on-screen display activates
Controls the vertical alignment of the two-line status on the display
device screen. When TOP is selected, the two-line status appears
near the top of the display device screen. When CENTER is selected,
3-63
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
the two-line status appears centered on the display device screen.
When BOTTOM is selected, the two-line status appears near the
bottom of the display device screen.
Note:
When the BACKGROUND parameter is set to OFF, the on-screen
display automatically deactivates when the display device is connected
to the Main Zone component video output connector.
FORMAT
SECAM, PAL, NTSC
SETUP
DISPLAYS
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
FORMAT
REMOTE STATE
ON, OFF
SETUP
DISPLAYS
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
REMOTE STATE
Controls the compatibility between the composite and S-video
output connectors, the video switcher, and the display device.
Select the setting that is compatible with the source components
and the display device.
Activates the remote control command bank indicator, a letter that
appears in the top-right corner of the on-screen display to indicate
the command bank from which the MC-12 last received a
command. The table below indicates the letter that represents each
command bank.
Note:
The FORMAT parameter has no effect on the component video output
connector.
When ON is selected, the command bank indicator appears in the
top-right corner of the on-screen display whenever the MC-12
receives a remote control command. When OFF is selected, the
command bank indicator does not appear on the on-screen display
when the MC-12 receives a remote control command.
BACKGROUND
ON, OFF
SETUP
DISPLAYS
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
BACKGROUND
Determines the on-screen display background. When ON is
selected, the on-screen display appears over a solid blue or gray
background (depending on the display device). When OFF is
selected, the on-screen display appears over the video input signal.
Letter Indicator
Command Bank
None*
Main Zone
Zone 2
Z
R
S
Record Zone
Shift
* No letter appears when the MC-12 receives a command from the Main Zone com-
mand bank, even if the REMOTE STATE parameter is set to ON.
3-64
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
FRONT-PANEL DISPLAY
SETUP
DISPLAYS
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY
Opens the FRONT PANEL DISPLAY menu, to customize the front panel display.
MAIN MENU
SETUP
DISPLAY SETUP
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY
ALWAYS ON
2 SECONDS
ALWAYS OFF
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY
A/V SYNC DELAY
CUSTOM NAME
EDIT CUSTOM NAME
STATUS
ALWAYS ON
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
BRIGHTNESS
100%
OFF
OFF
100%
75%
50%
25%
DISPLAY DISPLAYS SETUP
BRIGHTNESS
100%, 75%, 50%, 25%
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
SETUP
DISPLAYS
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY
BRIGHTNESS
STATUS
ALWAYS ON ALWAYS ON, 2 SECONDS,
ALWAYS OFF
Controls the illumination of front-panel display characters. When a
setting is selected, front-panel display characters automatically
adjust to the selected illumination percentage.
BRIGHTNESS 100%
100%, 75%, 50%, 25%
STATUS
ALWAYS ON, 2 SECONDS, ALWAYS OFF
SETUP
DISPLAYS
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY
STATUS
Controls the activation of the front-panel display. When ALWAYS ON
is selected, the front-panel display remains activated at all times.
When 2 SECONDS is selected, the front-panel display activates for
two seconds whenever a new input source is present or a new
command is received. When ALWAYS OFF is selected, the front-panel
display remains deactivated at all times, and will not reactivate until
the STATUS parameter is reset to ALWAYS ON or 2 SECONDS.
3-65
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
VOLUME-CONTROL SETUP
SETUP
VOLUME CONTROLS
Opens the VOLUME CONTROL SETUP menu, to configure the Main
Zone, Zone 2, and Record Zone volume levels.
level to the selected value when the Main Zone is activated. When
LAST LVL is selected, the MC-12 sets Main Zone volume level to the
last volume level that was selected in the Main Zone during the
previous operating session.
SETUP
VOLUME CONTROL SETUP
MAIN MENU
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
MAIN PWR ON
MUTE LEVEL
ZONE PWR ON
REC PWR ON
MAX VOLUME
-30dB
-30dB
-30dB
-30dB
+12dB
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
MUTE LEVEL
-10dB, -20dB, -30dB, -40dB, FULL MUTE
SETUP
VOLUME CONTROLS
MUTE LEVEL
Determines the amount of attenuation that occurs in the Main
Zone when the Mute button is pressed. When a value is selected,
Main Zone volume level is attenuated to the selected value when
the Mute button is pressed. When FULL MUTE is selected, Main
Zone volume level is fully attenuated when the Mute button is
pressed.
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB
-10dB
-20dB
-30dB
-40dB
FULL MUTE
ZONE PWR ON
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB
VOLUME CONTROLS SETUP
SETUP
VOLUME CONTROLS
ZONE PWR ON
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Setting
MAIN PWR ON -30dB
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB
Selects the volume level at which Zone 2 activates. When a value is
selected, the MC-12 automatically sets Zone 2 volume level to the
selected value when Zone 2 is activated. When LAST LVL is selected,
the MC-12 sets Zone 2 volume level to the last volume level that
was selected in Zone 2 during the previous operating session.
MUTE LEVEL
-30dB
-10dB, -20dB, -30dB, -40dB,
FULL MUTE
ZONE PWR ON -30dB
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB
-80 to +12dB
REC PWR ON
MAX VOLUME
-30dB
+12dB
REC PWR ON
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB
SETUP
VOLUME CONTROLS
REC PWR ON
MAIN PWR ON
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB
Selects the volume level at which the Record Zone activates. When
a value is selected, the MC-12 automatically sets Record Zone
volume level to the selected value when the Record Zone is
activated. When LAST LVL is selected, the MC-12 sets Record Zone
SETUP
VOLUME CONTROLS
MAIN PWR ON
Selects the volume level at which the Main Zone activates. When a
value is selected, the MC-12 automatically sets Main Zone volume
3-66
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
volume level to the last volume level that was selected in the Record
Zone during the previous operating session.
MAX VOLUME
-80 to +12dB
SETUP
VOLUME CONTROLS
MAX VOLUME
Selects the maximum volume level for the Main Zone. When a
value is selected, the MC-12 automatically sets Main Zone volume
level to the selected value.
3-67
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
TRIGGER SETUP
TRIGGER SETUP
TRIGGER SETUP
REMOTE ONLY
DVD1
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
VC
CD
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
ZONE2 INPUTS
RECORD INPUTS
FILM
ON
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
5.1 MONO SURR
5.1 MONO
FILM
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
SETUP
TRIGGERS
MUSIC
MUSIC
SETUP
TRIGGER SETUP
MAIN MENU
2-CHAN
5.1a FILM
5.1a MUSIC
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
TRIGGER 1
TRIGGER 2
REMOTE
REMOTE
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
5.1a
5.1a
SurEX
MUSIC
5.1a STANDARD
5.1a 2-CHANNEL
5.1a BYPASS
2CH BYPASS
LIVE! SMALL
LIVE! MED
TV
MUSIC
MUSIC SURR
PLIIx +
PLIIx MOV
PLIIx MUS
PLII +
PLII MOVIE
PLII MUSIC
PL +
PRO LOGIC
+
LIVE! LARGE
The TRIGGERS option prompts you to select trigger output connector 1 or 2. The MC-12
includes three 12V DC trigger output connectors labeled PWR (power), 1, and 2. The PWR
connector cannot be configured because its trigger output connector is activated and
deactivated when the MC-12 is activated and deactivated or placed into standby. The other
connectors can be configured for remote or program operation.
CIN
MUSIC
NIGHTCLUB
CONCERT HHALL
CHURCH
CATHEDRAL
PANORAMA
2-CH SURROUND
2-CHANNEL
MONO LOGIC
MONO SURROUND
MONO
Selecting TRIGGER 1 or TRIGGER 2 displays the corresponding TRIGGER SETUP menu, to
configure the selected trigger output connector. The TRIGGER SETUP menu shown at the
right is used as an example. The parameters on the left side of the TRIGGER SETUP menus
are identical regardless of whether TRIGGER 1 or TRIGGER 2 is selected. The parameter
settings on the right side are adjustable. The TRIGGER SETUP menu indicates factory
default parameter settings for both connectors.
5.1 FILM
5.1 TV
5.1 MUSIC
MUSIC
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
5.1 PLIIx MOV
5.1 PLIIx MUS
DIGITAL EX
5.1 2-CHANNEL
5.1 MONO LOGIC
REMOTE ONLY
ON
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
Program Operation
OFF
All TRIGGER SETUP menu parameters – except the REMOTE ONLY parameter – are considered program operation parameters.
ON
OFF
3-68
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
TRIGGER SETUP (continued)
Note the following:
REMOTE ONLY
ON, OFF
OR
TRIGGER 1
SETUP
TRIGGER 2
REMOTE ONLY
TRIGGERS
•
Connectors can be associated with individual Main Zone inputs
and listening modes, as well as the Zone 2 and Record Zone
inputs.
Configures the selected trigger output connector for remote
operation. Select the ON setting to configure the selected
connector for remote operation. Select the OFF setting to configure
the selected connector for program operation. Refer to the Program
Operation Parameter description below for more information.
•
•
Connectors cannot be associated with individual Zone 2 and
Record Zone inputs.
Connectors can be associated with multiple inputs and
listening modes at the same time.
When configured for remote operation, the connector labeled 1
can be activated and deactivated with the MODE + and – buttons
when the Zone 2 command bank is activated, and the connector
labeled 2 can be activated and deactivated with the MODE + and –
buttons when the Record Zone command bank is activated.
Note:
When the CUSTOM menu RESET MODE option is selected to restore
the factory-default version of the selected listening mode, the
corresponding TRIGGER SETUP menu program operation parameter is
automatically set to OFF.
Note:
When the REMOTE ONLY parameter is set to ON, all TRIGGER SETUP
menu program operation parameter settings are ignored.
PROGRAM OPERATION PARAMETERS
ON, OFF
OR
SETUP
TRIGGERS
TRIGGER 1
TRIGGER 2
Program Operation Parameter
Configures the selected trigger output connector for program
operation when the REMOTE ONLY parameter is set to OFF. Select
the ON setting to associate the selected connector with the corre-
sponding input(s) or listening mode(s).
When configured for program operation, the connector is activated
and deactivated when the associated inputs or listening modes are
activated and deactivated.
3-69
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
LOCK OPTIONS
SETUP
LOCK OPTIONS
Displays the LOCK OPTIONS menu, which protects MODE ADJUST,
AUDIO CONTROLS, and SETUP menu branch parameter settings
from accidental changes.
AUDIO CNTRL
LOCKED, UNLOCKED
SETUP
LOCK OPTIONS
AUDIO CNTRL
Protects AUDIO CONTROLS menu branch settings from accidental
changes. When LOCKED is selected, AUDIO CONTROLS menu
branch settings cannot be adjusted. When UNLOCKED is selected,
AUDIO CONTROLS menu branch settings can be adjusted.
LOCK OPTIONS
MAIN MENU
SETUP
UNLOCKED
UNLOCKED
UNLOCKED
SETUP
AUDIO CNTRL
MODES
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
SETUP
SETUP
LOCKED, UNLOCKED
LOCKED
UNLOCKED
LOCK OPTIONS
SETUP
Protects SETUP menu branch settings from accidental changes.
When LOCKED is selected, SETUP menu branch settings cannot be
adjusted. When UNLOCKED is selected, SETUP menu branch
settings can be adjusted.
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
MODES
UNLOCKED
UNLOCKED
UNLOCKED
LOCKED, UNLOCKED
LOCKED, UNLOCKED
LOCKED, UNLOCKED
AUDIO CNTRL
SETUP
Note the following:
•
•
•
When the MODES parameter is set to LOCKED, the up and
down arrows can still be used to adjust subwoofer output levels
applied to the selected listening mode when the Shift
command bank is activated.
MODES
LOCKED, UNLOCKED
SETUP
LOCK OPTIONS
MODES
When the SETUP parameter is set to LOCKED, the 2CH button
can still be used to adjust the MAIN ADV menu ANALOG
BYPASS parameter setting when the Shift command bank is
activated.
Protects MODE ADJUST menu branch settings from accidental
changes. When LOCKED is selected, MODE ADJUST menu branch
settings – including all listening mode menu settings – cannot be
adjusted. When UNLOCKED is selected, all MODE ADJUST menu
branch settings can be adjusted.
When the SETUP parameter is set to LOCKED, the 7/5 button
can still be used to adjust the MAIN ADV menu INPUT SELECT
parameter setting when the Shift command bank is activated.
3-70
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
The location of the sound source (piano, guitar, voices, etc.) is not
critical. LIVE! will compensate for sounds that are closer to one micro-
phone or another.
LIVE! CALIBRATION
SETUP
LIVE! CALIBRATION
LIVE! (Lexicon Intelligent Variable Environment) is a proprietary mode
designed to transform the way your listening room sounds. LIVE! uses
a combination of microphones and digital signal processing (DSP) to
enhance the room acoustics and create the illusion of a larger, more
reverberant listening space. Use LIVE! to create a pleasing environment
to practice or perform with a musical instrument, or to create a livelier
ambience for any social activity. LIVE! CALIBRATION must be
completed before using any of the LIVE! modes.
CONNECTING THE MICROPHONES
MC-12 Rear Panel
Notes:
CAUTION!
You should run automatic calibration before running LIVE! CALIBRATION.
See page 3-35 for instructions on running an automatic calibration.
•
The Lexicon microphones require careful handling. Dropping
or otherwise physically abusing the microphones can cause
calibration errors or irreparable damage to the microphone.
Any changes to the LEVELS CALIBRATION or CROSSOVER SETUP in the
SPEAKER SETUP menu will cause LIVE! to become uncalibrated.
•
The microphone wires also require careful handling. Do not
sharply bend the wires or place objects on them.
Pressing the remote control 7/5 button will cause LIVE! to become uncalibrated.
1. Make sure the MC-12 is powered off or in standby mode.
LIVE! requires 2 microphones, available in a kit from your authorized
Lexicon dealer. (If you already own the Lexicon 4-microphone kit,
there is no need to purchase the 2-microphone kit) These microphones
should be permanently mounted in the listening room. Performing
LIVE! CALIBRATION with any microphones other than those in the kit
can produce undesirable results.
2. Connect the Lexicon microphones to the microphone input 1 and
2 connectors on the MC-12 rear panel shown above. Connector 1
is for the left microphone, connector 2 is for the right. Microphones
connected to inputs 3 and 4 will be ignored during LIVE! calibration
and operation. Make sure each microphone cable plug is fully
inserted for a solid connection.
To achieve the proper LIVE! effect your system should be configured
with a minimum of 4 speakers (Front L/R, and either side L/R or Rear
L/R). If no subwoofer is present, the crossover setting of the Front L/R
speakers should be set to FULL.
During the microphone check, the microphones will be
referred to as 1 and 2 based on the input connector to which
the microphone is connected. You should label the micro-
phones for troubleshooting purposes.
Proper microphone placement, both during calibration and when
running LIVE!, is essential to achieving the desired results. Suggested
microphone placement instructions and illustrations are included in
this section.
3. Power on the MC-12 or deactivate standby mode.
3-71
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
POSITIONING THE MICROPHONES FOR LIVE!
Refer to the microphone placement examples below to position the microphones for LIVE!
PROPER
microphone positioning for LIVE!
Position the microphones:
3 On or near opposite side walls
3 Approximately halfway between the front and
side speakers
Rear
Left
3 At an approximate height between the waist
Side
Left
and head of a standing person
Rear
Right
3 In a location unobstructed by furniture and
other fixtures
3 At least 2 feet (0.61m) from all speakers.
Side
Right
Note:
LIVE! can potentially create feedback in the system.
The processing is designed to prevent this, but you
should avoid placing the microphones too close to
speakers.
Front
Left
Microphone
Center
The illustration to the right provides an example of
proper microphone placement during LIVE! calibration
and also for permanent location.
Subwoofer
Front
Right
3-72
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Setup
IMPROPER
microphone positioning for LIVE!
When positioning the microphones, do
not:
7 Place the microphones on the front or rear walls
7 Place the microphones near the floor or ceiling
Rear
Left
7 Obstruct the microphones with furniture or other
fixtures
Side
Left
Rear
7 Place the microphones within 2 feet (0.61m) of
Right
any speaker.
The illustration to the right provides an example of
improper microphone placement for LIVE! calibration
or for a permanent location.
Side
Right
Front
Left
Center
Microphone
Subwoofer
Front
Right
3-73
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup
Lexicon
PERFORMING LIVE! CALIBRATION
L
I
V
E!
!CA
HIGH AU
YOU WILL E 10 SEC
TO LEAVE
SIT QU
PRESS
C
A
LI
TI
IOLEVELS
R
ATION
LIVE! CALIBRATION
LIVE! CALIBRATION
IN PROGRESS
SETUP
MAIN MENU
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
U
O
N!
TEST WILL BEGIN IN
10
LIVE! CALIBRATION
D
CALIBRATION DONE
T
H
A
V
PRESS TO SKIP
COUNTDOWN
HE
R
OOM OR
PLEASE WAIT
I
E
TLY
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
PRESS TO CONTINUE
T
O
BEGIN
COUNTDOWN
LIVE! CALIBRATION
SIGNAL TOO LOW
PRESS TO CONTINUE
Select SETUP ꢀ LIVE! CALIBRATION as shown above.
•
The !CAUTION! HIGH AUDIO LEVELS message indicates that the MC-
12 generates loud calibration noise signals during LIVE! calibration. If
the signals become too loud, press the ꢃ arrow button to cancel
LIVE! calibration. Press the ꢀ arrow button to begin calibration.
•
SIGNAL TOO LOW
Indicates that the microphones failed to pick up sufficient cali-
bration noise signals for calibration to complete.
•
The countdown display notifies you that LIVE! calibration begins in
10 seconds. The primary reason for the 10 second delay is to give
you time to leave the listening space before automatic calibration
begins. If you choose to remain in the room, your movements
could affect the calibration results. If you leave the room, you can
return in about 3 minutes (the calibration procedure should be
completed). Press the ꢀ arrow button to skip the countdown
and begin LIVE! calibration. The MC-12 automatically activates
LIVE! calibration when the countdown ends.
After reading the message, press ꢀ to continue.
If the SIGNAL TOO LOW message appeared:
•
Examine microphone input connections to ensure that the
microphones are properly connected to the MC-12 in
microphone inputs 1 and 2 and that microphone cable plugs
are fully inserted for a solid connection.
•
•
Examine the speakers and the associated amplifier to ensure
that speaker wires are connected and the amplifier is on.
When the LIVE! calibration is finished, the LIVE CALIBRATION results
screen displays one of the two following messages.
Run a Microphone Check to determine if a microphone has
microphones.
•
CALIBRATION DONE
Indicates that no errors occurred during the calibration procedure.
3-74
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Audio Controls
Lexicon
AUDIO CONTROLS
Selecting the MAIN MENU AUDIO CONTROLS option opens the AUDIO CONTROLS menu, to customize the Main Zone, Zone 2, and Record
Zone audio output connectors.
MAIN MENU
AUDIO CONTROLS
BASS
TREBLE
TILT EQ
LOUDNESS
BALANCE
FADER
+0.0dB
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
OFF
<I>
<I>
ZONE2 BALANCE
RECORD BALANCE <I>
<I>
ON
OFF
-3.0 to +3.0dB
-6.0 to +6.0dB
L<
<L>
>R
B<
<L>
>F
Default Setting
•
The BASS, TREBLE, TILT EQ, LOUDNESS, BALANCE, and FADER
parameters affect the Main Zone audio output connectors. This
includes all Main Zone inputs and listening modes, except the
5.1a BYPASS and 2CH BYPASS listening modes.
Parameter
Possible Settings
BASS
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
OFF
-6.0 to +6.0dB
-6.0 to +6.0dB
-3.0 to +3.0dB
ON, OFF
TREBLE
•
•
The ZONE2 BALANCE parameter affects the Zone 2 audio
output connectors, including all Zone 2 inputs.
TILT EQ
LOUDNESS
BALANCE
FADER
The REC BALANCE parameter affects the Record Zone audio
output connectors, including all Record Zone inputs.
<|>
L< to <|> to >R
B< to <|> to >F
L< to <|> to >R
B< to <|> to >F
<|>
ZONE2 BALANCE <|>
REC BALANCE <|>
AUDIO CONTROLS menu parameter descriptions begin on the next page.
4-2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Audio Controls
BASS
AUDIO CONTROLS
-6.0dB to +6.0dB
BASS
BASS
Controls the amount of low-frequency boost or cut applied to the
Main Zone audio output connectors labeled Front L/R, Center, LFE,
and Subwoofer L/R. The graph to the right indicates the frequency
response of all BASS parameter settings.
To control the bass from the remote control:
Press the Shift button:
•
•
•
Press the CD button to increase the BASS parameter setting in
0.5dB increments.
Press the TAPE button to decrease the BASS parameter setting
in 0.5dB increments.
Press the OSD button to set the BASS, TREBLE, and TILT EQ
parameters to +0.0dB.
The BASS parameter controls the amount of low-frequency boost or cut applied to the
Main Zone audio output connectors labeled Front L/R, Center, LFE, and Subwoofer L/R.
4-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Audio Controls
Lexicon
TREBLE
AUDIO CONTROLS
-6.0dB to +6.0dB
TREBLE
TREBLE
Controls the amount of boost or cut applied to the Main Zone
audio output connectors labeled Front L/R and Center. The graph
shown at the right indicates the frequency response of all TREBLE
parameter settings.
To control the treble from the remote control:
Press the Shift button:
•
•
•
Press the PVR button to increase the TREBLE parameter setting
in 0.5dB increments.
Press the TUNER button to decrease the TREBLE parameter
setting in 0.5dB increments.
Press the OSD button to set the BASS, TREBLE, and TILT EQ
parameters to +0.0dB.
The TREBLE parameter controls the amount of boost or cut applied to the Main
Zone audio output connectors labeled Front L/R and Center.
4-4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Audio Controls
TILT EQ
AUDIO CONTROLS
-3.0 to +3.0
TILT EQ
TILT EQ
Controls the amount of tilt equalization applied to the Main Zone
audio output connectors labeled Front L/R, Center, LFE, and
Subwoofer L/R. This parameter setting affects the entire frequency
spectrum with a hinge point at 1kHz. As the setting increases,
frequencies higher than 1kHz are boosted while frequencies lower
than 1kHz are simultaneously cut. As the setting decreases,
frequencies higher than 1kHz are cut while frequencies lower than
1kHz are simultaneously boosted. The graph shown at the right
indicates the frequency response of all TILT EQ parameter settings.
To control the tilt EQ from the remote control:
Press the Shift button:
•
•
•
Press the GAME button to increase the TILT EQ parameter
setting in 0.5dB increments.
Press the AUX button to decrease the TILT EQ parameter setting
in 0.5dB increments.
Press the OSD button to set the BASS, TREBLE, and TILT EQ
parameters to +0.0dB.
The TILT EQ parameter controls the amount of tilt equalization applied to the Main
Zone audio output connectors labeled Front L/R, Center, LFE, and Subwoofer L/R.
4-5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Audio Controls
Lexicon
LOUDNESS
AUDIO CONTROLS
ON, OFF
LOUDNESS
LOUDNESS
Controls the amount of low-frequency boost that is automatically
applied to the Main Zone audio output connectors labeled Front
L/R, Center, LFE, and Subwoofer L/R. When ON is selected,
loudness compensation is automatically applied based on volume
level. As volume level increases, the amount of low-frequency boost
automatically decreases. The loudness contour is optimized for
input sources calibrated to THX reference levels. When OFF is
selected, no loudness compensation is applied.
The graph shown at the right indicates the frequency response that
is automatically applied when the LOUDNESS parameter is set to
ON and Main Zone volume level is adjusted.
To control the loudness from the remote control:
Press the Shift button:
•
•
Press the TV button to turn the LOUDNESS to on.
Press the SAT button to turn the LOUDNESS off.
The LOUDNESS parameter controls the amount of low-frequency boost that is
automatically applied to the Main Zone audio output connectors labeled Front
L/R, Center, LFE, and Subwoofer L/R.
4-6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Audio Controls
BALANCE
L< <|> >R
ZONE2 BALANCE
L< <|> >R
BALANCE
ZONE2 BALANCE
AUDIO CONTROLS
AUDIO CONTROLS
Controls the left-to-right balance of the Main Zone audio output
connectors labeled Front L/R.
Controls the left-to-right balance of the Zone 2 audio output
connectors.
To control the balance from the remote control:
To control the Zone 2 balance from the remote control:
Press the Shift button:
Press the ZONE button:
•
•
Press the MENU button to center the Main Zone balance.
•
•
Press the MENU button to center the Zone2 balance.
Press the ꢃor ꢀarrow buttons to adjust the Main Zone
balance left and right.
Press the ꢃ or ꢀ arrow buttons to adjust the Zone2 balance
left and right.
FADER
B< <|> >F
RECORD BALANCE
L< <|> >R
FADER
RECORD BALANCE
AUDIO CONTROLS
AUDIO CONTROLS
Controls the front-to-back balance of the Main Zone audio output
connectors labeled Front L/R.
Controls the left-to-right balance of the Record Zone analog audio
output connectors.
To control the fade from the remote control:
To control the balance from the remote control:
Press the Shift button:
Press the REC button:
•
•
Press the MENU button to center the Main Zone fader.
•
•
Press the MENU button to center the Main Zone balance.
Press the ꢁ or ꢂ arrow buttons to adjust the Main Zone fader
backward and forward.
Press the ꢃ or ꢀ arrow buttons to adjust the record balance
left and right.
4-7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
5
Mode Adjust
Mode Adjust ...............................................................................5-2
Listening Mode Activation...........................................................5-2
Preferred Listening Mode Selection Parameters ........................................ 5-3
Mode Buttons .......................................................................................... 5-4
Mode Family Selection Buttons ................................................................ 5-4
Listening Mode Descriptions .......................................................5-5
Listening Mode Menu Option & Parameter Descriptions...........5-37
Mode – Parameter Relationships ...............................................5-45
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
MODE ADJUST
MAIN MENU
MODE ADJUST
MODE ADJUST
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
FILM
TV
5.1a
5.1a
5.1a
5.1a
FILM
MUSIC
*
Selecting MAIN MENUꢀ MODE ADJUST displays the MODE ADJUST
menu, to select a listening mode. Selecting a listening mode opens the
corresponding listening mode menu, to customize the selected
listening mode. These adjustments are applied when the listening
mode is next activated.
MUSIC
MUSIC SURR
PLIIx +
PLIIx MOV
PLIIx MUS
PLII +
PLII MOVIE
PLII MUSIC
PL +
MUSIC
5.1a STANDARD
5.1a 2-CHANNEL
5.1a BYPASS
2CH BYPASS
LIVE! SMALL
LIVE! MED
All listening mode menus are shown in the Appendix. The parameters
on the left side of the menus differ from listening mode to listening
mode. The parameter settings on the right side are adjustable.
Factory-default parameter settings are shown for each listening mode.
LIVE! LARGE
PRO LOGIC
+
CIN
MUSIC
NIGHTCLUB
CONCERT HALL
CHURCH
When the MODE ADJUST menu opens, the activated listening mode is
highlighted. To activate a different listening mode, you must use one
of the methods described in “Listening Mode Activation” below.
CATHEDRAL
PANORAMA
2-CH SURROUND
2-CHANNEL
MONO LOGIC
MONO SURROUND
MONO
LISTENING MODE ACTIVATION
The MC-12 allows listening mode activation in the Main Zone.
Listening modes are available for 2-channel, Dolby Digital, DTS-ES,
analog, and microphone sources. In some cases, the MC-12 automati-
cally activates a listening mode in response to certain commands. For
this reason, it is important to understand the three methods through
which listening mode activation occurs.
5.1
5.1
5.1
FILM
TV
MUSIC
*
MUSIC
5.1 PLIIx MOV
5.1 PLIIx MUS
DIGITAL*
5.1 2-CHANNEL
5.1 MONO LOGIC
5.1 MONO SURR
5.1 MONO
Listening modes activation occurs through:
•
The INPUT SETUP menu preferred listening mode selection
parameters.
* These listening mode
names differ depend-
ing on the current
input source, speaker
setup, and parame-
ter settings. Refer to
the Listening Mode
Descriptions begin-
more information.
FILM*
MUSIC*
*
•
•
The front panel or remote control Mode ꢁand ꢂbuttons.
The remote control mode family selection buttons (THX, Dolby
Digital, LOGIC 7, TVL, DTS, and MUSIC).
MUSIC
*
2-CHAN*
5-2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
PREFERRED LISTENING MODE SELECTION
PARAMETERS
DVD1 INPUT SETUP
CD INPUT SETUP
NAME
DVD1
COAX-1
NONE
NAME
CD
COAX-4
NONE
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN COMPOSITE-1
COMPONENT IN
You can select five preferred listening modes for each Main Zone
input, including one listening mode each for 2-channel, Dolby
Digital, DTS-ES, 5.1-channel analog, and microphone sources. The
table below indicates the INPUT SETUP menu parameters that can
be used to select preferred listening modes.
AUTO
AUTO
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
S-VIDEO-1
1
1
MUSIC
MUSIC
MUSIC
FILM
2-CH
FILM
FILM
FILM
2-CH
D
5.1
5.1a
D
5.1
5.1a
MIC
FILM
5.1a
MIC
5.1a
LIVE! MED
LIVE! MED
Preferred Listening Mode Selection Parameters
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
2-CH
Selects a preferred listening mode for 2-channel
sources
RECORD ADVANCED
RECORD ADVANCED
D
Selects a preferred listening mode for Dolby Digital
sources
•
•
If the DVD1 input is selected while a 2-channel source is
present, the MC-12 automatically activates the L7 FILM
listening mode. If a 5.1-channel analog source becomes
present, the MC-12 automatically activates the 5.1a L7 FILM
listening mode.
Selects a preferred listening mode for DTS-ES
sources
5.1a
MIC
Selects a preferred listening mode for 5.1-channel
analog sources
If the CD input is selected while a Dolby Digital source is
present, the MC-12 automatically activates the 5.1 L7 MUSIC
listening mode. If the DVD1 input is then selected while a
DTS-ES source is present, the MC-12 automatically activates
the DTS or DTS-ES L7 FILM listening mode.
Selects a preferred LIVE! listening mode for micro-
phone sources.
When a preferred listening mode is selected, the MC-12 automati-
cally activates that listening mode whenever a new input is selected
or an appropriate input source is present. For example, the DVD1
and CD INPUT SETUP menu preferred listening mode selection
parameters are set as shown at the top of the next column.
Note:
Refer to the Selecting Preferred Listening Modes section that begins on
page 3-12 for more information.
5-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
MODE BUTTONS
MODE FAMILY SELECTION BUTTONS
Use the front panel and remote control Mode buttons to audition
listening modes with the current Main Zone input source. Press the
Mode + or – button to scroll up or down through the available
listening modes for the current Main Zone input source. For
example, if a 2-channel source is present in the Main Zone, the
Mode buttons can be used to audition 2-channel listening modes.
The remote control mode family selection buttons select a listening
mode within the corresponding mode family. Pressing a mode
family selection button activates the most appropriate listening
mode for the current Main Zone input source. For example,
pressing the L7 button while a 2-channel source is present in the
Main Zone activates the L7 FILM listening mode.
Scrolling occurs in the order shown on the MODE ADJUST menu.
The selected listening mode appears in the bottom-left corner of
the Main Zone two-line status. The selected listening mode is
automatically activated when scrolling stops.
The table below indicates the listening modes associated with each
mode family selection button.
Input Source
2-Channel
5.1 Dolby Digital
DTS-ES
5.1a Channel Analog
Button
DOLBY PLIIx + THX†
THX*
Dolby DIGITAL*
5.1 L7 FILM
5.1 L7 TV
DTS-ES THX*
5.1a THX*
DOLBY PLIIx MOVIE†
L7 FILM
N/A**
DTS-ES L7 FILM*
N/A**
N/A**
5.1a L7 FILM
N/A**
L7 TV
DTS Neo:6 CIN††
L7 MUSIC
N/A**
DTS-ES*
N/A**
5.1 L7 MUSIC
DTS-ES L7 MUSIC*
5.1a L7 MUSIC
*
These listening mode names differ depending on the current input source, speaker setup, and parameter settings. Refer to the Listening Mode Descriptions section that begins on the
next page for more information.
** The MODE SELECTION NOT AVAILABLE message appears on the on-screen and front panel displays when the selected listening mode family does not offer a listening mode for the
current Main Zone input source.
†
When a 7-speaker configuration is in use, the DPLIIx variant of this mode is loaded.
†† The MODE SELECTION NOT AVAILABLE message appears on the on-screen and front panel displays if the input has a sampling rate of 96kHz. This includes analog inputs converted to 96kHz.
5-4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
LISTENING MODE DESCRIPTIONS
The MC-12 offers an assortment of listening modes for 2-channel, Dolby Digital, DTS-ES, analog, and microphone sources. Listening mode
descriptions begin below and continue in the order shown on the MODE ADJUST menu. The table included with each description indicates the
corresponding listening mode menu parameters, as well as their factory-default and possible parameter settings. All listening mode menus are
shown in the Appendix. Descriptions of the listening mode parameters begin on page 5-37.
FILM
TV
FILM
MODE ADJUST
TV
MODE ADJUST
This listening mode designed for enhanced playback of 2-channel
stereo or matrix-encoded film sources.
This listening mode is designed for playback of 2-channel stereo or
matrix-encoded television broadcast sources.
LOGIC 7 FILM is a proprietary Lexicon listening mode that derives
seven channels from 2-channel input sources. Logic 7 also derives
full-frequency stereo surround channels that realistically increase
the perceived width, length and sense of envelopment of the
listening space. Logic 7 provides remarkable improvement
compared to other decoders.
LOGIC 7 TV is a proprietary Lexicon listening mode based on the
LOGIC 7 FILM listening mode, but specifically tailored for broadcast
sources.
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
AUTO AZIMUTH
ON
ON, OFF
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM
ON, OFF
FRONT STEERING
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
FILM
OFF
AUTO AZIMUTH
ON
ON, OFF
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB
ON, OFF
REAR
FRONT, NEUTRAL, REAR
ON, OFF
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
ON
5 SPKR ENHANCE ON
REAR
FRONT, NEUTRAL, REAR
ON, OFF
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
OFF
ON, OFF
5 SPKR ENHANCE ON
7.0kHz
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF
OFF, 1 to 30ms
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
OFF
ON, OFF
15ms
7.0kHz
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF
OFF, 1 to 30ms
Refer to page 5-35
Refer to page 5-35
REAR DLY OFFSET 15ms
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
descriptions.
descriptions.
5-5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
MUSIC
MUSIC SURR
MODE ADJUST
MUSIC
MODE ADJUST
MUSIC SURR
This listening mode is designed for playback of 2-channel stereo or
matrix-encoded music sources.
This listening mode is designed for playback of 2-channel stereo
music sources recorded in real spaces and for playback of
recordings that contain added reverb. It is recommended for
classical music sources, which are often recorded in real spaces with
added reverb to enhance the stereo mix.
LOGIC 7 MUSIC is a proprietary Lexicon listening mode based on
the LOGIC 7 FILM listening mode, but specifically tailored for music
sources. .
LOGIC 7 MUSIC SURR is a proprietary Lexicon listening mode that
is similar to the MUSIC SURROUND listening mode in other Lexicon
products. Logic 7 extracts ambient sounds from the input source
and sends these sounds to all speakers. Ambient sounds are heard
from all directions, creating a realistic playback presentation that
simulates what listeners experience in real spaces.
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
VOCAL ENHANCE
FRONT STEERING
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
+0.0dB
MUSIC
NEUTRAL
ON
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM
FRONT, NEUTRAL, REAR
ON, OFF
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
OFF
ON, OFF
VOCAL ENHANCE
FRONT STEERING
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
+0.0dB
MSURR
NEUTRAL
ON
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB
7.0kHz
15ms
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF
OFF, 1 to 30ms
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM
FRONT, NEUTRAL, REAR
ON, OFF
Refer to page 5-35
OFF
ON, OFF
descriptions.
7.0kHz
15ms
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF
OFF, 1 to 30ms
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
5-6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
PLIIx +
MODE ADJUST
&
PLIIx +
PLII +
PLIIx MOV &
PLII MOVIE
OR
OR
PLII +
MODE ADJUST
MODE ADJUST
MODE ADJUST
PLII MOVIE
PLIIx MOV
The Dolby PLIIx + THX and Dolby PLII + THX listening modes are
designed to playback 7.1 or 5.1 discrete channels decoded from
2-channel Dolby Surround-encoded sources. The seven or five main
channels are full frequency. The .1 channel, often referred to as LFE
information, has a limited frequency range of up to 120Hz. The PLIIx
listening mode is only available when the front, side and rear speakers
are present.
The Dolby PLIIx MOV (MOVIE) and Dolby PLII MOVIE listening modes
are designed to playback 7.1 or 5.1 discrete channels decoded from
2-channel Dolby Surround-encoded film sources. The seven or five
main channels are full frequency. The .1 channel, often referred to as
LFE information, has a limited frequency range of up to 120Hz. The
PLIIx listening mode is only available when the front, side and rear
speakers are present.
Note:
Note:
The PLIIx mode does not appear in the list of available listening modes if
either the side or rear speakers are missing from the configuration.
The PLIIx MOV mode does not appear in the list of available listening modes
if either the side or rear speakers are missing from the configuration.
The modes are recommended for home theaters with THX-certified
speakers. Dolby PLII(x) + THX encoding:
Dolby PLII MOVIE and Dolby PLIIx MOV modes:
•
•
Are designed for playback of Dolby Surround-encoded sources.
•
Apply THX re-equalization to simulate high-frequency rolloffs
that occur in movie theaters. Most films are mixed for movie
theaters, and might sound too bright when played back in
home theaters without re-equalization.
Provide impressive enhancement compared to Dolby Pro Logic
decoding.
Dolby PLII MOVIE decodes five channels from Dolby
Surround-encoded sources. Dolby PLIIx MOV decodes seven
channels from Dolby Surround-encoded sources.
•
Apply THX timbre matching to minimize timbre differences
between the front and surround channels, which results in
smoother sound movements between them.
Parameter
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
RE-EQUALIZER
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
ON
ON, OFF
Refer to page 5-35
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
descriptions.
5-7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
PLIIx MUS &
PLII MUSIC
PL +
MODE ADJUST
OR
MODE ADJUST
PLIIx MUS
MODE ADJUST
PLII MUSIC
PL +
The Dolby PLIIx MUS (MUSIC) and Dolby PLII MUSIC listening modes
are designed to playback 7.1 or 5.1 discrete channels decoded from
2-channel music sources. The seven or five main channels are full
frequency. The .1 channel, often referred to as LFE information, has a
limited frequency range of up to 120Hz. The PLIIx listening mode is
only available when the front, side and rear speakers are present.
This mode is designed for playback of Dolby Surround-encoded
sources and decodes four channels: three front channels and one
mono surround channel with a high-frequency rolloff above 7kHz.
This mode is recommended for home theaters with THX-certified
speakers. Dolby PL + THX mode:
•
Applies THX re-equalization to simulate high-frequency rolloffs
that occur in movie theaters. Most films are mixed for movie
theaters, and may sound too bright when played back in home
theaters without re-equalization.
Note:
The PLIIx MUS mode does not appear in the list of available listening modes
if either the side or rear speakers are missing from the configuration.
•
Applies THX timbre matching to minimize timbre differences
between the front and surround channels, which results in
smoother sound movements between them.
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
PANORAMA
CTR WIDTH
DIMENSION
OFF
ON, OFF
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
3
MIN, 1 to 6, MAX
FRONT, NEUTRAL, REAR
0 to 15ms
RE-EQUALIZER
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
ON
ON, OFF
NEUTRAL
Refer to page 5-35
SURROUND DLY 10ms
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
descriptions.
5-8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
PRO LOGIC
+
MODE ADJUST
PRO LOGIC
+
MODE ADJUST
The Dolby PRO LOGIC mode is designed for playback of Dolby
Surround-encoded sources. It decodes four channels from Dolby
Surround-encoded sources, and uses a mono surround channel
with a high-frequency rolloff above 7kHz.
This mode is designed for playback of matrix-encoded digital stereo
film sources. DTS NEO:6 derives six channels when both side and rear
speakers are present (rear channels will be in parallel). It derives five
channels when only side or rear speakers are present.
This mode is useful for comparison purposes, particularly with the
L7 FILM, Dolby PLIIx MOVIE and DTS Neo:6 CIN listening mode.
In addition to THX processing, THX re-equalization is applied to
simulate high-frequency rolloffs that occur in movie theaters. Most
films are mixed for movie theaters, and may sound too bright when
played back in home theaters without re-equalization.
Parameter
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
Refer to page 5-35
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
RE-EQUALIZER
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
ON
ON, OFF
descriptions.
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
5-9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
NIGHTCLUB
CIN &
MUSIC
OR
MODE ADJUST
NIGHTCLUB
CIN
MUSIC
MODE ADJUST
The NIGHTCLUB mode is designed for playback of “dry” music
sources that benefit from the addition of room reflections,
especially music sources that lack ambience in the recording. The
NIGHTCLUB mode generates early reflections and sends them to
the front, side and rear channels to simulate small, intimate
listening spaces.
These modes are designed for playback of matrix-encoded digital
stereo film or music sources. DTS Neo:6 derives six channels when
both side and rear speakers are present (rear channels will be in
parallel). It derives five channels when only side or rear speakers are
present. The LFE channel is generated through bass management in
the MC-12.
The NIGHTCLUB mode is a superior room simulation listening
mode because it uses a proprietary reverb algorithm inherited from
Lexicon professional products.
Parameter
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
Refer to page 5-35
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
descriptions.
CENTER DEPTH
SPEECH DETECT
SIZE
11
0 to 18
ON
ON, OFF
5m
4 to 20m
Note the following:
LIVENESS
196ms
30ms to 20.2s
OFF, 1 to 100ms
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF
-12 to +6dB
•
The DTS Neo:6 CIN or MUSIC listening modes cannot be
assigned as preferred listening modes for 2-channel sources.
However, when the 2-CH parameter is set to USE LAST, the
MC-12 automatically activates the DTS Neo:6 CIN or MUSIC
listening mode if the mode was active the last time a 2-channel
source was present.
PRE-DELAY
ROLLOFF
5ms
9.0kHz
EFFECT LVL
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
+3dB
Refer to page 5-35
•
•
The MC-12 will not automatically activate a DTS Neo:6 listening
mode unless a 44.1kHz or 48kHz PCM digital source is present.
The DTS Neo:6 listening modes are not available with 88.2kHz
or 96kHz, Dolby Digital, or analog sources.
descriptions.
The DTS Neo:6 MUSIC listening mode can be activated with
the front-panel or remote control Mode buttons. The DTS
Neo:6 CIN listening mode can also activated with the remote
control DTS button when a 2-channel input source is present.
5-10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
CONCERT HALL
CHURCH
MODE ADJUST
CONCERT HALL
MODE ADJUST
CHURCH
The CONCERT HALL mode generates early reflections and sends
them to the front, side and rear channels to simulate large listening
spaces.
The CHURCH mode uses a reverb algorithm to emphasize the rich,
smooth, reverberant decay characteristic of small and medium
listening spaces with long reverberation time relative to their size,
such as churches and chambers.
The CONCERT HALL mode is a superior room simulation listening
mode because it uses a proprietary reverb algorithm inherited from
Lexicon professional products.
The CHURCH mode is a superior room simulation listening mode
because it uses a proprietary reverb algorithm inherited from
Lexicon professional products.
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
CENTER DEPTH
SPEECH DETECT
SIZE
12
0 to 18
CENTER DEPTH
SPEECH DETECT
SIZE*
5
0 to 18
ON
ON, OFF
ON
ON, OFF
20m
4 to 20m
20m
4 to 30m
LIVENESS
1.72s
30ms to 20.2s
OFF, 1 to 100ms
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF
-12 to +6dB
MID RT*
1.56s
24ms to 24.3s
5ms to 48.6s
OFF, 1 to 100ms
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF
-12 to +6dB
PRE-DELAY
ROLLOFF
OFF
BASS RT*
1.87s
2.4kHz
PRE-DELAY
ROLLOFF
24ms
EFFECT LVL
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
-2dB
2.4kHz
Refer to page 5-35
EFFECT LVL
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
-3dB
Refer to page 5-35
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
* BASS RT, MID RT, and SIZE parameter settings are interdependent, meaning that the full
parameter range might not be available depending on the other parameter settings.
descriptions.
5-11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
CATHEDRAL
PANORAMA
MODE ADJUST
CATHEDRAL
MODE ADJUST
PANORAMA
The CATHEDRAL mode is similar to the CHURCH listening mode. It
uses a reverb algorithm to emphasize the rich, smooth, reverberant
decay characteristic of large listening spaces with long reverber-
ation time relative to their size, such as cathedrals.
The PANORAMA mode is designed for playback of stereo and
matrix-encoded sources. PANORAMA uses proprietary Lexicon
algorithms to move the stereo image outward from the front
speakers, producing a wider stereo field with greater depth.
The CATHEDRAL mode is a superior room simulation listening
mode because it uses a proprietary reverb algorithm inherited from
Lexicon professional products.
Sound quality depends on proper location of the listening position
and front speakers. When the front speakers are positioned close to
either side of the display device, the effect is produced over a wider
area than when the front speakers are positioned at a large angle
from the display device.
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
CENTER DEPTH
SPEECH DETECT
SIZE*
12
0 to 18
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
ON
ON, OFF
EFFECT LVL
+4dB
STEREO
+0
-12 to +6dB
30m
4 to 30m
BASS CONTENT
LOW FREQ WIDTH
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
INPUT BALANCE
CALIBRATION
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
BINAURL, MONO, STEREO
-25 to +25dB
MID RT*
3.72s
24ms to 24.3s
5ms to 48.6s
OFF, 1 to 100ms
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF
-12 to +6dB
BASS RT*
4.47s
3.1kHz
15ms
<|>
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF
OFF, 1 to 30ms
PRE-DELAY
ROLLOFF
23ms
3.1kHz
L< to <|> to >R
EFFECT LVL
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
-8dB
Refer to next column
Refer to page 5-35
*
BASS RT, MID RT, and SIZE parameter settings are interdependent, meaning that the
full parameter range might not be available depending on the other parameter
settings.
descriptions.
descriptions.
5-12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
PANORAMA CALIBRATION
CALIBRATION
MODE ADJUST
PANORAMA
Select PANORAMA ꢀ CALIBRATION to open
the PANORAMA CALIBRATION menu shown
to the left, to calibrate the PANORAMA
listening mode. This listening mode must be
calibrated to take full advantage of its
effects.
An external calibration source is required to calibrate the
PANORAMA listening mode. You should select a familiar stereo
source.
PANORAMA CALIBRATION
SOURCE LEFT & RIGHT
SPEAKER ANGLE 30deg
LISTENER POS
+0
NOTE:
ENSURE THAT
“SPEAKER SETUP” HAS
BEEN PROPERLY
PERFORMED
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
SOURCE
LEFT & RIGHT
30deg
RIGHT, LEFT & RIGHT, LEFT
For best results, you should center the
primary listening position between the front
left and right speakers as shown in illus-
SPEAKER ANGLE
LISTENER POS
10deg to 90deg
-127 to +127
+0
tration B at the top of the next page (center). Otherwise, the
PANORAMA listening mode will be calibrated with varying results.
descriptions.
5-13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
A
B
C
To calibrate the PANORAMA listening mode:
buttons. Each increment within the –127 to +127 parameter
range represents about one-third of an inch. Illustration A
shows the left of center position. Illustration C shows the right
of center position
1. Remove all obstructions between the speakers and the primary
listening position.
2. Make sure the distances between the speakers and the primary
listening position are properly measured. To do this, select one
of the following options.
4. Set the SOURCE parameter to RIGHT.
5. Begin playback of the external calibration source.
6. When playback of the external calibration source is in progress,
set the SPEAKER ANGLE parameter so the sound is not heard in
the right ear.
•
Select the AUTO SPEAKER SETUP menu DISTANCES option to
have the MC-12 automatically calibrate speaker distances.
•
Measure the distance between the primary listening posi-
tion and the front baffle of each speaker. Then, set the cor-
responding SPEAKER DISTANCES menu parameters to the
closest available value.
7. To confirm the LISTENER POS and SPEAKER ANGLE parameter
settings, set the SOURCE parameter to LEFT & RIGHT. If the
PANORAMA listening mode is properly calibrated, the sound
should be perceived to come from all around the primary
listening position. If not, go back to Step 1 and repeat the cali-
bration procudure.
3. Sit in the primary listening position. If the primary listening
position is not centered between the front left and right
speakers as shown in illustration B (above), set the PANORAMA
CALIBRATION ꢀ LISTENER POS parameter to compensate for
the difference using the remote control ꢁ and ꢂ arrow
5-14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
2-CH SURROUND
MONO LOGIC
MODE ADJUST
2-CH SURROUND
MODE ADJUST
MONO LOGIC
This mode, designed for playback of stereo sources, sends the left
channel to Front, Side, and Rear Left channels and the right channel
to Front, Side and Rear Right channels, and sums the Left and Right
for the center. It is recommended for background music.
This mode, designed for playback of mono sources, uses proprietary
Lexicon reverb algorithms to realistically expand mono sources to
use all channels. This dramatically increases the perceived width
and sense of envelopment of the listening space.
Parameter
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
Refer to page 5-35
EFFECT LVL
-9dB
-12dB to +6dB
ON, OFF
ACADEMY FILTER
SURR ROLLOFF
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
ON
3.1kHz
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF
descriptions.
2-CHANNEL
descriptions.
MODE ADJUST
2-CHANNEL
This mode, designed for playback of stereo sources, sends the left and
right channels to the Front L/R and Subwoofer channels. It is recom-
mended for two-speaker playback with subwoofers and for
comparison purposes with other listening modes.
Note:
When the remote control Shift command bank is activated, pressing the
TVL button activates the MONO LOGIC listening mode for 2-channel
sources.
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
SUB LEVEL
CUSTOM
+0dB
OFF, -30dB to +12dB
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
5-15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
MONO SURROUND
5.1 FILM
MODE ADJUST
MONO SURROUND
MODE ADJUST
5.1
FILM
This mode, designed for playback of mono sources, sends the
mono source to all channels.
The 5.1 L7 FILM mode is a proprietary Lexicon listening mode
designed for playback of 5.1-channel Dolby Digital-encoded film
sources, and provides remarkable improvement compared to other
decoders.
Parameter
It derives seven channels from 5.1-channel input sources with
enhanced front steering. When both side and rear speakers are
present, the 5.1 L7 FILM listening mode also increases the perceived
length and sense of envelopment of the listening space.
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
MONO
MODE ADJUST
VOCAL ENHANCE
FRONT STEERING
+0.0dB
FILM
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB
MONO
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC,
FILM
This mode, designed for playback of mono sources, sends mono
sources to the center channel.
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
ON
ON, OFF
REAR
REAR, NEUTRAL, FRONT
ON, OFF
ON
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
OFF
ON, OFF
SUB LEVEL
CUSTOM
+0dB
OFF, -30dB to +12dB
7kHz
500HZ to 20kHz, OFF
OFF, 1ms to 30ms
AUTO, ON, OFF
-10.0dB to +0.0dB
Refer to page 5-35
15ms
descriptions.
OFF
+0.0dB
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
5-16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
5.1 MUSIC
5.1
TV
MODE ADJUST
5.1
MUSIC
MODE ADJUST
5.1
TV
This proprietary Lexicon listening mode is designed for playback of
5.1-channel Dolby Digital-encoded music sources. Based on the 5.1
L7 FILM listening mode, 5.1 L7 MUSIC derives seven channels from
5.1-channel input sources with enhanced front steering.
This proprietary Lexicon listening mode is designed for playback of
5.1-channel Dolby Digital-encoded broadcast sources. Based on the
5.1 L7 FILM listening mode, 5.1 L7 TV derives seven channels from
5.1-channel input sources with enhanced front steering.
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
VOCAL ENHANCE
FRONT STEERING
+0.0dB
MUSIC
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB
VOCAL ENHANCE
FRONT STEERING
+0.0dB
FILM
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC,
FILM
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC,
FILM
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
OFF
OFF, ON
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
OFF
OFF, ON
NEUTRAL
REAR, NEUTRAL, FRONT
ON, OFF
REAR
REAR, NEUTRAL, FRONT
ON, OFF
ON
ON
OFF
ON, OFF
OFF
ON, OFF
7kHz
500HZ to 20kHz, OFF
OFF, 1ms to 30ms
AUTO, ON, OFF
-10.0dB to +0.0dB
7kHz
500HZ to 20kHz, OFF
OFF, 1ms to 30ms
AUTO, ON, OFF
-10.0dB to +0.0dB
15ms
15ms
OFF
OFF
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
descriptions.
5-17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
,
UL2Cin &
SurEX
OR
OR
MODE ADJUST
UL2Cin
SurEX
These modes are designed for 7-channel playback of 5.1-channel
Dolby Digital film sources that do not have THX Surround EX
encoding. They apply THX re-equalization to simulate
high-frequency rolloffs that occur in movie theaters. Most films are
mixed for movie theaters, and might sound too bright when played
back in home theaters without re-equalization. THX timbre
matching is applied to minimize timbre differences between the
front and surround channels, which results in smoother sound
movements between them. These modes are recommended for
home theaters with THX-certified speakers.
non-flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital source with or without
THX Surround EX encoding is detected.
•
•
The THX SurEX listening mode is available when both the side
and rear speakers are present and THX Surround EX decoding
is engaged. THX Surround EX decoding is engaged when the
SURROUND EX parameter is set to ON or AUTO and a flagged
5.1-channel Dolby Digital source with THX Surround EX
encoding is detected.
The THX listening mode is available when both Ultra2 and THX
Surround EX decoding are deactivated.
The listening mode name differs depending on the encoding
present in the input source, the SURROUND EX parameter setting,
and the speaker setup.
Note:
Some EX encoded sources are not flagged, and require manually
setting the SURROUND EX parameter to ON for EX decoding.
The table at the bottom of the page shows the conditions for the
behavior of the THX Ultra2 and THX Surround EX modes when
activated:
When THX Ultra2 decoding is active:
•
Adaptive de-correlation is applied to increase the perceived
width of the listening space. De-correlation of the mono
surround channel increases the perceived width of the
surround field in home theaters.
•
The THX ULTRA2 listening mode is available when both the
side and rear speakers are present and THX Ultra2 decoding is
engaged. THX Ultra2 decoding is engaged when the
SURROUND EX parameter is set to OFF or AUTO and a
Input Source
5.1-Channel THX Surround EX
Dolby Digital (Flagged)
5.1-Channel THX Surround EX
Dolby Digital (Non-Flagged)
5.1-Channel Dolby Digital
Parameter Setting
THX ULTRA2
THX SurEX
THX SurEX
THX SurEX
THX ULTRA2
THX ULTRA2
THX SurEX
SURROUND EX: AUTO
SURROUND EX: ON
SURROUND EX: OFF
THX ULTRA2
THX ULTRA2
5-18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
ASA processing is applied to signals sent to the rear speakers.
Mode Adjust
•
MUSIC
MODE ADJUST
Refer to the ASA parameter description on page 3-32 for more
information.
MUSIC
This listening mode is designed for playback of 5.1-channel Dolby
Digital music sources, and cannot be activated unless side and rear
speakers are present. ASA processing is applied to signals sent to the
rear speakers. Refer to the ASA parameter description on page 3-32
for more information. For best results, place the rear speakers close
together in your home theater.
When THX Surround EX decoding is active:
Matrix decoding is applied to derive three surround channels from
5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources.
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
Note:
RE-EQUALIZER
SURROUND EX
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
ON
ON, OFF
The THX MUSIC listening mode can only be activated with the front panel
or remote control Mode buttons.
AUTO
AUTO, ON, OFF
AUTO, ON, OFF
-10.0 to +0.0dB
OFF
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
+0.0dB
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
OFF
AUTO, ON, OFF
-10.0 to +0.0dB
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
+0.0dB
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
descriptions.
5-19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
5.1 PLIIx MOV
5.1 PLIIx MUS
5.1 PLIIx MOV
5.1 PLIIx MUS
MODE ADJUST
MODE ADJUST
The 5.1 PLIIx MUS (MUSIC) listening mode is designed to playback 7.1
discrete channels decoded from 5.1-channel Dolby Digital music
sources. (The 5.1 PLIIx MUSIC listening mode can also be used with
other types of Dolby Digital sources with mixed results.) The seven
main channels are full frequency. The .1 channel, often referred to as
LFE information, has a limited frequency range of up to 120Hz. The 5.1
PLIIx MUSIC listening mode is only available when the front, side and
rear speakers are present.
The 5.1 PLIIx MOV (MOVIE) listening mode is designed to playback
7.1 discrete channels decoded from 5.1-channel Dolby Digital film
sources. (The 5.1 PLIIx MOVIE listening mode can also be used with
other types of Dolby Digital sources with mixed results.) The seven
main channels are full frequency. The .1 channel, often referred to as
LFE information, has a limited frequency range of up to 120Hz. The 5.1
PLIIx MOVIE listening mode is only available when the front, side and
rear speakers are present.
Note the following:
Note the following:
•
The 5.1 PLIIx MUS listening mode cannot be assigned as the
preferred listening mode for 2-channel sources. However, when
the 2-CH parameter is set to USE LAST, the MC-12 automati-
cally activates the 5.1 PLIIx MUS listening mode if the 5.1
PLIIx MUS listening mode was activated the last time a
2-channel source was present.
•
The 5.1 PLIIx MOV listening mode cannot be assigned as the
preferred listening mode for 2-channel sources. However, when
the 2-CH parameter is set to USE LAST, the MC-12 automati-
cally activates the 5.1 PLIIx MOV listening mode if the 5.1
PLIIx MOV listening mode was activated the last time a
2-channel source was present.
•
The 5.1 PLIIx MUS mode does not appear in the list of available
listening modes if either the side or rear speakers are missing
from the configuration.
•
The 5.1 PLIIx MOV mode does not appear in the list of available
listening modes if either the side or rear speakers are missing
from the configuration.
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
EX DECODING
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
AUTO
OFF
+0.0dB
AUTO, ON, OFF
AUTO, ON, OFF
-10.0 to +0.0dB
EX DECODING
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
AUTO
OFF
+0.0dB
AUTO, ON, OFF
AUTO, ON, OFF
-10.0 to +0.0dB
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
Refer to page 5-35
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
5-20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
5.1-channel Dolby Digital source recorded with Dolby Digital
Surround EX encoding is detected.
DIGITAL &
DIGITAL EX
OR
MODE ADJUST
DIGITAL
DIGITAL EX
•
Dolby Digital Surround EX decoding is not activated when the
EX DECODING parameter is set to OFF or AUTO and a
non-flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital source recorded with or
without Dolby Digital Surround EX encoding is detected.
These listening modes are designed to decode and playback 5.1
discrete channels from 5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources. The five
main channels are full frequency. The .1 channel, often referred to
as LFE information, has a limited frequency range of 120Hz.
Note:
The mode name differs depending on the encoding present in the
input source, the EX DECODING parameter setting, and the
speaker setup.
The MC-12 cannot detect Dolby Digital Surround EX encoding in
non-flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital input sources because they do
not include information in the input signal that identifies Dolby Digital
Surround EX encoding.
The Dolby DIGITAL EX listening mode is recommended for Dolby
Digital sources recorded with Dolby Digital Surround EX encoding.
This listening mode can also be used with other types of
5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources with mixed results. The table at
the bottom of the page shows the conditions for the behavior of
the Dolby Digital EX mode when activated.
The Dolby DIGITAL listening mode is available when both the side
and rear speakers are present and Dolby Digital Surround EX
decoding is not activated.
The Dolby DIGITAL EX listening mode is available when both the
side and rear speakers are present and Dolby Digital Surround EX
decoding is activated. Matrix decoding is then applied to derive a
surround back channel from the other surround channels.
•
Dolby Digital Surround EX decoding is activated when the EX
DECODING parameter is set to ON or AUTO and a flagged
Input Source
5.1-Channel Surround EX
(Flagged)
5.1-Channel Surround EX
(Non-Flagged)
5.1-Channel Dolby Digital
Parameter Setting
DOLBY DIGITAL
DOLBY DIGITAL EX
DOLBY DIGITAL
DOLBY DIGITAL EX
DOLBY DIGITAL EX
DOLBY DIGITAL
DOLBY DIGITAL
DOLBY DIGITAL EX
DOLBY DIGITAL
EX DECODING: AUTO
EX DECODING: ON
EX DECODING: OFF
5-21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
5.1 2-CHANNEL
DIGITAL &
DIGITAL EX (continued)
OR
MODE ADJUST
5.1 2-CHANNEL
MODE ADJUST
DIGITAL
DIGITAL EX
This mode, recommended for recording purposes, is designed for
converting 5.1-channel Dolby Digital-encoded input sources into
2-channel Logic 7-encoded output signals.
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
EX DECODING
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
AUTO
AUTO, ON, OFF
AUTO, ON, OFF
-10.0 to +0.0dB
OFF
The downmixed 5.1-channel Dolby Digital input signals are sent to
the front speakers and subwoofer.
+0.0dB
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
descriptions.
CENTER MIX
SURROUND MIX
CNTR DLY SAMPLES
MASTER LEVEL
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
+0dB
-25 to +5dB
+0dB
-5 to +5dB
+0
-127 to +127
-5 to +5dB
+0dB
OFF
AUTO, ON, OFF
-20.0 to +0.0dB
OFF, -30 to +12dB
+0.0dB
SUB LEVEL
+0dB
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
5-22
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
5.1 MONO LOGIC
5.1 MONO SURR
MODE ADJUST
5.1 MONO LOGIC
MODE ADJUST
5.1 MONO SURR
This listening mode, designed for playback of Dolby
Digital-encoded mono sources, uses proprietary Lexicon reverb
algorithms to realistically expand mono sources to use all channels.
This dramatically increases the perceived width and sense of envel-
opment of the listening space.
This listening mode, designed for playback of Dolby
Digital-encoded mono sources, sends mono signals to all channels.
Parameter
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
Refer to page 5-35
Note that:
•
When a 1.0 Dolby Digital source is present, the MC-12 auto-
matically activates the 5.1 MONO LOGIC listening mode.
descriptions.
•
When the Shift command bank is activated, pressing the TVL
button activates the 5.1 MONO LOGIC listening mode for
5.1-channel sources.
5.1 MONO
MODE ADJUST
5.1 MONO
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
EFFECT LVL
-9dB
-12 to +6dB
This listening mode, designed for playback of Dolby
Digital-encoded mono sources, sends mono signals to the center
channel.
ACADEMY FILTER
SURR ROLLOFF
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
ON
ON, OFF
3.1kHz
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF
Refer to page 5-35
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
SUB LEVEL
CUSTOM
+0dB
OFF, -30 to +12dB
descriptions.
descriptions.
5-23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
DECODING
The DTS and DTS-ES listening modes are designed for, at a
minimum, playback of 5.1-channel DTS, 5.1-channel matrix
encoded DTS-ES, and 6.1-channel discrete-encoded DTS-ES
sources.
•
•
DTS-ES decoding is activated when both the side and rear
speakers are present and the ES DECODING parameter is set to
ON or AUTO and a 5.1-channel matrix-encoded or a
6.1-channel discrete-encoded DTS-ES source is detected.
DTS-ES decoding is deactivated when the ES DECODING
parameter is set to OFF or when the ES DECODING parameter
is set to AUTO and a 5.1-channel DTS source is detected.
DTS and DTS-ES listening mode names differ depending on the
encoding present in the input source, the DECODING parameter
setting, and the speaker setup.
DTS-ES listening modes are available when DTS-ES decoding is
activated. The table at the bottom of the page shows the conditions
for the behavior of DTS-ES decoding when it is activated.
Note:
The table below is not applicable to the DTS-ES THX, DTS THX ULTRA2,
and DTS THX MUSIC listening modes.
Input Source
5.1-Channel
Matrix-Encoded DTS-ES
6.1-Channel
Discrete-Encoded DTS-ES
5.1-Channel DTS
Parameter Setting
DTS
DTS-ES
DTS
DTS-ES
DTS-ES
DTS
DTS-ES
DTS-ES
DTS
ES DECODING: AUTO
ES DECODING: ON
ES DECODING: OFF
5-24
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
FILM &
FILM
MUSIC &
MUSIC
OR
OR
MODE ADJUST
FILM
FILM
MODE ADJUST
MUSIC
MUSIC
These proprietary Lexicon listening modes use an advanced matrix to
decode seven channels from 5.1 and 6.1-channel film sources with
enhanced front steering. When both side and rear speakers are
present, the DTS-ES L7 FILM listening mode also increases the
perceived length and sense of envelopment of the listening space.
These proprietary Lexicon listening modes, similar to the DTS-ES L7
FILM listening mode, use an advanced matrix to decode seven
channels from 5.1- and 6.1-channel music sources with enhanced
front steering to provide remarkable sound improvement compared
to other decoders. They are designed for enhanced playback of
5.1-channel DTS, 5.1-channel matrix-encoded DTS-ES, or 6.1-channel
discrete encoded DTS-ES music sources.
The listening modes are designed for enhanced playback of
5.1-channel DTS, 5.1-channel matrix-encoded DTS-ES, or 6.1-channel
discrete encoded DTS-ES film sources. The listening mode name differs
depending on the encoding present in the input source, the ES
DECODING parameter setting, and the speaker setup.
The listening mode name differs depending on the encoding
present in the input source, the ES DECODING parameter setting,
and the speaker setup.
Option/Parameter Default Setting Possible Settings
Option/Parameter Default Setting Possible Settings
VOCAL ENHANCE
FRONT STEERING
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
LFE MIX
+0.0dB
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM
ON, OFF
VOCAL ENHANCE
FRONT STEERING
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
LFE MIX
+0.0dB
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM
ON, OFF
FILM
MUSIC
ON
OFF
REAR
REAR, NEUTRAL, FRONT
ON, OFF
NEUTRAL
ON
REAR, NEUTRAL, FRONT
ON, OFF
ON
OFF
ON, OFF
OFF
ON, OFF
7kHz
500Hz to 20kHz, OFF
OFF, 1 to 30ms
7kHz
500Hz to 20kHz, OFF
OFF, 1 to 30ms
15ms
15ms
+0.0dB
-10.0 to +0.0dB
AUTO, ON, OFF
+0.0dB
-10.0 to +0.0dB
AUTO, ON, OFF
ES DECODING
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
AUTO
ES DECODING
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
AUTO
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
descriptions.
5-25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
&
UL2Cin
OR
MODE ADJUST
UL2Cin
The DTS THX UL2Cin (ULTRA2 CINEMA) and DTS-ES THX listening
modes allow 7-channel playback of 5.1-channel DTS sources that
lack DTS-ES encoding. They are designed for playback of 5.1-channel
DTS, 5.1-channel matrix encoded DTS-ES, or 6.1-channel DTS-ES
discrete-encoded film sources. DTS THX UL2Cin and DTS-ES THX
are recommended for home theaters with THX-certified speakers.
These modes apply:
When THX UL2Cin decoding is activated:
•
Adaptive de-correlation is applied to increase the perceived
width of the listening space. De-correlation of the mono
surround channel increases the perceived width of the
surround field in home theaters.
•
ASA processing is applied to signals sent to the rear speakers.
Refer to the ASA parameter description on page 3-32 for more
information.
•
THX re-equalization to simulate high-frequency rolloffs that
occur in movie theaters. Most films are mixed for movie
theaters, and might sound too bright when played back in
home theaters without re-equalization.
The DTS-ES THX listening mode
The DTS-ES THX listening mode is available when both the side and
rear speakers are present and DTS-ES decoding is active.
•
THX timbre matching to minimize timbre differences between
the front and surround channels, which results in smoother
sound movements between them.
DTS-ES decoding is activated when the ES DECODING parameter is
set to AUTO (the default) or ON and a 5.1-channel matrix-encoded
or 6.1-channel discrete-encoded DTS-ES source is detected.
The listening mode name differs depending on the encoding present
in the input source, the ES DECODING parameter setting, and the
speaker setup.
The table at the bottom of the page shows the conditions for the
behavior of the DTS THX UL2Cin and DTS-ES THX modes when
activated:.
The DTS THX UL2Cin listening mode
The DTS THX UL2Cin listening mode is available when when both side
and rear speakers are present and THX Ultra2 decoding is activated.
Option/Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
To activate DTS THX UL2Cin decoding:
RE-EQUALIZER
LFE MIX
ON
ON, OFF
1. Press MODE ADJUST ꢀ
ꢀ
DECODING.
+0.0dB
-10.0 to +0.0dB
AUTO, ON, OFF
2. Use the ꢁor ꢂarrow to select either AUTO (the default) or OFF.
ES DECODING
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
AUTO
When the the ES DECODING parameter is set to OFF the DTS-ES
THX ULTRA2 listening mode is always active. When the parameter
is set to AUTO the DTS-ES THX ULTRA2 listening mode activates
when a 5.1-channel DTS source is detected.
Refer to page 5-35
Refer to page 5-35
detaileddescriptions.
5-26
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
Input Source
5.1-Channel
Matrix-Encoded DTS-ES
6.1-Channel
Discrete-Encoded DTS-ES
5.1-Channel DTS
Parameter Setting
DTS THX UL2Cin
DTS-ES THX
DTS-ES THX
DTS-ES THX
DTS-ES THX
ES DECODING: AUTO
ES DECODING: ON
ES DECODING: OFF
DTS-ES THX
DTS THX UL2Cin
DTS THX UL2Cin
DTS THX UL2Cin
MUSIC
&
OR
MODE ADJUST
MUSIC
MODE ADJUST
This mode decodes 5.1 matrix or 6.1 discrete channels from DTS-ES
sources. It is designed for playback of 5.1-channel DTS, 5.1-channel
matrix encoded DTS-ES, and 6.1-channel discrete-encoded DTS-ES
sources.
The DTS THX MUSIC listening mode is designed for playback of
5.1-channel DTS music sources when the side and rear speakers are
present. ASA processing is applied to signals sent to the rear
more information. This mode is recommended for home theaters
with THX-certified speaker setups.
The six decoded main channels are full frequency. The .1 channel,
often referred to as LFE information, has a limited frequency range
of 120Hz.
Option/Parameter Default Setting
Possible Settings
The listening mode name differs depending on the encoding
present in the input source, the DECODING parameter setting, and
LFE MIX
+0.0dB
-10.0 to +0.0dB
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
Option/Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
descriptions.
LFE MIX
+0.0dB
-10.0 to +0.0dB
AUTO, ON, OFF
ES DECODING
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
AUTO
Refer to page 5-35
Refer to page 5-35
Note:
The DTS THX MUSIC listening mode can only be activated with the front
panel or remote control Mode buttons.
descriptions.
5-27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
5.1a
FILM
2-CHAN &
2-CHAN
MODE ADJUST
5.1
FILM
MODE ADJUST
2-CHAN OR
2-CHAN
The 5.1a LOGIC 7 FILM listening mode is a proprietary Lexicon
listening mode that uses Logic 7 decoding to derive seven channels
from of 5.1-channel analog film sources with enhanced front
steering.
These modes, recommended for recording purposes, send
downmixed 5.1-channel or 6.1-channel DTS-ES input signals to the
front speakers and subwoofer as 2-channel Logic 7-encoded output
signals.
This listening mode allows 5.1-channel analog sources to use bass
management, speaker crossovers, speaker distance calibration, and
audio controls (tone controls).
Option/Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
CENTER MIX
+0dB
+0dB
-25 to +5dB
SURROUND MIX
-5 to +5dB
Option/Parameter Default Setting Possible Settings
CNTR DLY SAMPLES +0
-127 to +127
-5 to +5dB
VOCAL ENHANCE
FRONT STEERING
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
LFE MIX
+0.0dB
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM
ON, OFF
MASTER LEVEL
LFE MIX
+0dB
FILM
+0.0dB
-20.0 to +0.0dB
AUTO, ON, OFF
OFF, -30 to +12dB
OFF
ES DECODING
SUB LEVEL
AUTO
REAR
REAR, NEUTRAL, FRONT
ON, OFF
+0dB
ON
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
OFF
ON, OFF
descriptions.
7kHz
500Hz to 20kHz, OFF
OFF, 1 to 30ms
15ms
+0.0dB
-10.0 to +0.0dB
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
5-28
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
5.1a MUSIC
5.1a
UL2Cin, 5.1a
SurEX, & 5.1a
MODE ADJUST
5.1a
MUSIC
OR
MODE ADJUST
OR
5.1a
UL2Cin
5.1a
SurEX
5.1a
The 5.1a LOGIC 7 MUSIC listening mode is similiar to the 5.1a
LOGIC 7 FILM listening mode, but specifically tailored for music
sources. This mode is designed and recommended for playback of
5.1-channel analog music sources.
The 5.1a THX UL2Cin, 5.1a THX SurEX, and 5.1a THX listening
modes are designed to convert 5.1-channel analog film sources that
lack THX Surround EX encoding into seven channel audio. The
modes also allow 5.1-channel analog sources to use bass
management, speaker crossovers, speaker distance calibration, and
audio controls (tone controls). The 5.1a THX UL2Cin, 5.1a THX
SurEX, and 5.1a THX listening modes are recommended for home
theaters with THX-certified speakers. These modes apply:
Option/Parameter Default Setting Possible Settings
VOCAL ENHANCE
FRONT STEERING
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
LFE MIX
+0.0dB
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM
ON, OFF
MUSIC
•
THX re-equalization to simulate high-frequency rolloffs that
occur in movie theaters. Most films are mixed for movie
theaters, and might sound too bright when played back in
home theaters without re-equalization.
OFF
NEUTRAL
ON
REAR, NEUTRAL, FRONT
ON, OFF
•
THX timbre matching to minimize timbre differences between
the front and surround channels, which results in smoother
sound movements between them.
OFF
ON, OFF
7kHz
500Hz to 20kHz, OFF
OFF, 1 to 30ms
The listening mode name differs depending on the SURROUND EX
parameter setting, and the speaker setup.
15ms
+0.0dB
-10.0 to +0.0dB
The table at the top of the next page indicates the conditions in
which THX Ultra2 and THX Surround EX decoding are activated.
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
5-29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
5.1a
UL2Cin, 5.1a
SurEX, & 5.1a
(continued)
OR
MODE ADJUST
OR
5.1a
UL2Cin
5.1a
SurEX
5.1a
Input Source
5.1-Channel THX Surround EX
Analog (Flagged)
5.1-Channel THX Surround EX
5.1-Channel Analog
Parameter Setting
Analog (Non-Flagged)
5.1a THX SurEX
5.1a THX SurEX
5.1a THX SurEX
SURROUND EX: ON
SURROUND EX: OFF
5.1a THX ULTRA2
5.1a THX ULTRA2
5.1a THX ULTRA2
The 5.1a THX UL2Cin listening mode
The 5.1a THX UL2Cin listening mode is available when both side
and rear speakers are present and THX Ultra2 decoding is active. THX
Ultra2 decoding is activated when the SURROUND EX parameter is
set to OFF. When THX Ultra2 decoding is activated:
When THX Surround EX decoding is activated Matrix decoding is
applied to derive three surround channels from 5.1-channel analog
sources.
The 5.1a THX listening mode
•
Adaptive de-correlation is applied to increase the perceived
width of the listening space. De-correlation of the mono
surround channel increases the perceived width of the
surround field in home theaters.
The 5.1a THX listening mode is available when neither THX Ultra2
nor THX Surround EX decoding is active.
•
ASA processing is applied to signals sent to the rear speakers.
Refer to the ASA parameter description on page 3-32 for more
information.
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
RE-EQUALIZER
SURROUND EX
LFE MIX
ON
ON, OFF
OFF
ON, OFF
The 5.1a THX SurEX listening mode
+0.0dB
-10.0 to +0.0dB
The 5.1a THX SurEX listening mode is available when both side and
rear speakers are present and THX surround EX decoding is active.
THX Surround EX decoding is activated when the SURROUND EX
parameter is set to ON.
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
5-30
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
5.1a STANDARD
5.1a
MUSIC
MODE ADJUST
5.1a STANDARD
MODE ADJUST
5.1a
MUSIC
This mode allows 5.1-channel analog sources to use bass
management, speaker crossovers, speaker distance calibration, and
audio controls (tone controls). When these features are not used,
the 5.1a STANDARD listening mode is similar to the 5.1a BYPASS
listening mode. The 5.1a STANDARD mode sends identical signals
(with appropriate time delays) to the Main Zone audio output
connectors labeled Side L and Rear L, as well as Side R and Rear R.
The 5.1a THX MUSIC listening mode is designed for playback of
5.1-channel analog music sources. It cannot be activated unless side
and rear speakers are present. This mode performs best in home
theaters where the rear speakers are placed close together.
ASA processing is applied to signals sent to the rear speakers. Refer
information.
Parameter
Option/Parameter Default Setting
Possible Settings
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
Refer to page 5-35
LFE MIX
+0.0dB
-10.0 to +0.0dB
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
descriptions.
Note:
The 5.1a THX MUSIC listening mode can only be activated with the front
panel or remote control Mode buttons.
5-31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
5.1a 2-CHANNEL
5.1a BYPASS
MODE ADJUST
5.1a 2-CHANNEL
MODE ADJUST
5.1a BYPASS
This mode downmixes 5.1-channel analog input signals into
2-channel Logic 7-encoded output signals. It sends these signals to
the front speakers and the subwoofer. It is recommended for
recording purposes, particularly for recording from a DVD-A or
multi-channel SACD player to a CD-R or another 2-channel
recording format.
•
•
Designed for playback of 5.1-channel analog sources, such as
DVD-A or SACD players.
Sends the 5.1-channel analog audio input connector directly to
the Main Zone volume control and audio output connectors as
internal processing.
•
When both side and rear speakers are present, surround
channel signals are sent in parallel to the side and rear speakers.
To configure a 5-channel speaker setup, set the OUTPUT
LEVELS menu SIDE L/R or REAR L/R parameter to OFF to deacti-
vate the associated surround speakers.
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
CENTER MIX
+0dB
+0dB
-25 to +5dB
SURROUND MIX
-5 to +5dB
•
•
The 5.1a BYPASS listening mode is automatically activated
whenever the 5.1-channel analog audio input connector is
assigned to the selected input. The 5.1a BYPASS listening mode
is only available for 5.1-channel analog sources.
CNTR DLY SAMPLES +0
-127 to +127
-5 to +5dB
MASTER LEVEL
LFE MIX
+0dB
+0.0dB
-20.0 to +0.0dB
OFF, -30 to +12dB
Pressing the remote control SHIFT then 2CH buttons toggles
the MAIN ADV menu ANALOG BYPASS parameter between ON
and OFF.
SUB L/R LVL
CUSTOM
+0dB
Refer to page 5-35
descriptions.
Option/Parameter
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
descriptions.
Note:
Speaker crossover settings, speaker distances, and audio controls (tone)
are not available when the 5.1a BYPASS listening mode is activated.
5-32
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
2CH BYPASS
LIVE! SMALL, LIVE! MED & LIVE! LARGE
OR
OR
MODE ADJUST
2CH BYPASS
MODE ADJUST
LIVE! SMALL
LIVE! MED
LIVE! LARGE
This listening mode sends 2-channel analog audio input signals to
the Main Zone audio output connectors labeled Front L/R with no
internal processing.
LIVE! (Lexicon Intelligent Variable Environment) is a proprietary
mode designed to transform the way your listening room sounds.
It provides a realistic illusion of a larger, more reverberant listening
space. LIVE! SMALL simulates the reverberations of a room that is
small, but larger than an average living room. LIVE! LARGE
simulates the reverberations of a large hall. LIVE! requires two
permanently mounted microphones. (See “LIVE! Calibration” on
page 3-71 for placement and calibration instructions.) LIVE! cannot
be used with prerecorded sources such as CD or DVD.
The 2CH BYPASS listening mode is automatically activated
whenever a 2-channel analog source is present and the MAIN ADV
menu ANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to ON. The 2CH BYPASS
listening mode is not available when a digital source is present and
the MAIN ADV menu INPUT SELECT parameter is set to AUTO.
Pressing the remote control SHIFT then 2CH buttons toggles the
MAIN ADV menu ANALOG BYPASS parameter between ON and
OFF.
When LIVE! is activated, the BASS, TREBLE, and TILT EQ audio
controls are set to +0.0dB and LOUDNESS is set to OFF, until LIVE! is
deactivated.
Note:
LIVE! SMALL parameter settings:
Speaker crossover settings, speaker distances, and audio controls (tone)
are not available when the 2CH BYPASS listening mode is activated.
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
MID RT
BASS RT
597ms
597ms
3.1kHz
3.1kHz
10ms
115ms to 15.4s
23ms to 30.8ms
500Hz to 20kHz
500Hz to 20kHz
10ms to 100ms
ROLLOFF
TREB CUT RT
PRE-DELAY
ADVANCED
CUSTOM
5-33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
LIVE! MED ADVANCED parameter settings:
LIVE! SMALL, LIVE! MED & LIVE! LARGE (continued)
OR
OR
MODE ADJUST
LIVE! SMALL
LIVE! MED
LIVE! LARGE
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
SHAPE
SPREAD
SIZE
2
25%
30m
0 to 4
0% to 100%
4m to 60m
LIVE! SMALL ADVANCED parameter settings:
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
REVERB LVL
EARLY RFLX LVL
BASS XOVER
SHAPE
SPREAD
SIZE
+0dB
-13dB
156Hz
0
0%
19m
-80dB to +0dB
-80dB to +12dB
30Hz to 19.9kHz, OFF
0 to 4
0% to 100%
4m to 60m
LIVE! LARGE parameter settings:
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
MID RT
4.71s
115ms to 30.8s
23ms to 30.8ms
500Hz to 20kHz
500Hz to 20kHz
10ms to 100ms
BASS RT
4.71s
ROLLOFF
TREB CUT RT
PRE-DELAY
ADVANCED
CUSTOM
3.1kHz
2.4kHz
20ms
LIVE! MED parameter settings:
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
Refer to page 5-35
MID RT
BASS RT
1.84s
2.76s
2.4kHz
3.1kHz
18ms
115ms to 15.4s
23ms to 30.8ms
500Hz to 20kHz
500Hz to 20kHz
10ms to 100ms
ROLLOFF
TREB CUT RT
PRE-DELAY
ADVANCED
CUSTOM
LIVE! LARGE ADVANCED parameter settings:
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
REVERB LVL
EARLY RFLX LVL
BASS XOVER
SHAPE
-6dB
-17dB
156Hz
2
-80dB to +0dB
-80dB to +12dB
30Hz to 19.9kHz, OFF
0 to 4
Refer to page 5-35
SPREAD
SIZE
28%
38m
0% to 100%
4m to 60m
LIVE! MED ADVANCED parameter settings:
Parameter
Default Setting Possible Settings
descriptions.
REVERB LVL
-4dB
-80dB to +0dB
EARLY RFLX LVL
BASS XOVER
-14dB
156Hz
-80dB to +12dB
30Hz to 19.9kHz, OFF
5-34
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
OUTPUT LEVELS
MODE ADJUST
Listening Mode
CUSTOM
MODE ADJUST
Listening Mode
Opens the CUSTOM menu shown below, which can be used to
compare custom and factory-default versions of the selected listening
mode and to restore the factory-default version of the selected listening
mode.
Opens the OUTPUT LEVELS menu, which is
used to adjust output levels for the Main
Zone audio output connectors labeled
Center, Subwoofer L/R, LFE, Side L/R, and
Rear L/R.
OUTPUT LEVELS
CENTER
SIDE L/R
REAR L/R
SUB L/R
LFE
+0dB
+0dB
+0dB
+0dB
+0dB
CUSTOM VS PRESET
MODE ADJUST
Listening Mode
CUSTOM
CUSTOM VS PRESET
The OUTPUT LEVELS option does not appear on listening mode
menus when the selected listening mode does not accommodate
multi-channel output signals. Instead, an output-specific parameter
appears. For example, the MONO listening mode menu includes a
SUB L/R LVL parameter.
Allows comparison listening between the custom and factory-default
versions of the selected listening mode. When PRESET is selected, the
listening mode is heard in its factory-default condition, as if all listening
mode menu parameters were set to their factory-default settings.
When CUSTOM is selected, the listening mode is heard it its custom
condition, including all current listening mode menu parameter settings.
The PRESET and CUSTOM versions of the selected listening mode will
sound identical when all listening mode menu parameters are set to
their factory-default settings.
Parameter
Default Setting
Possible Settings
CENTER
SIDE L/R
REAR L/R
SUB
+0dB
+0dB
+0dB
+0dB
+0dB
OFF, -30 to +12dB
OFF, -30 to +12dB
OFF, -30 to +12dB
OFF, -30 to +12dB
OFF, -30 to +12dB
Note:
The CUSTOM VS PRESET option does not affect current listening mode
menu parameter settings.
LFE
descriptions.
PRESET
CUSTOM
CUSTOM
CUSTOM VS PRESET
RESET MODE
To toggle between the custom and factory-default versions of
the selected listening mode:
1. Follow the CUSTOM VS PRESET menu path to open the CUS-
TOM VS PRESET drop-down menu.
5-35
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
2. When the CUSTOM VS PRESET option drop-down menu is
open, press the remote control ꢁ and ꢂ arrow buttons to
toggle between the PRESET (factory-default) and CUSTOM
versions of the selected listening mode.
3. When finished, press the ꢃ arrow button to close the
CUSTOM VS PRESET drop down menu.
RESET MODE
MODE ADJUST
Listening Mode
CUSTOM
RESET MODE
Restores the factory-default version of the selected listening mode,
restoring all listening mode menu parameters to their factory default
settings.
To restore the factory-default version of the selected listening mode:
1. Follow the RESET MODE menu path to select the RESET MODE
option. The PRESS RIGHT V TO RESTORE MODE message
appears on the on-screen display.
PRESS RIGHT V
TO RESTORE MODE
CUSTOM
CUSTOM VS PRESET
RESET MODE
2. Press the ꢀ arrow button to restore the factory-default version of
the selected listening mode. Press the ꢃ arrow button to close the
message without restoring the factory-default.
Note:
When the CUSTOM menu RESET MODE option is selected to restore the
factory-default version of the selected listening mode, the corresponding
TRIGGER SETUP menu listening mode parameter is automatically set to
OFF.
5-36
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
LISTENING MODE MENU OPTION & PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS
dummy head microphones. Select the MONO setting for sources
recorded with mono bass. Select the STEREO setting for sources
recorded with stereo bass. Available in PANORAMA mode.
5 SPKR ENHANCE
ON, OFF
Simulates 7-channel playback in 5-channel speaker configurations.
When set to ON, the MC-12 provides an increased sense of
spaciousness and envelopment through the surround speakers. This
enhancement is most noticeable when the surround speakers are
positioned to the side of the primary listening position, or when the
primary listening position is located against the rear wall. The effec-
tiveness of this parameter varies within the listening space. For best
results, it is recommended that you position the surround speakers
to the left and right sides of the primary listening position. Available
in all Logic 7 modes.
BASS ENHANCE
ON, OFF
Enhances stereo bass, which results in low-frequency reproduction
that is less localizable and more realistic in the listening space. The
effectiveness of the BASS ENHANCE parameter varies depending on
room acoustics and the ability of the surround speakers to
reproduce low frequencies. It is recommended that you use front,
side or rear speakers that are capable of reproducing frequencies of
40Hz or lower. Available in all Logic 7 modes.
ACADEMY FILTER
ON, OFF
BASS RT
5ms to 48.6s
When set to ON, restores the proper tonal balance of older mono
film sources that have much narrower frequency responses than
more recent mono film sources. Available in MONO LOGIC and 5.1
MONO LOGIC modes.
Works with the MID RT and SIZE parameters to adjust the amount
of time required for low-frequency information to decay below 60dB
in level. In smaller listening spaces, the BASS RT parameter setting
should match the MID RT parameter setting for more natural effects.
Available in CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes
AUTO AZIMUTH
ON, OFF
Maximizes matrix steering accuracy. When set to ON, the MC-12
continually monitors the 2-channel input signal and automatically
adjusts the relative level and time offset of the input channels to ensure
that signals are sent to the appropriate channels with maximum
separation. When set to OFF, the accuracy of the selected listening
mode varies among sources. It is recommended that you set this
parameter to ON for film and broadcast sources and to OFF for music
sources. Available in L7 FILM and L7 TV modes.
CAUTION!
Setting the BASS RT, MID RT and SIZE parameters to a high
value may produce undesirable or damaging audio.
BASS XOVER
30Hz to 19.9kHz, OFF
Sets the frequency at which BASS RT applies. Available in all LIVE! modes.
CALIBRATION
BASS CONTENT
BINAURAL, MONO, STEREO
Opens the PANORAMA listening mode CALIBRATION menu, which is
used to calibrate the PANORAMA listening mode. Refer to
“PANORAMA” on page 5-12 for more information. Available in
PANORAMA mode.
Adjusts the bass content of binaural, mono and stereo recordings.
When set to BINAURL, the MC-12 activates low-frequency compen-
sation. Select this setting for true binaural sources recorded with
5-37
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
LISTENING MODE MENU OPTION & PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS (continued)
Dolby Digital input sources that are listened to at lower volume levels,
especially for nighttime viewing to avoid disturbing others. Available in
all Dolby Digital modes.
CENTER
OFF, -30 to +12dB
Controls the output level of the audio output connector labeled Center.
Available in all except 2 CH modes (2-CHANNEL, 2 CH BYPASS,
DTS(-ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1 2-CHANNEL, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL), MONO, 5.1
MONO, and LIVE! modes.
CTR WIDTH
MIN, 1 to 6, MAX
Adjusts the center image. When set to MIN, the center image is heard
from just the center speaker. When set to MAX, the center image is
heard as a “phantom” center image from the front left and right
speakers. When set on the 1 to 6 scale, the center image is heard in
various combinations of the front and center speakers. Available in
Dolby PLII MUSIC and Dolby PLIIx MUSIC modes.
CENTER DEPTH
0 to 18
Adjusts the amount of processing applied to the center channel,
changing the perceived distance of the center speaker. Higher
settings increase and lower settings decrease the perceived distance
of the center speaker from the listening position. Available in
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, and CATHEDRAL modes.
CUSTOM
Opens the CUSTOM menu, which is used to compare custom and
factory-default versions of the selected listening mode and to restore
the factory default version of the selected listening mode. Available in
all modes.
CENTER MIX
-25 to +5dB
Indicates the relative center channel level for downmixing. Set this
parameter to +0dB for film sources and -5dB for music sources.
Available in 5.1 2-CHANNEL, DTS(-ES) 2-CHAN, and 5.1a 2-CHANNEL
modes.
CUSTOM VS PRESET
Allows comparison listening to the custom and factory-default versions
of the selected listening mode. Refer to page 5-33 for information.
Available in all modes.
CNTR DLY SAMPLES
-127 to +127
Controls the relative time offset of the center channel. Set this
parameter to +0 unless the center channel is not properly timed
and the value of the error is known. Available in 5.1 2-CHANNEL,
DTS(-ES) 2-CHAN, and 5.1a 2-CHANNEL modes.
DIMENSION
FRONT, NEUTRAL, REAR
Controls the relative balance of the sound field, which can be useful
with certain recordings to achieve a more suitable balance among
all speakers. When set to FRONT, the sound field is balanced toward
the front of the listening space. When set to NEUTRAL, the sound
field is balanced at the center of the listening space. When set to
REAR, the sound field is balanced toward the rear of the listening
space. Available in Dolby PLII MUSIC and Dolby PLIIx MUSIC modes.
COMPRESSION
AUTO, ON, OFF
Reduces wide volume level changes and increases dialog intelligibility
at lower listening levels for Dolby Digital input sources. When ON, full
compression is applied regardless of volume level. When OFF,
compression is not applied. Set this parameter to AUTO or ON for
5-38
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
source is present or when the ES DECODING parameter is set
to AUTO and a 5.1-channel matrix-encoded or 6.1-channel
discrete-encoded DTS-ES source is present.
EARLY RFLX LVL
-80dB to +12dB, OFF
Controls the amount of additional early reflections. Available in all
LIVE! modes.
This parameter is available in all DTS modes.
EFFECT LVL
-12 to +6dB
EX DECODING
AUTO, ON, OFF
Adjusts the amount of effect applied to the listening mode. Available
in NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, PANORAMA,
MONO LOGIC, and 5.1 MONO LOGIC modes.
Controls Dolby Digital Surround EX decoding, which extracts a rear
channel from 5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources recorded with or
without Dolby Digital Surround EX. When ON, Dolby Digital
Surround EX decoding is engaged for all 5.1-channel Dolby Digital
sources. When OFF, Dolby Digital Surround EX decoding is disen-
gaged for all 5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources.
ES DECODING
AUTO, ON, OFF
Controls DTS-ES decoding, which extracts a rear channel from
5.1-channel DTS, 5.1-channel matrix-encoded DTS-ES, and
6.1-channel discrete-encoded DTS-ES sources. When ON is selected,
DTS-ES decoding is activated for all DTS-ES sources. When OFF is
selected, DTS-ES decoding is deactivated for all DTS-ES sources.
When AUTO is selected, Dolby Digital Surround EX decoding is
engaged when a flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital source recorded
with Dolby Digital Surround EX encoding is detected. Dolby Digital
Surround EX decoding is not engaged when a non- flagged
5.1-channel Dolby Digital source recorded with or without Dolby
Digital Surround EX encoding is detected.
When AUTO is selected, DTS-ES decoding is activated when a
5.1-channel matrix-encoded or a 6.1-channel discrete-encoded
DTS-ES source is detected. DTS-ES decoding is deactivated when a
5.1-channel DTS source is detected.
Note:
The MC-12 cannot automatically detect Dolby Digital Surround EX
encoding in non-flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources. A non-flagged
input source does not identify Dolby Digital Surround EX encoding in the
input signal.
DTS-ES listening modes are available when DTS-ES decoding is
engaged. DTS listening modes are available when DTS-ES decoding is
not engaged. Refer to the DTS-ES Decoding section that begins on
page 5-22 for more information.
Note the following:
The Dolby DIGITAL EX listening mode is available when Dolby
Digital Surround EX decoding is engaged. The Dolby DIGITAL
listening mode is available when Dolby Digital Surround EX
decoding is not engaged. Refer to the Dolby DIGITAL EX & Dolby
DIGITAL listening mode descriptions that begin on page 5-19 for
more information.
•
•
DTS-ES decoding cannot be engaged unless both side and rear
speakers are present.
When the Shift command bank is activated, pressing the
remote control DTS button while a DTS-ES source is present
adjusts the ES DECODING parameter, cycling through the
AUTO, ON, and OFF settings.
•
The DTS-ES STATUS menu includes an SB level meter when the
ES DECODING parameter is set to ON and a 5.1-channel DTS
5-39
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
LISTENING MODE MENU OPTION & PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS (continued)
Note the following:
LFE
OFF, -30.0 to +012dB
Controls the output level of the Main Zone audio output connector
labeled LFE. The OUTPUT LEVELS menu does not include the LFE
parameter unless an LFE subwoofer is present. Available in All Dolby
Digital, DTS, and 5.1a modes.
•
Dolby Digital Surround EX decoding cannot be engaged unless
both side and rear speakers are present.
This parameter is available in 5.1 PLIIx MOV, 5.1 PLIIx MUS, DOLBY
DIGITAL EX, and DOLBY DIGITAL modes.
•
When the Shift command bank is activated, pressing the
remote control DOLBY button while a 5.1-channel Dolby
Digital source is present activates the Dolby DIGITAL EX or
Dolby DIGITAL listening mode. Subsequent presses adjust the
EX DECODING parameter, cycling through the AUTO, ON, and
OFF settings.
LFE MIX
-20.0 or -10.0 to +0.0dB
Controls the output level of LFE information – the 5.1 channel in a
5.1-channel or 6.1-channel input source – that is sent to the audio
output labeled Subwoofer. Low frequencies from up to seven other
channels might be combined with the LFE information to create the
subwoofer output signal, which significantly increases subwoofer
output levels.
FRONT STEERING
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM
Careful adjustment of this parameter allows achievement of proper
tonal balance and reduces the risk of subwoofer overload. When the
speaker setup does not include a subwoofer, LFE information is mixed
into speakers for which the corresponding CUSTOM SETUP menu
parameter is set to FULL or to the lowest crossover points. Available in
all Dolby Digital modes except MONO modes (5.1 MONO LOGIC, 5.1
MONO SURR, 5.1 MONO), all DTS modes, and all 5.1a modes except
5.1a STANDARD and 5.1a BYPASS modes.
Adjusts front steering between the front left, front right, and center
speakers. When set to FILM, maximum front steering is applied to
the center channel. When set to MUSIC, moderate front steering is
applied. When set to MSURR, minimum front steering is applied.
When set to OFF, no front steering is applied. It is recommended
that you set this parameter to FILM for film and broadcast sources
and to MUSIC, MSURR or OFF for music sources. Available in L7 TV,
L7 MUSIC, L7 MUSIC SURR, all 5.1 L7 modes, all DTS L7 modes, and
all 5.1a L7 modes.
LISTENER POS
-127 to +127
INPUT BALANCE
L< to <|> to >R
Compensates for primary listening positions that are not centered
between the front left and right speakers. Each increment within the
-127 to +127 parameter range represents about one-third of an inch.
Refer to the Calibration section that begins on page 5-12 for more
information. Available in PANORAMA CALIBRATION mode.
Controls the balance of the selected stereo analog audio input
connectors, compensating for audio input sources with audible
channel imbalance. Available in PANORAMA mode.
5-40
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
Note:
OUTPUT LEVELS
The LISTENER POS parameter range might extend past the location of the
front left and right speakers.
Opens the OUTPUT LEVELS menu, which is used to adjust output
levels for the Main Zone audio output connectors labeled Center,
Subwoofer L/R, LFE, Side L/R, and Rear L/R. Refer to page 5-32 for
more information. Available in all except 2-CHANNEL, MONO, 5.1
2-CHANNEL, 5.1 MONO, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL,
2CH BYPASS, and LIVE! modes.
LIVENESS
30ms to 20.2s
Depends on the SIZE parameter setting. The LIVENESS parameter
adjusts the amount of effect recirculation. Higher settings mimic
more reflective surfaces and increase decay time. Available in
NIGHTCLUB and CONCERT HALL modes.
PANORAMA
ON, OFF
When set to ON, Dolby PLII MUSIC and Dolby PLIIx MUSIC listening
modes extend the front stereo image to include surround channel
signals, which creates a “wraparound” effect with side wall imaging.
Available in DPLII MUSIC and DPLIIx MUSIC modes.
LOW FREQ WIDTH
-25 to +25dB
Applies low-frequency spatial correction to the input signal. This
correction is applied to uncorrelated input signals below 60Hz.
Available in PANORAMA mode.
Note:
The PANORAMA parameter within the Dolby PLII MUSIC and Dolby PLIIx
MUSIC listening modes should not be confused with the separate
PANORAMA listening mode (page 5-12).
MASTER LEVEL
-5 to +5dB
Adjusts the output level of 2-channel Logic 7-encoded sources.
Available in 5.1 2-CHANNEL, DTS(-ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL
modes.
PRE-DELAY
1 to 100ms, OFF
Adjusts delay time between the direct sound and the onset of rever-
beration. Higher settings make the simulated space sound larger.
Because some pre-delay is inherent in all source material, you
should begin with the parameter set to the lowest setting, then
make adjustments accordingly. Available in NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT
HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes.
MID RT
24ms to 24.3s
Works with the SIZE parameters to adjust the amount of time
required for mid-frequency information to decay below 60dB in
level. The full parameter range might not be available depending
on the SIZE parameter setting. Available in CHURCH, CATHEDRAL,
and all LIVE! modes.
CAUTION!
Setting the BASS RT, MID RT or SIZE parameters to a high
value may produce undesirable or damaging audio.
5-41
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
LISTENING MODE MENU OPTION & PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS (continued)
RE-EQUALIZER
ON, OFF
REVERB LVL
-80 to +0dB, OFF
Simulates high-frequency rolloffs that occur in movie theaters.
When set to ON, the MC-12 applies a high-frequency filter. When
set to OFF, the MC-12 does not apply a high-frequency filter. It is
recommended that you set this parameter to ON for film sources,
as many films are mixed for movie theaters and might sound too
bright when played back in home theaters without re-equalization.
Available in L7 FILM, L7 TV, DPLII + THX, DPLIIx + THX, 5.1 L7 FILM,
5.1 L7 TV, THX ULTRA2, THX SurEX, THX, DTS (ES) L7 FILM, DTS (ES)
THX ULTRA2, DTS (ES) THX, 5.1a L7 FILM, 5.1a THX ULTRA2, 5.1a
THX SurEX, 5.1a THX modes.
Controls the amount of added reverb. Available in all LIVE! modes.
ROLLOFF
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF
Simulates the absorption of high frequencies in a real space. It is
recommended that you begin with a low setting to simulate
high-frequency absorptive spaces. Available in NIGHTCLUB,
CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL and all LIVE! modes.
SHAPE
0 TO 4
Controls the buildup of the energy that most audibly creates the
sound of a real room. SHAPE and SPREAD work together – if either is
set to zero, the other has no effect. Available in all LIVE! modes.
REAR DLY OFFSET
OFF, 1 to 30ms
Increases the perceived depth of the listening space by delaying the
arrival time of rear speaker signals. It is recommended that you
increase the setting when using side and rear speakers that are
located close together or when a greater sense of depth is desired in
the listening space. Available in All Logic 7 modes and PANORAMA
mode.
SIDE L/R
-30 to +12dB, OFF
Controls the level of the Side L/R audio output connectors in the
Main Zone. Available in all except 2-CHANNEL, MONO, 5.1
2-CHANNEL, 5.1 MONO, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL, 2CH
BYPASS, and LIVE! modes.
REAR L/R
-30 to +12dB, OFF
Controls the output level of the audio output connector labeled
Rear L/R. Available in all except 2-CHANNEL, MONO, 5.1
2-CHANNEL, 5.1 MONO, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL, 2CH
BYPASS, and LIVE! modes.
SIZE
4 to 20 or 30m
Adjusts the length of the listening space within a 4m to 20m or
30m range (depending on the listening mode). Increase the size of
the space to increase the reverb effect. Available in NIGHTCLUB,
CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes.
RESET MODE
Restores the factory-default version of the selected listening mode,
restoring all listening mode menu parameters to their
factory-default settings. Available in all modes.
CAUTION!
Setting the BASS RT, MID RT and SIZE parameters to a
high value may produce undesirable or damaging audio.
5-42
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
SOUND STAGE
FRONT, NEUTRAL, REAR
SPEECH DETECT
ON, OFF
Dynamically controls the relative balance of the audio output
connectors. When set to FRONT, Side L/R and Rear L/R output levels
are attenuated by 6dB, shifting the perceived balance of the sound
field to the front of the listening space. When set to NEUTRAL, Side L/R
and Rear L/R output levels are slightly attenuated by 3dB, shifting the
perceived balance of the sound field to the center of the listening
space. When set to REAR, Side L/R and Rear L/R output levels are not
attenuated, preserving the intended balance of the sound field.
Available in all Logic 7 modes.
Distinguishes monaural speech from other input sources. When set to
ON, effects are lowered to minimize interference and unnatural echo
in monaural speech. When stereo input sources are present, the front
left and right channels are independently used as inputs for ambience
synthesis. When strong monaural speech is present in the input source,
the monaural component of the ambience effect is reduced and the
stereo component of the effect is increased. When set to OFF, the
amount of ambience synthesis is dynamically controlled. Available in
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, and CATHEDRAL modes.
SPREAD
0 to 100%
SOURCE
RIGHT, LEFT & RIGHT, LEFT
Controls the timing between the initial reflections that most audibly
create the sound of a real room. SHAPE and SPREAD work together; if
either is set to 0, the other has no effect. Available in all LIVE! modes.
Controls the perceived direction of the PANORAMA listening mode
external calibration source signal. When RIGHT is selected, the
sound is perceived to come from the right of the primary listening
position. When LEFT is selected, the sound is perceived to come
from the left of the primary listening position. When LEFT & RIGHT
is selected, the sound is perceived to come from all around the
primary listening position. Refer to the Calibration section that
begins on page 5-13 for more information about the SOURCE
parameter. Available in PANORAMA CALIBRATION.
SUB L/R & SUB L/R LVL
OFF, -30 to +12dB
Controls the output level of the Main Zone audio output
connectors labeled Subwoofer L/R. The SUB L/R parameter appears
on the listening mode OUTPUT LEVELS menu. The SUB L/R LVL
parameter appears on listening mode menus when the listening
mode does not accommodate multi-channel output signals.
Available in all except LIVE! modes.
Note:
The SOURCE parameter controls the perceived direction of the sound,
although both the front left and right speakers generate the external
calibration source signal.
SURR ROLLOFF
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF
Applies high-frequency attenuation control to the audio output
connectors labeled Side L/R and Rear L/R. This filter is only applied to
output signals generated by the MC-12. Available in all Logic 7 modes.
SPEAKER ANGLE
10 to 90deg
Compensates for a wide or narrow speaker angle relative to the
primary listening position. Select the setting closest to the angle
between the front left and right speakers and the primary listening
position. Refer to the Calibration section that begins on page 5-13
for more information about the SPEAKER ANGLE parameter.
Available in PANORAMA CALIBRATION.
5-43
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
LISTENING MODE MENU OPTION & PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS (continued)
page 5-26, or the 5.1a THX ULTRA2, 5.1a THX SurEX, & 5.1a THX
listening mode descriptions that begin on page 5-29 for more
information.
SURROUND DLY
0 to 15ms
Increases the perceived depth of the listening space by delaying the
arrival time of signals from the side and rear speakers. It is recom-
mended that you increase the setting when a greater sense of
depth is desired in the listening space. Available in DPLII MUSIC and
DPLIIx MUSIC modes.
Note the following:
•
•
•
•
The SURROUND EX parameter AUTO setting is not available for
the 5.1a THX listening modes.
SURROUND EX
AUTO, ON, OFF
Toggling the SURROUND EX parameter setting produces low
level clicks in the front speakers.
Controls the THX Surround EX decoding feature, which can be used to
extract a rear channel from 5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources. When
ON is selected, THX Surround EX decoding is engaged for all
5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources. When OFF is selected, THX
Surround EX decoding is not engaged for all 5.1-channel Dolby Digital
sources. Available in THX ULTRA2, THX SurEX, and THX modes.
THX Surround EX decoding cannot be engaged unless both
side and rear speakers are present.
When the Shift command bank is activated, pressing the
remote control THX button while a 5.1-channel Dolby Digital
source is present activates the 5.1 THX ULTRA2, 5.1 THX SurEX,
or 5.1 THX listening mode. Subsequent presses adjust the
SURROUND EX parameter, cycling through the AUTO, ON,
and OFF settings.
When AUTO is selected, THX Surround EX decoding is engaged
when a flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital source with THX
Surround EX encoding is detected. THX Surround EX decoding is
not engaged when a non-flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital source
with or without THX Surround EX encoding is detected.
•
When the Shift command bank is activated, pressing the
remote control THX button while a 5.1-channel analog source
is present activates the 5.1a THX ULTRA2, 5.1a THX SurEX, or
5.1a THX listening mode. Subsequent presses toggle the
SURROUND EX parameter between the ON and OFF settings.
Note:
The MC-12 cannot automatically detect THX Surround EX encoding in
non-flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources. A non-flagged input
source does not include information in the input signal that identifies THX
Surround EX encoding.
SURROUND MIX
-5 to +5dB
Controls the relative level of surround channel information sent to the
audio output connectors labeled Front L/R. It is recommended that
you set this parameter to +2dB or +3dB for all input sources. Available
in 5.1 2-CHANNEL, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, and 5.1a 2-CHANNEL modes.
THX Surround EX listening modes are available when Dolby Digital
Surround EX decoding is engaged. THX or THX ULTRA2 listening
modes are available when THX Surround EX decoding is not
engaged. Refer to the 5.1 THX ULTRA2, 5.1 THX SurEX, & 5.1 THX
ULTRA2 & DTS-ES THX listening mode descriptions that begin on
5-44
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
and consequently can actually shorten the reverb time. Available in
all LIVE! modes.
TREB CUT RT
500Hz to 20kHz
Sets the frequency above which high frequencies are rolled off in
the reverberated signal, causing reverberated signals to grow
progressively darker. This results in a more natural sound because it
simulates the effect of air absorption in a real hall. Setting this
parameter to a low frequency dampens the audio as it recirculates,
VOCAL ENHANCE
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB
Controls the level of dialog boost in the audio output connector
labeled Center. Increase this setting to improve dialog intelligibility,
particularly at lower volume levels. Available in all Logic 7 modes.
MODE – PARAMETER RELATIONSHIPS
The following table lists each parameter and the modes in which it is used.
The parameter...
Is used in these modes
5 SPKR ENHANCE
ACADEMY FILTER
AUTO AZIMUTH
BASS CONTENT
BASS ENHANCE
BASS RT
All L7 modes
MONO LOGIC and 5.1 MONO LOGIC
L7 FILM and L7 TV
PANORAMA
All L7 modes
CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes
All LIVE! modes
BASS XOVER
CALIBRATION
CENTER
PANORAMA
All except 2 CH modes (2-CHANNEL, 2 CH BYPASS, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1 2-CHANNEL, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL),
MONO, 5.1 MONO, and LIVE! modes
5-45
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
The parameter...
Is used in these modes
CENTER DEPTH
CENTER MIX
CNTR DLY SAMPLES
COMPRESSION
CTR WIDTH
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL
5.1 2-CHANNEL, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL
5.1 2-CHANNEL, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL
All Dolby Digital modes
DPLII MUSIC and DPLIIx MUSIC
CUSTOM
All modes
CUSTOM VS PRESET
DIFFUSION
All modes
All LIVE! modes
DIMENSION
EARLY RFLX LVL
EFFECT LVL
DPLII MUSIC and DPLIIx MUSIC
All LIVE! modes
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, PANORAMA, MONO LOGIC, and 5.1 MONO LOGIC
ES DECODING
EX DECODING
FRONT STEERING
INPUT BALANCE
LFE
All DTS modes
5.1 PLIIx MOV, 5.1 PLIIx MUS, DOLBY DIGITAL EX, and DOLBY DIGITAL
L7 TV, L7 MUSIC, L7 MUSIC SURR, all 5.1 L7 modes, all DTS L7 modes, and all 5.1a L7 modes
PANORAMA
All Dolby Digital, DTS, and 5.1a modes
LFE MIX
All Dolby Digital modes except MONO modes (5.1 MONO LOGIC, 5.1 MONO SURR, 5.1 MONO), all DTS
modes, and all 5.1a modes except 5.1a STANDARD and 5.1a BYPASS
LISTENER POS
5-46
PANORAMA CALIBRATION
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Mode Adjust
The parameter...
Is used in these modes
LIVENESS
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL
LOW FREQ WIDTH
MASTER LEVEL
MID RT
PANORAMA
5.1 2-CHANNEL, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL
CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes
OUTPUT LEVELS
All except 2-CHANNEL, MONO, 5.1 2-CHANNEL, 5.1 MONO, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL, 2CH BYPASS,
and LIVE! modes
PANORAMA
PRE-DELAY
DPLII MUSIC and DPLIIx MUSIC
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes
RE-EQUALIZER
L7 FILM, L7 TV, DPLII + THX, DPLIIx + THX, 5.1 L7 FILM, 5.1 L7 TV, THX ULTRA2, THX SurEX, THX, DTS (ES) L7
FILM, DTS (ES) THX ULTRA2, DTS (ES) THX, 5.1a L7 FILM, 5.1a THX ULTRA2, 5.1a THX SurEX, 5.1a THX
REAR DLY OFFSET
REAR L/R
All L7 modes and PANORAMA
All except 2-CHANNEL, MONO, 5.1 2-CHANNEL, 5.1 MONO, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL, 2CH BYPASS,
and LIVE! modes
RESET MODE
REVERB LVL
ROLLOFF
SHAPE
All modes
All LIVE! modes
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes
All LIVE! modes
SIDE L/R
All except 2-CHANNEL, MONO, 5.1 2-CHANNEL, 5.1 MONO, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL, 2CH BYPASS,
and LIVE! modes
SIZE
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes
All L7 modes
SOUND STAGE
5-47
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mode Adjust
Lexicon
The parameter...
Is used in these modes
SOURCE
PANORAMA CALIBRATION
PANORAMA CALIBRATION
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, and CATHEDRAL
All LIVE! modes
SPEAKER ANGLE
SPEECH DETECT
SPREAD
SUB L/R & SUB L/R LVL
SURR ROLLOFF
SURROUND DLY
SURROUND EX
SURROUND MIX
TREB CUT RT
All except LIVE! modes
All L7 modes
DPLII MUSIC and DPLIIx MUSIC
THX ULTRA2, THX SurEX, THX
5.1 2-CHANNEL, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL
All LIVE! modes
VOCAL ENHANCE
All L7 modes
5-48
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6
Troubleshooting & Maintenance
Troubleshooting..........................................................................6-2
Routine Maintenance..................................................................6-3
Restoring Factory-default Settings ...............................................6-4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Troubleshooting & Maintenance
Lexicon
2. Make sure volume level is audible. Volume level can be
TROUBLESHOOTING
increased with the front panel volume knob or the remote con-
trol VOL + and – buttons.
The MC-12 does not power on.
3. Make sure audio has not been muted. The message “MUTE
ON” or “FULL MUTE ON” will appear in the on-screen and
front panel displays when audio has been muted. To deactivate
mute, press the Mute button or adjust the volume level.
1. Make sure the rear panel power switch is set to the I (“on”)
position.
2. Attempt to power on the MC-12 with the front panel Standby
4. Check the INPUT SETUP menu DIGITAL IN and ANALOG IN
parameters to ensure the appropriate audio connector is assigned
to the selected input.
button and remote control On button.
3. Examine the power cord to ensure a good connection between
the rear panel AC input connector and the wall outlet.
5. Make sure the MC-12 is receiving an audio signal. To do this,
follow the instructions that begin on page 2-20 to open the
STATUS menu for the current input source.
4. Check the electrical circuit and breaker.
6. Make sure all associated power amplifiers are powered on.
The remote control does not work.
1. Eliminate obstructions between the remote control and the
front panel IR receiver. When the MC-12 is not using the rear
panel IR IN connector, the remote control must be in
line-of-sight with the front panel IR receiver for proper opera-
tion. The remote control might also become unreliable if
strong sunlight or fluorescent light is shining on the IR receiver.
Dialog sounds muffled.
If the speaker setup does not include a center speaker, make sure a
custom – as opposed to a THX – speaker setup is selected. Then,
make sure the CUSTOM SETUP menu CENTER parameter is set to
NONE.
2. Make sure the remote control batteries are correctly inserted
with the proper polarity.
A humming sound is present in the audio.
3. Replace the remote control batteries. When the batteries are
low on power, the remote control enters a low-voltage condi-
tion that prevents it from operating the MC-12.
1. If a cable TV connection is present, disconnect the cable from
the wall outlet. If this eliminates the humming sound, a ground
loop isolation device is required. Contact your dealer or the
cable provider for assistance.
The MC-12 is powered on, but there is no audio.
2. Disconnect components one at a time to isolate the problem.
Once the problem is identified, make sure the associated com-
ponent is properly grounded and connected to the same elec-
trical circuit as the MC-12.
1. Examine the audio cables to ensure a good connection
between the MC-12 and all associated power amplifiers.
6-2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Troubleshooting & Maintenance
The MC-12 is powered on, but there is no video.
2. Use the MC-12 configuration tool to download the current
MC-12 configuration to a personal computer (PC) or docu-
ment all user-defined settings on the installation worksheet
that begins on page A-20. Then, follow the instructions on
page 6-4 to restore factory-default settings.
1. Examine the video cables – particularly the S-video cables – to
ensure a good connection to the associated component.
2. Check the INPUT SETUP menu VIDEO IN and COMPONENT IN
parameters to ensure the appropriate video connector is
assigned to the selected input.
3. Contact an authorized Lexicon dealer.
4. Contact Lexicon customer service at 781-280-0300 or
www.lexicon.com.
RF interference is present in the audio or video.
Note:
1. Make sure the MC-12 is not positioned near unshielded TV or
FM antennas, cable TV decoders, and other RF-emitting
devices.
Visit the knowledgebase at http://www.lexicon.com/kbase for
answers to frequently asked questions and additional trouble-
shooting information.
2. Replace unshielded cables with shielded cables wherever possible.
The MC-12 is exhibiting erratic behavior.
ROUTINE MAINTENANCE
1. Set the rear panel power switch to the c(“off”) position. Wait
10 seconds. Then, set the rear panel power switch to the
| (“on”) position.
The bulleted items below describe routine maintenance that
should be performed on a periodic basis.
2. Use the MC-12 configuration tool to download the current
MC-12 configuration to a personal computer (PC) or docu-
ment all user-defined settings on the installation worksheet
next page to restore factory-default settings.
•
Clean the MC-12 exterior surface with a soft, lint-free cloth. Do
not use alcohol, benzene, acetone-based cleaners, or strong
commercial cleaners. Do not use a cloth made with steel wool
or metal polish. If the MC-12 is exposed to a dusty environ-
ment, a low-pressure blower can be used to remove dust from
its exterior surface.
•
Replace the remote control batteries as needed. The remote
control requires two AA batteries. When these batteries are low
on power, the remote control enters a low-voltage condition
that prevents it from operating the MC-12. Normal operation
will resume when new batteries are installed.
If all else fails . . .
1. Set the rear panel power switch to the c(“off”) position. Wait
10 seconds. Then, set the rear panel power switch to the
| (“on”) position.
6-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Troubleshooting & Maintenance
Lexicon
5. Press the ꢁ and ꢂ arrow buttons to highlight the desired
option.
RESTORING FACTORY-DEFAULT SETTINGS
When factory-default settings are restored, all parameters and
user-defined values are restored to their factory-default settings.
Before restoring factory-default settings, you should record all
user-defined settings.
•
•
Highlight RESTORE DEFAULTS to restore factory default settings.
Highlight EXIT to close the FACTORY SETTINGS menu without
restoring factory-default settings.
6. When the desired option is highlighted, press the ꢀ arrow
button to select this option.
FACTORY SETTINGS
FACTORY SETTINGS
•
If the RESTORE DEFAULTS option was selected, the FAC-
TORY SETTINGS message shown on the previous page will
appear on the on-screen and front panel displays. When this
message appears, press a front panel or remote control but-
ton to restart the MC-12.
EXIT
HAVE BEEN RESTORED
PRESS ANY KEY
TO RESTART
RESTORE DEFAULTS
To restore factory-default settings:
•
If the EXIT option is selected, the FACTORY SETTINGS menu
will close and the two-line status will open on the on-screen
and front panel displays
1. Select one of the following options to record user defined settings:
•
•
Use the Configuration Tool to download current MC-12 set-
tings to a personal computer (PC). The configuration tool is
available at www.lexicon.com/mc12/downloads. asp.
Record user-defined settings on the installation worksheet
2. If applicable, press the Standby Button to activate standby
mode.
3. When standby mode is activated, press the Standby Button
to deactivate standby mode.
4. After the Standby Button is pressed, quickly press and hold the
Mute button until the FACTORY SETTINGS menu shown above
opens on the on-screen and front panel displays.
Note:
The Mute button must be pressed within 2 seconds of deac-
tivating standby mode. Otherwise, the "MUTE ON" message
will appear on the on-screen and front panel displays. If this
occurs, too much time has passed. Begin again with step 2.
6-4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
A
Appendix
Specifications............................................................................. A-2
Declaration of Conformity.......................................................... A-4
Menu Tree ................................................................................. A-5
Installation Worksheet ............................................................. A-20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix
Lexicon
SPECIFICATIONS
Main Zone Audio Performance
Audio Input & Output Connectors
Output Level
• 150mVrms typical, 6Vrms maximum (RCA connectors)
• 300mVrms typical, 12Vrms maximum (XLR connectors,
MC-12 Balanced only)
• Maximum value with full-scale input signal and volume at
+12dB
Analog Audio Inputs
Digital Audio Inputs
• 8 stereo (RCA) or 5 stereo and one 5.1-channel connectors
• 6 S/PDIF coaxial (RCA), 6 S/PDIF optical (5 TosLink and 1
optical mini jack), and 1 AES/EBU (XLR) connectors
• Coaxial and optical input connectors conform to IEC-
958, S/PDIF standards
• Accepts 44.1, 48, 88.2 and 96kHz sample rates
• Accepts 16-24 bits PCM audio, Dolby Digital, DTS and
DTS-ES discrete data formats
Output Impedance
• 100Ω in parallel with 150pF (RCA connectors)
• 50Ω in parallel with 150pF (XLR connectors, MC-12 Bal-
anced only)
Main Zone Audio
Outputs
• 12 unbalanced (RCA) and 12 balanced (XLR, MC-12
Balanced only) connectors for Front L/R, Center, LFE,
Subwoofer L/R, Side L/R, and Rear L/R, and Auxiliary L/R
Zone 2 & Record Zone Audio Performance
Zone 2 Audio Outputs • 2 unbalanced (RCA, 1 fixed and 1 variable output level)
stereo connectors and 1 balanced stereo connector
A/D Conversion
• 24-bit, 44.1 to 96kHz, dual-bit ∆Σarchitecture (Record
Zone only)
(XLR, variable output level, MC-12 Balanced only)
D/A Conversion
• 24-bit, 44.1 to 192kHz, multi-bit ∆Σ architecture
Record Zone Audio
Outputs
• 2 unbalanced (RCA, 1 fixed and 1 variable output level)
stereo connectors
• 1 S/PDIF coaxial (RDA) and 1 S/PDIF optical (TosLink)
connector (in parallel)
Frequency Response • 10Hz to 20kHz, +0.1dB/-0.25dB, -0.75dB at 40kHz, refer-
ence 1kHz
THD + Noise
• Below 0.005% at 1kHz, maximum output level
• 105dB minimum, 108dB typical, 22kHz bandwidth
Dynamic Range
Signal-to-Noise Ratio • 105dB minimum, 108dB typical, 22kHz bandwidth
Main Zone Audio Performance
Input Sensitivity
Input Impedance
Output Level
• 200mVrms (4Vrms for maximum output level)
A/D Conversion
D/A Conversion
• 24-bit, 96kHz, dual-bit ∆Σarchitecture
• 24-bit, 44.1 to 192kHz, multi-bit ∆Σ architecture
• 100kΩ in parallel with 150pF
• 200mVrms typical, 4Vrms maximum (RCA connectors)
• 400mVrms typical, 8Vrms maximum (XLR connectors,
Zone 2 only, MC-12 Balanced only)
• Maximum value with full-scale input signal and volume at
0dB
Frequency Response • 10Hz to 20kHz, +0.1dB/-0.25dB, -0.75dB at 40kHz, refer-
ence 1kHz
THD + Noise
• Below 0.003% at 1kHz, maximum output level
• 108dB minimum, 111dB typical, 22kHz bandwidth
Dynamic Range
Output Impedance
• 100Ω in parallel with 150pF (RCA connectors)
• 50Ω in parallel with 150pF (XLR connectors, Zone 2 only,
MC-12 Balanced only)
Signal-to-Noise Ratio • 108dB minimum, 111dB typical, 22kHz bandwidth
Input Sensitivity
• 200mVrms (2Vrms for maximum output level) at 0dB
input gain
Input Impedance
• 100kΩ in parallel with 150pF
A-2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Appendix
Video Input & Output Connectors
Microphone Input Connectors
Video Inputs
• 5 composite (RCA), 8 S-video, and 4 component video (3
RCA and 1 BNC))
Inputs
• 4 3.5 miniature phone jacks
• 10mVrms (400mV maximum input level)
Input Sensitivity
Input Impedence
Video Outputs
• 4 composite (RCA, 2 monitor and 2 Record Zone), 2 S-
video (2 monitor and 2 Record Zone), and 1 component
(BNC)
• 20kΩ (accepts balanced or unbalanced input signals)
Other
Composite & S-video Performance
Trigger Outputs
• 1 power on/off and 1 programmable connector on
detachable screw terminals (+12 VDC, 0.5 amps each)
Compatibility
Switching
• NTSC, PAL, and SECAM
• Active
RS-232 Serial Input/ • 2 9-pin D-sub connectors
Output
Output Level
Impedance
• 1.0V peak-to-peak
Power Requirements • 90-250 VAC, 50-60Hz, 60W (universal line input), detach-
able power cord
• 75Ω
Input Return Loss
Differential Gain
Differential Phase
Bandwidth
• >40dB
• <0.5%
• <0.5°
MC-12
Dimensions &
Weight
• Height (with feet): 5.2 inches (132mm)
• Width: 17.3 inches (440mm)
• Depth: 14.85 inches (377mm)
• Weight: 36lbs (16.4kg)
• >25MHz
• <0.3%
MC-12 Balanced
Dimensions &
Weight
• Height (with feet): 6.63 inches (169mm)
• Width: 17.3 inches (440mm)
• Depth: 14.85 inches (377mm)
• Weight: 45lbs (20.5kg)
K Factor
Gain
•
0.15dB
Signal-to-Noise Ratio • >70dB
Rack Mounting
Environment
• Optional brackets are available for installation in a stan-
dard 19" equipment rack (2 rack units required for MC-
12; 3 rack units required for MC-12 Balanced.)
Frequency Response • 10Hz to 10MHz + 0.1/-0.3dB
• Operating Temperature: 0° to 35°C (32° to 95°F)
• Storage Temperature: -30° to 75°C (-22° to 167°F)
• Relative Humidity: 95% maximum without condensation
Component Video Performance
Compatibility
Switching
• 3-channel (Y, Pr, Pb), format-independent
Remote Control
• Hand-held, backlit infrared remote control unit
• Requires 2 AA batteries (Alkaline batteries recommended)
• Passive
• 75Ω
Impedence
Insertion Loss
Bandwidth
• <3dB
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
• >300MHz
A-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix
DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY
Lexicon
Application of Council Directive(s):
89/336/EEC and 93/68/EEC
Standard(s) to Which Conformity is Declared:
EN55022:1998, EN55024:1998, EN61000-3-2: 2000,
EN61000-3-3:2000, and EN60065: 1998
Manufacturer:
Harman Specialty Group
3 Oak Park
Bedford, MA 01730-1413 USA
The equipment identified here conforms to the Directive(s)
and Standard(s) specified above.
Type of Equipment: Digital Controller
Model:
Date:
Lexicon MC-12
June 2001
Harman Specialty Group
Vice President of Engineering
3 Oak Park
Bedford, MA 01730-1413 USA
Tel: 781-280-0300
Fax: 781-280-0490
A-4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Appendix
MENU TREE
TRIGGER SETUP
TRIGGER SETUP
Selecting SETUPꢀTRIGGERS prompts the
selection of a trigger output connector.
Selecting a connector opens the TRIGGER
SETUP menu Shown at the far right. The
parameters on the left side of the TRIGGER
SETUP menu are identical regardless of the
selected connector. The TRIGGER SETUP
menu indicates factory-default parameter
settings for both connectors.
MAIN MENU
SETUP
REMOTE ONLY
DVD1
ON
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
5.1 MONO SURR
5.1 MONO
FILM
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
VCR
CD
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
ZONE2 INPUTS
RECORD INPUTS
FILM
TV
MUSIC
MUSIC SURR
PLIIx +
PLIIx MOV
PLIIx MUS
PLII +
PLII MOVIE
PLII MUSIC
PL +
PRO LOGIC
+
MUSIC
TRIGGER SETUP
TRIGGER 1
TRIGGER 2
REMOTE
REMOTE
MUSIC
2-CHAN
5.1a FILM
5.1a MUSIC
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
5.1a
5.1a
SurEX
MUSIC
5.1a STANDARD
5.1a 2-CHANNEL
5.1a BYPASS
2CH BYPASS
LIVE! SMALL
LIVE! MED
LIVE! CALIBRATION
!CAUTION!
HIGH AUDIO LEVELS
LIVE! LARGE
INPUT SETUP
VOLUME CONTROL SETUP
MAIN POWER ON -30dB
REAR PANEL CONFIG
continued on page A-14
8 STEREO INPUTS
OR
5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG
DVD1
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
MUTE LEVEL
ZONE PWR ON
REC PWR ON
MAX VOLUME
-30dB
-30dB
-30dB
+12dB
LOCK OPTIONS
MODES
AUDIO CNTRL UNLOCKED
SETUP
UNLOCKED
8 STEREO INPUTS
FOR REAR PANEL CFG
UNLOCKED
VCR
CD
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB
CIN
MUSIC
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
5 ST. & (1) 5.1 ANLG
FOR REAR PANEL CFG
NIGHTCLUB
CONCERT HHALL
CHURCH
CATHEDRAL
PANORAMA
2-CH SURROUND
2-CHANNEL
MONO LOGIC
MONO SURROUND
MONO
5.1 FILM
5.1 TV
5.1 MUSIC
SurEX
-10dB
-20dB
-30dB
LOCKED
UNLOCKED
-40dB
FULL MUTE
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY
continued on page A-6
ALWAYS ON
100%
STATUS
BRIGHTNESS
SPEAKER SETUP
100%
75%
50%
25%
SETUP CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
DISPLAY SETUP
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY
A/V SYNC DELAY
CUSTOM NAME
EDIT CUSTOM NAME
MUSIC
MANUAL
OFF
OFF
5.1 PLIIx MOV
5.1 PLIIx MUS
DIGITAL EX
5.1 2-CHANNEL
5.1 MONO LOGIC
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
ALWAYS ON
2 SECONDS
ALWAYS OFF
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
STATUS
POSITION
2 SECONDS
TOP
continued on page A-9
EDIT CUSTOM NAME
MC-12
FORMAT
NTSC
TOP
CENTER
BOTTOM
ON
ON
BACKGROUND
REMOTE STATE
OFF, 1 to 60ms
BUTTONS TO EDIT
UP TO 20 CHARACTERS
BUTTON TO ADVANCE
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
SECAM
PAL
NTSC
ON
OFF
A-5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix
Lexicon
MENU TREE (continued)
Selecting SETUP ꢀ INPUTS prompts the selection of the
desired input (for example, DVD1). Selecting an input
opens the corresponding INPUT SETUP menu shown
below. The parameters on the left side of the INPUT SETUP
menus are identical regardless of which input is selected.
The parameter settings on the right side are adjustable.
Default parameter settings differ from input to input. The
INPUT SETUP menus shown below indicate default
parameter settings for each input.
SETUP
MAIN MENU
INPUT SETUP
INPUT SETUP
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
DVD1
DVD2
LD
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
TV
SAT
VCR
CD
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
DVD1 INPUT SETUP
LD INPUT SETUP
SAT INPUT SETUP
NAME
CD INPUT SETUP
GAME INPUT SETUP
TUNER INPUT SETUP
NAME
DVD1
COAX-1
NONE
NAME
LD
COAX-3
ANALOG-1
AUTO
S-VIDEO-3
1
SAT
NAME
CD
COAX-4
NONE
NAME
GAME
NAME
TUNER
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
OPTICAL-2
ANALOG-3
AUTO
S-VIDEO-5
4
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
OPTICAL-4
ANALOG-6
AUTO
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
NONE
ANALOG-8
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
S-VIDEO-1
1
VIDEO IN COMPOSITE-1
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
VIDEO IN COMPOSITE-2
NONE
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
1
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
1
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
1
FILM
FILM
TV
MUSIC
FILM
MUSIC
D
5.1 FILM
FILM
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
D
5.1 FILM
FILM
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
D
5.1 TV
FILM
D
5.1 MUSIC
MUSIC
D
5.1 FILM
FILM
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
D
5.1 MUSIC
MUSIC
5.1a
MIC
5.1a
MIC
5.1a
MIC
5.1a
FILM
5.1a
MIC
5.1a
FILM
5.1a
MIC
5.1a
MIC
5.1a
FILM
LIVE! MED
LIVE! MED
LIVE! MED
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
ANLG
ANLG
ANLG
ANLG
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
ANLG
ANLG
RECORD IN
RECORD IN
RECORD IN
RECORD IN
RECORD IN
RECORD IN
RECORD ADVANCED
RECORD ADVANCED
RECORD ADVANCED
RECORD ADVANCED
RECORD ADVANCED
RECORD ADVANCED
PVR INPUT SETUP
NAME
DVD2 INPUT SETUP
NAME
VCR INPUT SETUP
TAPE INPUT SETUP
NAME
AUX INPUT SETUP
NAME
TV INPUT SETUP
NAME
PVR
DVD2
NAME
VCR
TAPE
AUX
TV
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
OPTICAL-3
ANALOG-5
AUTO
S-VIDEO-7
1
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
COAX-2
NONE
DIGITAL IN
NONE
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
OPTICAL-5
ANALOG-7
AUTO
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
OPTICAL-6
NONE
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
OPTICAL-1
ANALOG-2
AUTO
S-VIDEO-4
3
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
ANALOG-4
AUTO
S-VIDEO-6
1
AUTO
AUTO
S-VIDEO-2
2
NONE
VIDEO IN COMPOSITE-3
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
1
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
1
TV
FILM
FILM
MUSIC
MUSIC
TV
TV
FILM
D
5.1 TV
FILM
D
5.1 FILM
FILM
D
5.1
FILM
FILM
FILM
D
5.1 MUSIC
MUSIC
D
5.1 MUSIC
MUSIC
D
5.1
5.1a
MIC
5.1a
FILM
5.1a
MIC
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
5.1a
MIC
5.1a
LIVE! MED
5.1a
MIC
5.1a
FILM
5.1a
MIC
5.1a
FILM
5.1a
MIC
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
LIVE! MED
LIVE! MED
LIVE! MED
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
RECORD ADVANCED
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
RECORD ADVANCED
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
RECORD ADVANCED
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
ANLG
ANLG
ANLG
ANLG
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
ANLG
ANLG
RECORD IN
RECORD IN
RECORD IN
RECORD ADVANCED
RECORD ADVANCED
RECORD ADVANCED
A-6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Appendix
MAIN MENU
SETUP
INPUT SETUP
DVD1 INPUT SETUP
NAME
Selecting an INPUT SETUP menu item opens the
corresponding menu shown below. These menus
are identical regardless of which input is selected.
The MAIN ADV and RECORD ADV menus shown
on the next page indicate factory-default parame-
ter settings for each input.
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
DVD1
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
VCR
CD
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
DVD1
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
COAX-1
NONE
AUTO
S-VIDEO-1
1
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
FILM
FILM
FILM
D
5.1
DIGITAL
ANLG
DMIX
5.1a
MIC
5.1a FILM
LIVE! MED
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
DVD1
D MODE
RECORD IN
AUTO
OFF
RECORD ADVANCED
5.1 FILM
5.1 TV
5.1 MUSIC
DIGITAL
ANALOG
AUTO
DVD1 ANALOG IN
DVD1 2-CH MODE
DVD1 VIDEO IN
DVD1 INPUT NAME
COMPOSITE-1
COMPOSITE-2
COMPOSITE-3
COMPOSITE-4
COMPOSITE-5
S-VIDEO-1
S-VIDEO-2
S-VIDEO-3
S-VIDEO-4
S-VIDEO-5
S-VIDEO-6
S-VIDEO-7
S-VIDEO-8
NONE
DIGITAL
ANALOG-1
ANALOG-2
ANALOG-3
ANALOG-4
ANALOG-5
ANALOG-6
ANALOG-7 5.1 ANLG (6-8)
ANALOG-8
NONE
EDIT INPUT NAME
RESTORE DEFAULT NAME
FILM
TV
MUSIC
MUSIC SURR
PLII +
PLII MOVIE
5.1 2-CHANNEL
5.1 MONO LOGIC
5.1 MONO SURR
5.1 MONO
DVD1 MAIN ADV
DIGITAL
OFF
AUTO
ON
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
PRESS MENU TO
RESTORE INPUT NAME
USE LAST
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
PLII MUSIC
EDIT INPUT NAME
DVD1
OFF
COMPONENT OSD
PL +
DVD1
MODE
FILM
PRO LOGIC
NIGHTCLUB
CONCERT HALL
CHURCH
LIVE!
ON
OFF
MUSIC
BUTTONS TO EDIT
UP TO 8 CHARACTERS
BUTTON TO ADVANCE
CATHEDRAL
PANORAMA
2-CH SURROUND
2-CHANNEL
MONO LOGIC
MONO SURROUND
MONO
DVD1 RECORD ADV
DVD1 ANLG IN LVL
2-CHAN
USE LAST
DIGITAL
ANLG IN LVL
ON
+0.dB
AUTO
MANUAL
DVD1 DIGITAL IN
OFF
DIGITAL BYPASS
44.1kHz
ENABLED
COAX-1
COAX-2
COAX-3
COAX-4
COAX-5
COAX-6
OPTICAL-1
OPTICAL-2
OPTICAL-3
OPTICAL-4
OPTICAL-5
OPTICAL-6
AES/EBU
NONE
DIG OUT RATE
RECORD
DVD1 5.1a MODE
DVD1 COMPONENT
5.1a FILM
5.1a MUSIC
5.1a
5.1a STANDARD
5.1a 2-CHAN
USE LAST
COMPONENT-1
COMPONENT-2
COMPONENT-3
COMPONENT-4
AUTO GAIN
+0.0dB
L
R
dB
BLOCKED
ENABLED
USE LAST
0
-6
-15
-30
INPUT
96kHz
-45
88.2kHz
48kHz
DVD1 MIC MODE
-18 to +12dB
44.1kHz
LIVE! SMALL
LIVE! MED
LIVE! LARGE
USE LAST
ON
OFF
-18 to +12dB
A-7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix
Lexicon
MENU TREE (continued)
MAIN MENU
SETUP
The MAIN ADV and RECORD ADV menus indicate
factory-default parameter settings for each input.
INPUT SETUP
CD INPUT SETUP
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
DVD1
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
VCR
CD
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
NAME
CD
COAX-4
NONE
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
AUTO
VIDEO IN COMPOSITE-1
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
1
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
MUSIC
D
5.1 MUSIC
MUSIC
5.1a
MIC
5.1a
FILM
LIVE! MED
MAIN ADVANCED
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
RECORD ADVANCED
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
DVD1 MAIN ADV
SAT MAIN ADV
GAME MAIN ADV
DIGITAL
OFF
AUTO
AUTO
OFF
AUTO
ON
AUTO
OFF
AUTO
ON
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
COMPONENT OSD
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
COMPONENT OSD
DVD1 RECORD ADV
SAT RECORD ADV
GAME RECORD ADV
+OdB
OFF
+OdB
OFF
44.1kHz
+OdB
OFF
ANLG IN LVL
ANLG IN LVL
DIGITAL BYPASS
ANLG IN LVL
DIGITAL BYPASS
DIGITAL BYPASS
ON
OFF
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
COMPONENT OSD
44.1kHz
44.1kHz
DIG OUT RATE
RECORD
DIG OUT RATE
RECORD
DIG OUT RATE
RECORD
OFF
OFF
ENABLED
ENABLED
ENABLED
DVD2 MAIN ADV
VCR MAIN ADV
TAPE MAIN ADV
DIGITAL
OFF
ANALOG
OFF
AUTO
OFF
AUTO
ON
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
COMPONENT OSD
DVD2 RECORD ADV
VCR RECORD ADV
TAPE RECORD ADV
+OdB
OFF
+OdB
OFF
44.1kHz
+OdB
OFF
ANLG IN LVL
ANLG IN LVL
DIGITAL BYPASS
DIG OUT RATE
ANLG IN LVL
AUTO
ON
AUTO
ON
DIGITAL BYPASS
DIGITAL BYPASS
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
COMPONENT OSD
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
COMPONENT OSD
44.1kHz
44.1kHz
DIG OUT RATE
RECORD
DIG OUT RATE
RECORD
OFF
OFF
OFF
ENABLED
BLOCKED
BLOCKED
RECORD
LD MAIN ADV
CD MAIN ADV
TUNER MAIN ADV
AUTO
OFF
AUTO
ON
DIGITAL
OFF
AUTO
ON
ANALOG
OFF
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
COMPONENT OSD
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
LD RECORD ADV
CD RECORD ADV
TUNER RECORD ADV
+OdB
OFF
44.1kHz
ENABLED
+OdB
OFF
44.1kHz
ENABLED
+OdB
OFF
ANLG IN LVL
DIGITAL BYPASS
DIG OUT RATE
RECORD
ANLG IN LVL
DIGITAL BYPASS
DIG OUT RATE
RECORD
ANLG IN LVL
AUTO
ON
DIGITAL BYPASS
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
44.1kHz
DIG OUT RATE
RECORD
OFF
OFF
OFF
COMPONENT OSD
COMPONENT OSD
ENABLED
TV MAIN ADV
PVR MAIN ADV
AUX MAIN ADV
AUTO
OFF
AUTO
ON
AUTO
OFF
AUTO
ON
DIGITAL
OFF
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
COMPONENT OSD
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
COMPONENT OSD
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
TV RECORD ADV
PVR RECORD ADV
AUX RECORD ADV
+OdB
OFF
44.1kHz
ENABLED
+OdB
OFF
44.1kHz
+OdB
OFF
44.1kHz
ANLG IN LVL
DIGITAL BYPASS
DIG OUT RATE
ANLG IN LVL
DIGITAL BYPASS
DIG OUT RATE
ANLG IN LVL
DIGITAL BYPASS
DIG OUT RATE
AUTO
ON
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3
COMPONENT OSD
OFF
OFF
OFF
BLOCKED
ENABLED
RECORD
RECORD
RECORD
A-8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Appendix
MAIN MENU
SETUP
SPEAKER SETUP
C
R
O
S
S
OV
E
R
S
ETUP
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
CUSTOM SETUP
THX SETUP
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
MANUAL
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
80Hz
R
C
SR
RR
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
M
SUB
L
SL RL
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
80Hz
THX SPEAKER SETUP
THX SETUP
THX REAR SPEAKERS
CUSTOM SETUP
FRONT L/R
CENTER
SIDE L/R
REAR L/R
SUB L/R
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
MONO
THX 80Hz
NONE
!CAUTION!
PRESSING THE
BUTTON WILL
FRONT L/R
CENTER
SIDE L/R
REAR L/R
SUB L/R
SUB XOVER
LFE
80 Hz
80 Hz
80 Hz
80 Hz
MONO
80 Hz
OFF
AUTOMATICALLY CHANGE
THE OUTPUTS TO A THX
SPEAKER
ON
OFF
SUB XOVER THX 80Hz
ON
OFF
LFE
OFF
ULTRA2 SUB OFF
N/A
CONFIGURATION
APART
CLOSE
TOGETHER
ULTRA2 SUB OFF
BGC
ASA
APART
CLOSE
TOGETHER
BGC
ASA
N/A
APART
APART
FRONT L/R SPEAKERS
REAR L/R SPEAKERS
CENTER SPEAKERS
SIDE L/R SPEAKERS
SUBWOOFERS L/R
SUB XOVER
FULL
FULL + SUB
FULL
FULL + SUB
FULL
FULL + SUB
FULL
FULL + SUB
MONO
STEREO
FULL
30Hz
30Hz
40Hz
30Hz
30Hz
30Hz
NONE
40Hz
50Hz
40Hz
40Hz
40Hz
50Hz
60Hz
50Hz
50Hz
50Hz
60Hz
70Hz
60Hz
60Hz
60Hz
70Hz
80Hz
70Hz
70Hz
70Hz
80Hz
THX 80Hz
90Hz
100Hz
110Hz
120Hz
THX 80Hz
90Hz
100Hz
110Hz
120Hz
80Hz
THX 80Hz
90Hz
100Hz
110Hz
120Hz
NONE
80Hz
THX 80Hz
90Hz
100Hz
110Hz
120Hz
NONE
80Hz
THX 80Hz
90Hz
100Hz
110Hz
120Hz
NONE
A-9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix
Lexicon
MENU TREE (continued)
CHECK MICROPHONES
CHECKING FOR SILENCE
CHECK MICROPHONES
CHECK MICROPHONES
MAIN MENU
SETUP
SPEAKER SETUP
CHECKING MICROPHONES
GROUP MICROPHONES
INTO A BUNDLE IN THE
MIDDLE OF THE ROOM
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
PLEASE WAIT
PLEASE WAIT
DISPLAYS
MANUAL
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
PRESS
TO BEGIN
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
MIC CHECK
When an ERROR mes-
sage appears on the last
CHECK MICROPHONES
screen, press the ꢁ and
ꢂ arrow buttons to high-
light the desired micro-
phone. Then, press the
ꢀarrow button to view
more details about the
error. One of the mes-
sages shown to the left
will appear in the on-
screen display.
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP
SPEAKER SETUP
CHECK MICROPHONES
(MICROPHONE)
NOT DETECTED
or
(MICROPHONE)
SIGNAL TOO LOW
or
(MICROPHONE)
OUT OF RANGE
or
or
DISTANCES & LEVELS
DISTANCES
OUTPUT LEVELS
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
MIC 1
MIC 2
MIC 3
MIC 4
ERROR
OK
OK
OK
MANUAL
PLACE MICROPHONES
IN PRIMARY LISTENING
POSITIONS
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
PRESS
TO VIEW
DETAILS
(MICROPHONE)
TOO MUCH ROOM NOISE
(MICROPHONE)
OK
When an ERROR message appears on the last CHECK
MICROPHONES screen, pressing the ꢃ arrow but-
ton opens the SPEAKER SETUP menu. When no
ERROR message appears on the last CHECK MICRO-
PHONES screen, pressing the ꢃarrow button opens
the AUTO SPEAKER SETUP menu.
A-10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Appendix
MAIN MENU
SETUP
SPEAKER SETUP
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP
A
U
T
O
SPE
!CA
HIGH AU
YOU WILL E 10 SEC
TO LEAVE
SIT QU
PRESS
A
K
E
R
SETUP
N!
EVELS
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
DISTANCES & LEVELS
DISTANCES
OUTPUT LEVELS
U
D
TI
O
L
TEST WILL BEGIN IN
10
IO
MANUAL
T
H
A
V
PRESS TO SKIP
COUNTDOWN
PLACE MICROPHONES
IN PRIMARY LISTENING
POSITIONS
HE
R
OOM OR
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
I
E
TLY
T
O
BEGIN
MIC CHECK REQUIRED
FOR AUTO CALIBRATION
COUNTDOWN
When the MC-12 is finished calibrating speaker
distances and output levels, the AUTO SPEAKER
SETUP results screen shown at the left will open on
the on-screen display, indicating the results for
each calibration procedure. Press the ꢁ and ꢂ
arrow buttons to highlight the desired calibration
procedure. Then, press the ꢀ arrow button to
select this procedure. Selecting DISTANCES opens
the AUTO DISTANCES screen shown below.
Selecting the LEVELS option opens the AUTO LEV-
ELS screen shown below.
SETTING DISTANCES
SETTING LEVELS
or
A
U
T
O
SPE
A
K
E
R
SETUP
A
U
T
O
SP
K
E
R
SETUP
ERROR
ERROR
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
N/A
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
N/A
DISTANCES
LEVELS
OK
OK
DISTANCES
LEVELS
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
SUB (MONO)
SUB RIGHT
LFE
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
SUB (MONO)
SUB RIGHT
LFE
AUTO VALUES APPLIED
PRESS TO VIEW
DETAILS
AUTO VALUES APPLIED
PRESS TO VIEW
DETAILS
LEVELS
OK
OK
N/A
N/A
DISTANCES
The AUTO DISTANCES and AUTO LEVELS screens
shown at the right indicate the individual calibra-
tion results for each speaker. Press the ꢁ and ꢂ
arrow buttons to highlight the desired speaker cali-
bration parameter. Then, press the ꢀ arrow but-
ton to view more detailed results for the selected
speaker.
AUTO LEVELS
AUTO DISTANCES
(SPEAKER)
SPKR OUTPUT TOO HIGH
(SPEAKER)
SPEAKER OUT OF PHASE
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
ERROR
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
N/A
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
ERROR
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
N/A
(SPEAKER)
SPKR OUTPUT TOO LOW
(SPEAKER)
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
SUB (MONO)
SUB RIGHT
LFE
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
SUB (MONO)
SUB RIGHT
LFE
SIGNAL TOO LOW
(SPEAKER)
UNABLE TO CALCULATE
Press the ꢃ arrow button to return to the AUTO
SPEAKER SETUP results screen shown above (right).
Then, press the ꢀ arrow button to select the other
calibration procedure or press the the ꢃ arrow
button to return to the SPEAKER SETUP menu.
(SPEAKER)
MAY NOT BE ACCURATE
N/A
N/A
(SPEAKER)
(SPEAKER)
SPEAKER IS NOT ENABLED
(SPEAKER)
OK
(SPEAKER)
SPEAKER IS NOT ENABLED
OK
A-11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix
Lexicon
MENU TREE (continued)
MAIN MENU
SETUP
SPEAKER SETUP
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP
A
U
T
O
SPE
!CA
HIGH AU
YOU WILL E 10 SEC
TO LEAVE
SIT QU
PRESS
A
K
E
R
SETUP
N!
IOLEVELS
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
DISTANCES & LEVELS
DISTANCES
OUTPUT LEVELS
U
D
TI
O
TEST WILL BEGIN IN
10
MANUAL
T
H
A
V
PRESS TO SKIP
COUNTDOWN
PLACE MICROPHONES
IN PRIMARY LISTENING
POSITIONS
HE
R
OOM OR
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
I
E
TLY
T
O
BEGIN
MIC CHECK REQUIRED
FOR AUTO CALIBRATION
COUNTDOWN
The AUTO LEVELS screen shown below indicates the
individual calibration results for each speaker. Press the
SETTING DISTANCES
SETTING LEVELS
The AUTO DISTANCES screen shown below indicates
the individual calibration results for each speaker. Press
the ꢁ and ꢂ arrow buttons to highlight the desired
speaker calibration parameter. Then, press the ꢃ
arrow button to view more detailed results for the
selected speaker.
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
N/A
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
N/A
ꢁ
and ꢂ arrow buttons to highlight the desired
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
SUB (MONO)
SUB RIGHT
LFE
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
SUB (MONO)
SUB RIGHT
LFE
speaker calibration parameter. Then, press the ꢃ
arrow button to view more detailed results for the
selected speaker.
N/A
N/A
AUTO LEVELS
AUTO DISTANCES
(SPEAKER)
SET DISTANCES
SET LEVELS
(SPEAKER)
SPKR OUTPUT TOO HIGH
SPEAKER OUT OF PHASE
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
ERROR
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
N/A
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
ERROR
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
N/A
AUTO DISTANCES
ORIGINAL DISTANCES
AUTO LEVELS
ORIGINAL LEVELS
(SPEAKER)
SPKR OUTPUT TOO LOW
(SPEAKER)
SIGNAL TOO LOW
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
SUB (MONO)
SUB RIGHT
LFE
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
SUB (MONO)
SUB RIGHT
LFE
(SPEAKER)
OK
R
C
SR
RR
R
SR
RR
(SPEAKER)
UNABLE TO CALCULATE
0.0ft
0.0dB
0.0ft
0.0dB
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0dB
C
(SPEAKER)
SPEAKER IS NOT ENABLED
(SPEAKER)
MAY NOT BE ACCURATE
0.0dB
N/A
M
SUB
M
SUB
N/A
L
SL RL
0.0ft
L
SL RL
0.0dB
0.0dB
(SPEAKER)
OK
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0dB
0.0dB
AUTO DISTANCES
APPLIED
AUTO LEVELS
ORIGINAL LEVELS
APPLIED
APPLIED
ORIGINAL DISTANCES
APPLIED
(SPEAKER)
SPEAKER IS NOT ENABLED
A-12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Appendix
LEVELS CALIBRATION
MAIN MENU
SETUP
SPEAKER SETUP
MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
SET CROSSOVERS
CHECK MICROPHONES
AUTOMATIC
SPEAKER DISTANCES
LEVELS CALIBRATION
INTERNAL NOISE TEST
EXTERNAL NOISE TEST
BASS PEAK LIMITER
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
MANUAL
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
R
C
SR
RR
60Hz
SET CROSSOVERS
BEFORE CALIBRATING
60Hz
40Hz
60Hz
M
SUB
L
SL RL
60Hz
40Hz
60Hz
40Hz
SPEAKER DISTANCES
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
0.0ft
N/A
BASS PEAK LIMITER
SPEAKER LEVEL ADJUST
INTERNAL NOISE
!CAUTION!
HIGH AUDIO LEVELS
CAL NOISE
ON
ON
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
SUB (MONO)
SUB RIGHT
LFE
FRONT LEFT
CENTER
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
N/A
L/R LIMITER
L/R LIMIT ADJ
LFE LIMITER’
LFE LIMIT ADJ
100dB
FRONT RIGHT
SIDE RIGHT
REAR RIGHT
REAR LEFT
SIDE LEFT
SUB (MONO)
SUB RIGHT
LFE
ON
100dB
!CAUTION!
HIGH AUDIO LEVELS
N/A
FEET
UNITS
N/A
0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m
METERS
FEET
75 to 120dB
-18 to 12dB
ON
OFF
A-13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix
Lexicon
MENU TREE (continued)
LIVE! CALIBRATION
LIVE! CALIBRATION
LIVE! CALIBRATION
IN PROGRESS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
MAIN MENU
SETUP
!CAUTION!
HIGH AUDIO LEVELS
INPUTS
SPEAKERS
REAR PANEL CONFIG
DISPLAYS
VOLUME CONTROLS
TRIGGERS
LOCK OPTIONS
LIVE! CALIBRATION
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
CALIBRATION DONE
TEST WILL BEGIN IN
10
PRESS TO SKIP
COUNTDOWN
YOU WILL HAVE 10 SEC
TO LEAVE THE ROOM OR
SIT QUIETLY
PLEASE WAIT
PRESS TO CONTINUE
PRESS TO BEGIN
COUNTDOWN
OR
LIVE! CALIBRATION
SIGNAL TOO LOW
PRESS TO CONTINUE
MAIN MENU
AUDIO CONTROLS
BASS
TREBLE
TILT EQ
LOUDNESS
BALANCE
FADER
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
OFF
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
<I>
<I>
ZONE2 BALANCE
RECORD BALANCE
<I>
<I>
L<
<l>
>R
B<
<l>
>F
ON
OFF
-3.0 to +3.0dB
-6.0 to +6.0dB
A-14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Appendix
MODE ADJUST
FILM
+
MAIN MENU
FILM
PLIIx +
CATHEDRAL
MODE ADJUST
AUDIO CONTROLS
SETUP
RE-EQUALIZER
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
ON
AUTO AZIMUTH
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB
ON
CENTER DEPTH
SPEECH DETECT
SIZE
MID RT
BASS RT
PRE-DELAY
ROLLOFF
EFFECT LVL
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
12
ON
30m
3.72s
4.47s
23ms
3.1kHz
-8dB
RE-EQUALIZER
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
ON
TV
MUSIC
MUSIC SURR
PLIIx +
PLIIx MOV
PLIIx MUS
PLII +
PLII MOVIE
PLII MUSIC
PL +
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET 15ms
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
ON
REAR
ON
OFF
7.0kHz
CIN
PLIIx MOV
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
MUSIC
PLIIx MUS
PRO LOGIC
+
Selecting
a
listening mode
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
PANORAMA
CTR WIDTH
DIMENSION
SURROUND DLY
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
OFF
3
NEUTRAL
opens the corresponding lis-
tening mode menu (pages A-
14 to A-16). The parameters
on the left side of the listening
mode menus differ from mode
to mode. The parameter set-
tings on the right side are
adjustable. The listening mode
menus shown here indicate
factory-default parameter set-
tings for each listening mode.
Listening mode menu param-
eter drop-down menus are
shown on pages A-16 to A-17.
TV
PANORAMA
EFFECT LVL
BASS CONTENT STEREO
LOW FREQ WIDTH +0
SURR ROLLOFF 3.1kHz
REAR DLY OFFSET 15ms
INPUT BALANCE
CALIBRATION
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
CIN
MUSIC
AUTO AZIMUTH
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB
ON
+4dB
NIGHTCLUB
CONCERT HALL
CHURCH
CATHEDRAL
PANORAMA
2-CH SURROUND
2-CHANNEL
MONO LOGIC
MONO SURROUND
MONO
10ms
NIGHTCLUB
FRONT STEERING
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET 15ms
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
FILM
OFF
REAR
ON
OFF
7.0kHz
CENTER DEPTH
SPEECH DETECT
SIZE
LIVENESS
PRE-DELAY
11
ON
5m
PLII +
<l>
196ms
5ms
9.0kHz
+3dB
RE-EQUALIZER
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
ON
ROLLOFF
EFFECT LVL
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
5.1 FILM
5.1 TV
2-CH SURROUND
PLII MOVIE
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
5.1 MUSIC
*
MUSIC
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
CONCERT HALL
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB
FRONT STEERING MUSIC
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET 15ms
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
MUSIC
CENTER DEPTH
SPEECH DETECT
SIZE
LIVENESS
PRE-DELAY
12
ON
20m
1.72ms
OFF
2.4kHz
-2dB
5.1 PLIIx MOV
5.1 PLIIx MUS
DIGITAL*
5.1 2-CHANNEL
5.1 MONO LOGIC
5.1 MONO SURR
5.1 MONO
FILM*
2-CHANNEL
PLII MUSIC
NEUTRAL
+0dB
ON
OFF
7.0kHz
SUB L/R LVL
CUSTOM
PANORAMA
CTR WIDTH
DIMENSION
SURROUND DLY
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
OFF
3
NEUTRAL
10ms
ROLLOFF
MONO LOGIC
EFFECT LVL
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
EFFECT LVL
-9dB
ON
3.1kHz
MUSIC*
*
ACADMY FILTER
SURR ROLLOFF
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
PL +
MUSIC
MUSIC SURR
CHURCH
*
RE-EQUALIZER
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
ON
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB
FRONT STEERING MSURR
SOUND STAGE NEUTRAL
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF 7.0kHz
REAR DLY OFFSET 15ms
OUTPUT LEVELS
2-CHAN*
CENTER DEPTH
SPEECH DETECT
SIZE
5
ON
20m
1.56s
1.87s
24ms
2.4kHz
-3dB
5.1a
5.1a
5.1a
5.1a
FILM
MUSIC
*
MONO SURROUND
ON
OFF
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
MID RT
MUSIC
PRO LOGIC
BASS RT
PRE-DELAY
ROLLOFF
EFFECT LVL
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
5.1a STANDARD
5.1a 2-CHANNEL
5.1a BYPASS
2CH BYPASS
LIVE! SMALL
LIVE! MED
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
MONO
CUSTOM
SUB L/R LVL
CUSTOM
+0dB
LIVE! LARGE
A-15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix
Lexicon
MENU TREE (continued)
5.1 MONO LOGIC
MUSIC
LIVE! SMALL
5.1 FILM
5.1a
EFFECT LVL
ACADEMY FILTER
SURR ROLLOFF 3.1kHz
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
-9dB
ON
LFE MIX
+0.0dB
RE-EQUALIZER
SURROUND EX
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
ON
AUTO
OFF
MID RT
BASS RT
ROLLOFF
TREB CUT RT
PRE DELAY
ADVANCED
CUSTOM
597ms
597ms
3.1kHz
3.1kHz
10ms
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB
RE-EQUALIZER
SURROUND EX
LFE MIX
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
ON
OFF
+0.0dB
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
FRONT STEERING
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
FILM
ON
REAR
ON
OFF
+0.0dB
LFE MIX
+0.0dB
AUTO
5.1 MONO SURR
DECODING
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
7.0kHz
15ms
OFF
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
5.1a
MUSIC
MUSIC
LFE MIX
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
+0.0dB
LIVE! SMALL ADVANCED
REVERB LVL +0dB
EARLY RFLX LVL -13dB
BASS XOVER
SHAPE
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
OFF
+0.0dB
+0.0dB
5.1 MONO
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
2-CHAN
SUB L/R LVL
CUSTOM
+0dB
CENTER MIX
SURROUND MIX
CNTR DLY SAMPLES +0
MASTER LEVEL
LFE MIX
DECODING
SUB L/R LVL
CUSTOM
+0dB
+0dB
156Hz
0
0%
19m
5.1a STANDARD
FILM
5.1 PLIIx MOV
SPREAD
SIZE
5.1 TV
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
+0dB
+0.0dB
AUTO
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB
EX DECODING
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
AUTO
OFF
+0.0dB
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB
FRONT STEERING
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
LFE MIX
FILM
ON
REAR
ON
OFF
7.0kHz
15ms
+0.0dB
AUTO
FRONT STEERING
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
FILM
OFF
REAR
ON
OFF
LIVE! MED
+0dB
5.1a 2-CHANNEL
MID RT
BASS RT
ROLLOFF
TREB CUT RT
PRE DELAY
ADVANCED
CUSTOM
1.84s
2.76s
2.4kHz
3.1kHz
18ms
CENTER MIX
SURROUND MIX
CNTR DLY SAMPLES +0
MASTER LEVEL
LFE MIX
+0dB
+0dB
5.1a FILM
7.0kHz
15ms
OFF
5.1 PLIIx MUS
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB
+0dB
+0.0dB
+0dB
FRONT STEERING
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
FILM
ON
REAR
ON
OFF
EX DECODING
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
AUTO
OFF
+0.0dB
DECODING
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
+0.0dB
SUB L/R LVL
CUSTOM
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
LIVE! MED ADVANCED
5.1a BYPASS
7.0kHz
15ms
OFF
MUSIC
REVERB LVL
EARLY RFLX LVL -14dB
BASS XOVER
SHAPE
SPREAD
SIZE
-4dB
5.1 MUSIC
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB
FRONT STEERING MUSIC
DIGITAL
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB
FRONT STEERING MUSIC
156Hz
2
25%
30m
+0.0dB
EX DECODING
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
AUTO
OFF
+0.0dB
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
LFE MIX
OFF
NEUTRAL
ON
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
OFF
NEUTRAL
ON
OFF
7.0kHz
15ms
2CH BYPASS
NO PARAMETERS
OFF
7.0kHz
15ms
+0.0dB
AUTO
5.1a MUSIC
LIVE! LARGE
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB
FRONT STEERING MUSIC
LIVE! LARGE ADVANCED
MID RT
BASS RT
ROLLOFF
TREB CUT RT
PRE DELAY
ADVANCED
CUSTOM
4.71s
4.71s
3.1kHz
2.4kHz
20ms
5.1 2-CHANNEL
REVERB LVL
EARLY RFLX LVL -17dB
BASS XOVER
SHAPE
SPREAD
SIZE
-6dB
RE-EQUALIZER
SOUND STAGE
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS ENHANCE
SURR ROLLOFF
REAR DLY OFFSET
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
OFF
NEUTRAL
ON
OFF
7.0kHz
15ms
OFF
+0.0dB
DECODING
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
CENTER MIX
SURROUND MIX
CNTR DLY SAMPLES +0
MASTER LEVEL
COMPRESSION
LFE MIX
SUB L/R LVL
CUSTOM
+0dB
+0dB
156Hz
2
28%
38m
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
+0dB
OFF
+0.0dB
RE-EQUALIZER
LFE MIX
DECODING
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
ON
+0.0dB
AUTO
OFF
+0.0dB
+0dB
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
A-16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Appendix
Selecting the listening mode menu CALIBRATION, OUTPUT LEVELS, or CUSTOM option opens the corresponding menu path shown below. The CALIBRATION option is available
for the PANORAMA listening mode. The OUTPUT LEVELS and CUSTOM options are available for most listening modes. These menus are identical regardless of which listening
mode is selected. Listening mode menu parameter drop-down menus are shown below and on the next page.
MONO LOGIC
EFFECT LVL
ACADMY FILTER
SURR ROLLOFF
OUTPUT LEVELS 3.1kHz
CUSTOM
CUSTOM
CUSTOM VS PRESET
RESET MODE
PANORAMA CALIBRATION
MONO LOGIC
EFFECT LVL
ACADMY FILTER
SURR ROLLOFF 3.1kHz
OUTPUT LEVELS 3.1kHz
CUSTOM
OUTPUT LEVELS
PANORAMA
EFFECT LVL
BASS CONTENT STEREO
LOW FREQ WIDTH +0
SURR ROLLOFF 3.1kHz
REAR DLY OFFSET 15ms
INPUT BALANCE
CALIBRATION
OUTPUT LEVELS
CUSTOM
-9dB
ON
+0
SOURCE LEFT & RIGHT
SPEAKER ANGLE 30deg
-9dB
ON
CENTER
SIDE L/R
REAR L/R
SUB L/R
+0dB
+0dB
+0dB
+0dB
+4dB
LISTENER POS
+0
NOTE:
ENSURE THAT
“SPEAKER SETUP” HAS
BEEN PROPERLY
PERFORMED
<I>
Selecting a listening mode menu parameter opens the corresponding parameter drop-down menu shown below and on the next page. These drop-down menus are identical
regardless of which listening mode is selected. However, certain parameter ranges differ from listening mode to listening mode.
5 SPKR ENHANCE
BASS CONTENT
CENTER
OFF, -30 to +12dB
CNTR DLY SAMPLES
-127 to +127
CUSTOM VS PRESET
DECODING
ON
OFF
BINAURL
MONO
AUTO
ON
PRESET
CUSTOM
STEREO
OFF
ACADEMY FILTER
BASS ENHANCE
CENTER DEPTH
COMPRESSION
EX DECODING
DIMENSION
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
AUTO
ON
OFF
AUTO
ON
OFF
FRONT
NEUTRAL
REAR
0 to 18
AUTO AZIMUTH
BASS RT
CENTER MIX
CTR WIDTH
EFFECT LVL
FRONT STEERING
-12 to +6dB
ON
OFF
5ms to 48.6s
-25 to +5dB
OFF
MIN,1 to 6, MAX
MSURR
MUSIC
FILM
A-17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix
Lexicon
MENU TREE (continued)
Refer to the Restoring Factory-Default Settings section that begins on page 6-4 for more information.
FACTORY SETTINGS
FACTORY SETTINGS
EXIT
HAVE BEEN RESTORED
PRESS ANY KEY
TO RESTART
RESTORE DEFAULTS
2CH STATUS
D STATUS
INPUT
MODE
CHANNELS
BIT RATE
EX ENCODING
PG1
D STATUS
PG2
INPUT
MODE
INPUT TYPE
SAMPLE RATE
SAMPLE RATE
2.0 ENCODING
DIALOG OFFSET
MIX ROOM
CENTER MIX LVL
SURR MIX LVL
dB
dB
L
R
L
C
R
SL
LFE
SR
0
-6
-15
-30
0
-6
-15
-30
-45
-45
STATUS
DIGITAL STATUS
STATUS
PG1
PG2
2CH BYPASS STATUS
5.1 ANALOG STATUS
5.1a BYPASS STATUS
INPUT
MODE
INPUT TYPE
SAMPLE RATE
INPUT
MODE
CHANNELS
BIT RATE
INPUT
MODE
INPUT TYPE
WORD LENGTH
SAMPLE RATE
INPUT
MODE
INPUT TYPE
SAMPLE RATE
INPUT
MODE
INPUT TYPE
ENCODING
dB
L
C
R
SL
LFE
SR
dB
L
C
R
SL
LFE
SR
0
-6
-15
-30
0
-6
-15
-30
-45
-45
2CH STATUS
INPUT
MODE
INPUT TYPE
SAMPLE RATE
L
R
dB
0
-6
-15
-30
-45
A-18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Appendix
INPUT BALANCE
MASTER LEVEL
-5 to +5dB
REAR DLY OFFSET
OFF, 1 to 30ms
SIZE
SPEECH DETECT
SURROUND DLY
0 to 15ms
4 to 20 or 30ms
ON
OFF
L<
<l>
>R
LFE MIX
MID RT
REAR L/R
OFF, -30 to 12dB
SOUND STAGE
SUB L/R
SURROUND EX
OFF, -30 to 12dB
FRONT
NEUTRAL
REAR
AUTO
ON
OFF
-20.0 or -10.0 to +0.0dB
24ms to 24.3s
CENTER MIX
PANORAMA
ON
RESET MODE
SOURCE
SUB L/R LVL
OFF, -30 to 12dB
SURROUND MIX
PRESS RIGHT
TO RESTORE MODE
-127
+0
+127
RIGHT
LEFT & RIGHT
LEFT
+5 to +5dB
OFF
LIVENESS
PRE-DELAY
OFF, 1 to 100ms
ROLLOFF
SPEAKER ANGLE
SURROUND ROLLOFF
VOCAL ENHANCE
30ms to 20.2s
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF
+6.0dB
+3.0dB
+0.0dB
10 to 90deg
LOW FREQ WIDTH
-25 to +25
RE-EQUALIZER
SIDE L/R
OFF, -30 to 12dB
ON
OFF
A-19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix
Lexicon
INSTALLATION WORKSHEET
INPUT SETUP
DVD1 DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
VCR
CD
PVR
GAME TAPE TUNER AUX
NAME
DIGITAL IN
ANALOG IN
ANLG IN LVL
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT IN
2-CH
D
5.1a
MIC
MAIN ADVANCED
INPUT SELECT
ANALOG BYPASS
S-VIDEO 16:9
S-VIDEO 4:3 OSD
COMPONENT OSD
ZONE2 IN
RECORD IN
RECORD ADVANCED
ANLG IN LVL
DIGITAL BYPASS
DIG OUT RATE
RECORD
A-20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Appendix
SPEAKER SETUP
CUSTOM SETUP
THX SETUP
SPEAKER DISTANCES
LEVELS CALIBRATIONS
THX 80Hz
FRONT LEFT/RIGHT
THX 80Hz
THX 80Hz
CENTER
SIDE LEFT/RIGHT
REAR LEFT/RIGHT
SUB LEFT/RIGHT
SUB XOVER
LFE
MONO
THX 80Hz
OFF
ULTRA2SUB
BGC
ASA
UNITS
BASS PEAK LIMITERS
CAL NOISE
L/R LIMITER
L/R LIMIT ADJ
LFE LIMITER
LFE LIMIT ADJ
REAR PANEL CONFIG
Circle one.
VOLUME CONTROL SETUP
LOCK OPTIONS
MAIN PWR ON
MODES
8 STEREO INPUTS
5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG MUTE LEVEL
ZONE PWR ON
AUDIO CONTROL
SETUP
REC PWR ON
MAX VOLUME
A-21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix
Lexicon
INSTALLATION WORKSHEET (continued)
DISPLAY SETUP
TRIGGER 1 SETUP
TRIGGER 2 SETUP
Circle all parameters set to ON.
Circle all parameters set to ON.
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY
STATUS
REMOTE ONLY
DVD1
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
VCR
CD
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
ZONE2 INPUTS
RECORD INPUTS
FILM
REMOTE ONLY
DVD1
DVD2
LD
TV
SAT
VCR
CD
PVR
GAME
TAPE
TUNER
AUX
ZONE2 INPUTS
RECORD INPUTS
FILM
2-CH SURROUND
2-CHANNEL
MONO LOGIC
MONO SURROUND
2-CH SURROUND
2-CHANNEL
MONO LOGIC
MONO SURROUND
MONO
POSITION
FORMAT
MONO
5.1
5.1
5.1
FILM
TV
MUSIC
BACKGROUND
REMOTE STATE
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY
STATUS
5.1
5.1
5.1
FILM
TV
MUSIC
MUSIC
MUSIC
5.1 PLIIx MOV
5.1 PLIIx MUS
DIGITAL EX
5.1 2-CHANNEL
5.1 MONO LOGIC
5.1 MONO SURR
5.1 MONO
5.1 PLIIx MOV
5.1 PLIIx MUS
DIGITAL EX
5.1 2-CHANNEL
5.1 MONO LOGIC
5.1 MONO SURR
5.1 MONO
BRIGHTNESS
A/V SYNC DELAY
CUSTOM NAME
EDIT CUSTOM NAME
AUDIO CONTROLS
BASS
TV
MUSIC
MUSIC SURR
PLIIx +
PLIIx MOV
PLIIx MUS
PLII +
PLII MOVIE
PLII MUSIC
PL +
PRO LOGIC
+
TV
MUSIC
MUSIC SURR
PLIIx +
PLIIx MOV
PLIIx MUS
PLII +
PLII MOVIE
PLII MUSIC
PL +
PRO LOGIC
+
FILM
MUSIC
FILM
MUSIC
MUSIC
MUSIC
TREBLE
2-CHAN
FILM
MUSIC
SurEX
MUSIC
2-CHAN
FILM
MUSIC
SurEX
MUSIC
TILT EQ
5.1a
5.1a
5.1a
5.1a
5.1a
5.1a
5.1a
5.1a
LOUDNESS
BALANCE
FADER
5.1a STANDARD
5.1a 2-CHANNEL
5.1a BYPASS
2CH BYPASS
LIVE! SMALL
LIVE! MED
5.1a STANDARD
5.1a 2-CHANNEL
5.1a BYPASS
2CH BYPASS
LIVE! SMALL
LIVE! MED
CIN
MUSIC
NIGHTCLUB
CONCERT HALL
CHURCH
CATHEDRAL
PANORAMA
CIN
MUSIC
NIGHTCLUB
CONCERT HALL
CHURCH
CATHEDRAL
PANORAMA
ZONE2 BALANCE
RECORD BALANCE
LIVE! LARGE
LIVE! LARGE
A-22
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Index
Numerics
A
B
2.0 ENCODING parameter, 2-25
2CH
status menu, 2-21
2CH button, 2-17
about the MC-12, 1-2
AC input connector, 2-7
balanced audio output connectors, 2-9
frequency response graph, 4-3
settings, 4-5
advanced speaker array, 3-32
ANALOB BYPASS parameter, 3-15
analog audio input connectors, 2-7
anamorphic trigger signals, 3-16
arrow buttons, 2-17
2CH BYPASS
status menu, 2-23
2CH BYPASS listening mode, 5-33
2-CH SURROUND listening mode, 5-15
2-CHANNEL listening mode, 5-15
BASS XOVER parameter, 5-37
5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG option, 3-60
5.1 2-CHANNEL listening mode, 5-22
5.1 ANALOG STATUS menu, 2-22
5.1 MONO listening mode, 5-23
5.1 MONO LOGIC listening mode, 5-23
5.1 MONO SURR listening mode, 5-23
5.1a 2-CHANNEL listening mode, 5-32
5.1a BYPASS
ASA parameter, 3-26
battery installation
remote control, 1-6
BLUE button. See remote control, 2-16
boundary gain compensation, 3-32
assigning input connectors, 3-7
audio input connectors
5.1-channel analog, 2-7
analog, 2-7
audio output connectors
balanced, 2-9
main zone, 2-7
record zone analog, 2-9
record zone digital, 2-9
C
Calibration
5.1a STANDARD listening mode, 5-31
5.1a THX MUSIC listening mode, 5-31
5.1a THX SurEX listening mode, 5-30
5.1a THX ULTRA2 listening mode, 5-30
5.1-channel analog audio input connectors, 2-7
manual, 3-52
output levels, 3-33
speaker distances, 3-33
AUTO DISTANCES, 3-49
AUTO LEVELS, 3-49
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP screens, 3-47
Automatic Calibration, 3-35
CATHEDRAL listening mode, 5-12
CENTER L/R parameter, 3-28
CENTER MIX LVL parameter, 2-25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Index
Lexicon
Dolby Digital status menu, 2-21
FP button. See remote control, 2-16
front panel
C (continued)
DOLBY PLII MUSIC listening mode, 5-8
DOLBY PLIIx + THX listening mode, 5-7
DOLBY PRO LOGIC listening mode, 5-9
changing input names, 3-5
CHANNELS parameter, 2-25
CHECK MICROPHONES option, 3-35, 3-39
CHURCH listening mode, 5-12
COMPONENT IN menu, 3-11
display, 2-3
MC-12, 2-2
MC-12 Balanced, 2-4
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY menu, 3-65
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY parameter, 3-61
FRONT RIGHT parameter, 3-34
COMPONENT IN parameter, 3-7
DTS listening mode, 5-27
CONCERT HALL listening mode, 5-11
CROSSOVER SETUP menu, 3-25
DTS Neo:6 CIN listening mode, 5-10
DTS Neo:6 FILM listening mode, 5-4
DTS status menu, 2-22
DTS THX MUSIC listening mode, 5-27
DTS THX UL2 Cin listening mode, 5-26
DTS-ES 2-CHAN listening mode, 5-28
DTS-ES DECODING parameter, 5-24
H
highlights, MC-12, 1-4
high-pass filter, 3-23
horizontal bar graphs, 2-12
CUSTOM parameter, 5-38
I
input connectors
D
digital audio, 2-7
video, 2-9
Declaration of Conformity, A-4
DIALOG OFFSET parameter, 2-25
Dig Out Rate parameter, 3-21
digital audio input connectors, 2-7
DIGITAL IN parameter, 3-7
E
EARLY RFLX LVL parameter, 5-39
EDIT INPUT NAME menu, 3-5
EX ENCODING parameter, 2-25
INPUT NAME menu, 3-5
input selection buttons, 2-5
Record Zone, 2-5
DISTANCES & LEVELS option, 3-35, 3-47
DISTANCES option, 3-47
DOLBY button, 5-4
Zone 2, 2-5
INPUTS
External Noise Test, 3-52
changing names, 3-5
configuring, 3-15
DOLBY D parameter, 3-13
F
factory-default settings, restoring, 6-4
Record Zone, 3-2
installation considerations, 1-5
I-2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Index
low-pass filter, 3-23
MONO SUB parameter, 3-34
MONO SURROUND listening mode, 5-16
MUTE ON message, 2-4
I (continued)
installation worksheet, A-20
Internal Noise Test, 3-52
IR input connector, 2-10
IR receiver, 2-3
M
MAIN ADV menu, 3-15
MAIN ADVANCED parameter, 3-15
MAIN menu, 2-11
Main Zone, 2-19
main zone audio output connectors, 2-7
L
N
NAME parameter, 3-5
NIGHTCLUB listening mode, 5-10
L7 MUSIC SURR listening mode, 5-6
LEDs, IR receiver, 2-3
manual audio adjustments, 3-10
manual calibration, 3-52
MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP menu, 3-52
MAX VOLUME parameter, 3-67
MC-12
O
OSD button. See remote control, 2-16
output connectors
level meters, 3-10
LEVELS CALIBRATION, A-21
LEVELS CALIBRATION menu, 3-54
LEVELS option, 3-35
audio, 2-7
trigger, 2-10
about, 1-2
highlights, 1-4
Output Level Parameters, 3-33
OUTPUT LEVELS menu, 5-35
Output levels, calibrating
Levels option, 3-47
product registration, 1-5
MENU button, 2-17
menu item selection, 2-11
menu navigation, 2-11
menu options, 2-12
selecting, 2-12
listening mode descriptions, 5-5
listening mode parameter descriptions, 5-37
LISTENING MODES
Bass Peak Limiters, 3-57
manual, 3-54
parameters, 3-33
Menu tree, A-5
MIC parameter, 3-14
P
parameter descriptions, 5-37
Preferred, 5-3
MICROPHONE CHECK option, 3-35
microphone input connectors, 2-10
microphone placement, 3-41
MODE ADJUST menu, 5-2
MONO listening mode, 5-16
MONO LOGIC listening mode, 5-15
PANORAMA
calibration, 5-13
Panorama listening mode, 5-12
parameter drop-down menus, 2-12
parameters
listening modes, preferred, 3-12
LIVE! CALIBRATION menu, 3-3
LIVE! mode, 5-33
listening mode menu, 5-37
program operation, 3-68
selecting, 2-12
LIVE! Status Menu, 2-24
parameters, preferred listening mode selection, 3-12
I-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Index
Lexicon
light button, 2-14
Main Zone, 2-14
operation considerations, 2-10
overview, 2-10
Record Zone, 2-14
Shift, 2-14
SPREAD parameter, 5-43
standby button, 2-3
P (continued)
PLIIx MOV listening mode, 5-20
PLIIx MUS listening mode, 5-20
POSITION parameter, 3-63
power switch, 2-7
STAT button, 2-17
STATUS menu descriptions, 2-21
STATUS menu Level Meters, 2-26
SUB L/R LVL parameter, 5-32
SUB L/R parameter, 3-26
SUB parameter, 5-35
removable access panel, 2-10
restoring factory-default settings, 6-4
REVERB LVL parameter, 5-42
routine maintenance, 6-3
RS-232 connectors, 2-9
R
REAR LEFT parameter, 3-34
SUB RIGHT parameter, 3-34
SUBWOOFER parameter, 3-30
SUBWOOFERS L/R parameter, 3-28
SURR MIX LVL parameter, 2-26
rear panel
MC-12, 2-6
MC-12 Balanced, 2-8
overview, 2-6
REAR PANEL CONFIG menu, 3-2
REAR RIGHT parameter, 3-34
REC BALANCE parameter, 4-2
RECORD ADVANCED parameter, 3-15
RECORD parameter, 3-20, A-20
Record parameter, 3-21
S-VIDEO 16
S
S:VIDEO 16:9 parameter, 3-15
S:VIDEO OSD 4:3 parameter, 3-15
safety instructions, ii, v
SET DISTANCES display, 3-50
SET LEVELS display, 3-50
SETTING DISTANCES screen, 3-48
SETTING LEVELS screen, 3-48
SETUP parameter, 3-70
SHAPE parameter, 5-42
SIDE LEFT parameter, 3-34
SIDE RIGHT parameter, 3-34
speaker calibration parameters, 3-33
SPEAKER SETUP menu, 3-2
9 parameter, 3-16
T
THX button, 5-4
Record Zone, 2-19
THX listening mode, 5-18
THX SPEAKER SETUP screen, 3-25
THX SurEX listening mode, 5-18
trigger output connectors, 2-10
TRIGGER SETUP menu, 3-2
troubleshooting, 6-2
record zone audio output connectors, 2-9
record zone video output connectors, 2-9
remote control
arrow buttons, 2-11
battery installation, 1-6
BLUE button, 2-16
command bank activation, 2-13
command matrix, 2-14
TV button, 5-4
Two-line Status
input selection buttons, 2-14
Main Zone, 2-19
I-4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MC-12
Index
T (continued)
Record Zone, 2-20
U
USE LAST setting, 3-13
V
VIDEO IN menu, 3-11
video input connectors
S-video, 2-9
video output connectors, 2-9
record zone, 2-9
S-video, 2-9
VOLUME CONTROL SETUP menu, 3-2
volume knob, 2-3
W
WORD LENGTH parameter, 2-26
Z
zone 2 audio output connectors, 2-7
ZONE PWR ON parameter, 3-66
Zones, About, 2-19
I-5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Inside Back Cover.fm Page 1 Monday, May 9, 2005 11:21 AM
PRODUCT REGISTRATION
Please register this product within 15 days of
purchase. To do so, complete and return this card
or register online at www.lexicon.com. Retain the
sales receipt for proof of coverage.
Mr.
Mrs.
Ms.
Miss
Single
Married
Divorced
Widowed
LIMITED WARRANTY
First Name
Last Name
Title
Company
Mailing Address
City
What Expenses will Harman Specialty Group
Assume?
Harman Specialty Group will pay all labor and material
expenses for covered items. Payment of shipping
charges is discussed in the next section of the warranty.
Harman Specialty Group offers the following warranty
on this product:
What Certain Damages are Excluded?
State
Fax Number
Zip
Harman Specialty Group’s liability for a defective
product is limited to repair or replacement of that
product, at our option. Harman Specialty Group shall
not be liable for damages based on inconvenience;
loss of use of the product; loss of time; interrupted
operation; commercial loss; or any other damages,
whether incidental, consequential, or otherwise.
Telephone Number
Email Address
Product Model
Version
What is the Duration of this Warranty?
This warranty will remain in effect for three (3) years
from the original date of purchase.
Purchase Date
Serial Number
Where did you purchase this product?
Age Education
High School
How is Service Obtained?
Household Income
Under $20,000
When this product needs service, write, telephone, or
fax Harman Specialty Group to request information
about where the unit should be taken or sent. When
making a written request, please include your name,
complete address, and daytime telephone number;
the product model and serial numbers; and a descrip-
tion of the problem. Do not return the unit to Harman
Specialty Group without prior authorization.
Under 18
18-24
25-34
35-49
50-64
65+
Who is Covered?
College
Graduate School
Certificate:
$20,000 to $34,999
$35,000 to $49,000
$50,000 to $74,999
$75,000 to $99,000
$100,000+
This warranty may be enforced by the original pur-
chaser and subsequent owners during the warranty
period, provided the original dated sales receipt or
other proof of warranty coverage is presented at time
of service.
How do State Laws Relate to this Warranty?
Some states do not allow limitations on the duration of
implied warranties and/or the exclusion or limitation
of incidental or consequential damages. As such, the
above limitations may not apply.
How did you learn about this product? Choose one:
Friend
Colleague
Teacher
Store salesperson
Store display
Received as a gift
Advertisement
Magazine Article
Own other Lexicon
products
What is Covered?
This warranty is not enforceable outside of North
America. This warranty provides specific legal rights.
Additional rights may be provided by some states.
This warranty covers all defects in material and
workmanship on this product, except as specified
below. The following are not covered:
When Shipping a Product for Service . . .
Which of the following were most important in the selection of this product?
1. Pay any initial shipping charges, which are the
responsibility of the owner. If necessary repairs are
covered by this warranty, Harman Specialty
Group will pay return shipping charges to any
destination in the United States using the carrier
of our choice.
Sound
Features
Quality
Brandname
Value for price
Other:
Durability
1. Damage resulting from
What are your three favorite magazines?
1. 2.
What are your three favorite websites?
1. 2.
A. Accident, misuse, abuse, or neglect.
B. Failure to follow instructions contained in the
3.
3.
user guide.
C. Repair or attempted repair unauthorized by
Harman Specialty Group.
D. Failure to perform recommended periodic
What features would you like to see added to this product in the future?
2. Pack the unit securely. Package insurance is
strongly recommended.
maintenance.
3. Include a copy of the original dated sales receipt.
(A copy of the original dated sales receipt must be
presented whenever warranty service is required.)
4. Do not include accessories such as power cords or
user guides unless instructed to do so.
MC-12 05/05
2. Causes other than product defects, including lack
of skill, competence, or experience on the part of
the owner.
3. Damage occurring during any shipment of this
product. Claims for shipping damages must be
made with the carrier.
4. Damage to a unit that has been altered, or on
which the serial number has been defaced, modi-
fied, or removed.
What are the Limitations of Implied
Warranties?
Any implied warranties, including warranties of mer-
chantability and fitness for a particular purpose, are
limited in duration to the length of this warranty.
Customer Service
Tel 781-280-0300
Fax 781-280-0495 (Sales)
Fax 781-280-0499 (Service)
Harman Specialty Group
3 Oak Park
Bedford, MA 01730-1413
Tel 781-280-0300
Fax 781-280-0490
www.lexicon.com
USA
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
A Harman International Company
Part No. 070-14773 | Rev 4 | 05/05
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
|
LG Electronics Washer WM3988H User Manual
Lightolier Indoor Furnishings 0889 User Manual
Lightolier Indoor Furnishings TSL User Manual
Lowrance electronic SONAR X100C User Manual
Madrigal Imaging Stereo Amplifier N380 User Manual
Magnadyne DVD Player MV DVD PL3 User Manual
Master Chef Charcoal Grill 85 1035 0 User Manual
Melissa Ventilation Hood 258 001 User Manual
Mellerware Electric Shaver 20610 User Manual
Microsoft Computer Accessories 7706368 User Manual